3 @setfilename ../../info/org
4 @settitle The Org Manual
9 @c Version and Contact Info
10 @set MAINTAINERSITE @uref{http://orgmode.org,maintainers webpage}
11 @set AUTHOR Carsten Dominik
12 @set MAINTAINER Carsten Dominik
13 @set MAINTAINEREMAIL @email{carsten at orgmode dot org}
14 @set MAINTAINERCONTACT @uref{mailto:carsten at orgmode dot org,contact the maintainer}
20 @c @hyphenation{time-stamp time-stamps time-stamp-ing time-stamp-ed}
35 @c Subheadings inside a table.
36 @macro tsubheading{text}
46 This manual is for Org version @value{VERSION}.
48 Copyright @copyright{} 2004, 2005, 2006, 2007, 2008, 2009 Free Software Foundation
51 Permission is granted to copy, distribute and/or modify this document
52 under the terms of the GNU Free Documentation License, Version 1.3 or
53 any later version published by the Free Software Foundation; with no
54 Invariant Sections, with the Front-Cover texts being ``A GNU Manual,''
55 and with the Back-Cover Texts as in (a) below. A copy of the license
56 is included in the section entitled ``GNU Free Documentation License.''
58 (a) The FSF's Back-Cover Text is: ``You have the freedom to copy and
59 modify this GNU manual. Buying copies from the FSF supports it in
60 developing GNU and promoting software freedom.''
62 This document is part of a collection distributed under the GNU Free
63 Documentation License. If you want to distribute this document
64 separately from the collection, you can do so by adding a copy of the
65 license to the document, as described in section 6 of the license.
71 * Org Mode: (org). Outline-based notes management and organizer
77 @subtitle Release @value{VERSION}
78 @author by Carsten Dominik
80 @c The following two commands start the copyright page.
82 @vskip 0pt plus 1filll
86 @c Output the table of contents at the beginning.
90 @node Top, Introduction, (dir), (dir)
97 * Introduction:: Getting started
98 * Document Structure:: A tree works like your brain
99 * Tables:: Pure magic for quick formatting
100 * Hyperlinks:: Notes in context
101 * TODO Items:: Every tree branch can be a TODO item
102 * Tags:: Tagging headlines and matching sets of tags
103 * Properties and Columns:: Storing information about an entry
104 * Dates and Times:: Making items useful for planning
105 * Capture - Refile - Archive:: The ins and outs for projects
106 * Agenda Views:: Collecting information into views
107 * Markup:: Prepare text for rich export
108 * Exporting:: Sharing and publishing of notes
109 * Publishing:: Create a web site of linked Org files
110 * Miscellaneous:: All the rest which did not fit elsewhere
111 * Hacking:: How to hack your way around
112 * MobileOrg:: Viewing and capture on a mobile device
113 * History and Acknowledgments:: How Org came into being
114 * Main Index:: An index of Org's concepts and features
115 * Key Index:: Key bindings and where they are described
116 * Variable Index:: Variables mentioned in the manual
119 --- The Detailed Node Listing ---
123 * Summary:: Brief summary of what Org does
124 * Installation:: How to install a downloaded version of Org
125 * Activation:: How to activate Org for certain buffers
126 * Feedback:: Bug reports, ideas, patches etc.
127 * Conventions:: Type-setting conventions in the manual
131 * Outlines:: Org is based on Outline mode
132 * Headlines:: How to typeset Org tree headlines
133 * Visibility cycling:: Show and hide, much simplified
134 * Motion:: Jumping to other headlines
135 * Structure editing:: Changing sequence and level of headlines
136 * Sparse trees:: Matches embedded in context
137 * Plain lists:: Additional structure within an entry
138 * Drawers:: Tucking stuff away
139 * Blocks:: Folding blocks
140 * Footnotes:: How footnotes are defined in Org's syntax
141 * Orgstruct mode:: Structure editing outside Org
145 * Built-in table editor:: Simple tables
146 * Column width and alignment:: Overrule the automatic settings
147 * Column groups:: Grouping to trigger vertical lines
148 * Orgtbl mode:: The table editor as minor mode
149 * The spreadsheet:: The table editor has spreadsheet capabilities
150 * Org-Plot:: Plotting from org tables
154 * References:: How to refer to another field or range
155 * Formula syntax for Calc:: Using Calc to compute stuff
156 * Formula syntax for Lisp:: Writing formulas in Emacs Lisp
157 * Field formulas:: Formulas valid for a single field
158 * Column formulas:: Formulas valid for an entire column
159 * Editing and debugging formulas:: Fixing formulas
160 * Updating the table:: Recomputing all dependent fields
161 * Advanced features:: Field names, parameters and automatic recalc
165 * Link format:: How links in Org are formatted
166 * Internal links:: Links to other places in the current file
167 * External links:: URL-like links to the world
168 * Handling links:: Creating, inserting and following
169 * Using links outside Org:: Linking from my C source code?
170 * Link abbreviations:: Shortcuts for writing complex links
171 * Search options:: Linking to a specific location
172 * Custom searches:: When the default search is not enough
176 * Radio targets:: Make targets trigger links in plain text
180 * TODO basics:: Marking and displaying TODO entries
181 * TODO extensions:: Workflow and assignments
182 * Progress logging:: Dates and notes for progress
183 * Priorities:: Some things are more important than others
184 * Breaking down tasks:: Splitting a task into manageable pieces
185 * Checkboxes:: Tick-off lists
187 Extended use of TODO keywords
189 * Workflow states:: From TODO to DONE in steps
190 * TODO types:: I do this, Fred does the rest
191 * Multiple sets in one file:: Mixing it all, and still finding your way
192 * Fast access to TODO states:: Single letter selection of a state
193 * Per-file keywords:: Different files, different requirements
194 * Faces for TODO keywords:: Highlighting states
195 * TODO dependencies:: When one task needs to wait for others
199 * Closing items:: When was this entry marked DONE?
200 * Tracking TODO state changes:: When did the status change?
201 * Tracking your habits:: How consistent have you been?
205 * Tag inheritance:: Tags use the tree structure of the outline
206 * Setting tags:: How to assign tags to a headline
207 * Tag searches:: Searching for combinations of tags
209 Properties and Columns
211 * Property syntax:: How properties are spelled out
212 * Special properties:: Access to other Org mode features
213 * Property searches:: Matching property values
214 * Property inheritance:: Passing values down the tree
215 * Column view:: Tabular viewing and editing
216 * Property API:: Properties for Lisp programmers
220 * Defining columns:: The COLUMNS format property
221 * Using column view:: How to create and use column view
222 * Capturing column view:: A dynamic block for column view
226 * Scope of column definitions:: Where defined, where valid?
227 * Column attributes:: Appearance and content of a column
231 * Timestamps:: Assigning a time to a tree entry
232 * Creating timestamps:: Commands which insert timestamps
233 * Deadlines and scheduling:: Planning your work
234 * Clocking work time:: Tracking how long you spend on a task
235 * Resolving idle time:: Resolving time if you've been idle
236 * Effort estimates:: Planning work effort in advance
237 * Relative timer:: Notes with a running timer
241 * The date/time prompt:: How Org mode helps you entering date and time
242 * Custom time format:: Making dates look different
244 Deadlines and scheduling
246 * Inserting deadline/schedule:: Planning items
247 * Repeated tasks:: Items that show up again and again
249 Capture - Refile - Archive
251 * Remember:: Capture new tasks/ideas with little interruption
252 * Attachments:: Add files to tasks.
253 * RSS Feeds:: Getting input from RSS feeds
254 * Protocols:: External (e.g. Browser) access to Emacs and Org
255 * Refiling notes:: Moving a tree from one place to another
256 * Archiving:: What to do with finished projects
260 * Setting up Remember for Org:: Some code for .emacs to get things going
261 * Remember templates:: Define the outline of different note types
262 * Storing notes:: Directly get the note to where it belongs
266 * Moving subtrees:: Moving a tree to an archive file
267 * Internal archiving:: Switch off a tree but keep i in the file
271 * Agenda files:: Files being searched for agenda information
272 * Agenda dispatcher:: Keyboard access to agenda views
273 * Built-in agenda views:: What is available out of the box?
274 * Presentation and sorting:: How agenda items are prepared for display
275 * Agenda commands:: Remote editing of Org trees
276 * Custom agenda views:: Defining special searches and views
277 * Exporting Agenda Views:: Writing a view to a file
278 * Agenda column view:: Using column view for collected entries
280 The built-in agenda views
282 * Weekly/daily agenda:: The calendar page with current tasks
283 * Global TODO list:: All unfinished action items
284 * Matching tags and properties:: Structured information with fine-tuned search
285 * Timeline:: Time-sorted view for single file
286 * Search view:: Find entries by searching for text
287 * Stuck projects:: Find projects you need to review
289 Presentation and sorting
291 * Categories:: Not all tasks are equal
292 * Time-of-day specifications:: How the agenda knows the time
293 * Sorting of agenda items:: The order of things
297 * Storing searches:: Type once, use often
298 * Block agenda:: All the stuff you need in a single buffer
299 * Setting Options:: Changing the rules
301 Markup for rich export
303 * Structural markup elements:: The basic structure as seen by the exporter
304 * Images and tables:: Tables and Images will be included
305 * Literal examples:: Source code examples with special formatting
306 * Include files:: Include additional files into a document
307 * Macro replacement:: Use macros to create complex output
308 * Embedded LaTeX:: LaTeX can be freely used inside Org documents
310 Structural markup elements
312 * Document title:: Where the title is taken from
313 * Headings and sections:: The document structure as seen by the exporter
314 * Table of contents:: The if and where of the table of contents
315 * Initial text:: Text before the first heading?
317 * Paragraphs:: Paragraphs
318 * Footnote markup:: Footnotes
319 * Emphasis and monospace:: Bold, italic, etc.
320 * Horizontal rules:: Make a line
321 * Comment lines:: What will *not* be exported
325 * Special symbols:: Greek letters and other symbols
326 * Subscripts and superscripts:: Simple syntax for raising/lowering text
327 * LaTeX fragments:: Complex formulas made easy
328 * Previewing LaTeX fragments:: What will this snippet look like?
329 * CDLaTeX mode:: Speed up entering of formulas
333 * Selective export:: Using tags to select and exclude trees
334 * Export options:: Per-file export settings
335 * The export dispatcher:: How to access exporter commands
336 * ASCII export:: Exporting to plain ASCII
337 * HTML export:: Exporting to HTML
338 * LaTeX and PDF export:: Exporting to La@TeX{}, and processing to PDF
339 * DocBook export:: Exporting to DocBook
340 * Freemind export:: Exporting to Freemind mind maps
341 * XOXO export:: Exporting to XOXO
342 * iCalendar export:: Exporting in iCalendar format
346 * HTML Export commands:: How to invoke HTML export
347 * Quoting HTML tags:: Using direct HTML in Org mode
348 * Links in HTML export:: How links will be interpreted and formatted
349 * Tables in HTML export:: How to modify the formatting of tables
350 * Images in HTML export:: How to insert figures into HTML output
351 * Text areas in HTML export:: An alternative way to show an example
352 * CSS support:: Changing the appearance of the output
353 * Javascript support:: Info and Folding in a web browser
355 La@TeX{} and PDF export
357 * LaTeX/PDF export commands:: Which key invokes which commands
358 * Quoting LaTeX code:: Incorporating literal La@TeX{} code
359 * Sectioning structure:: Changing sectioning in La@TeX{} output
360 * Tables in LaTeX export:: Options for exporting tables to La@TeX{}
361 * Images in LaTeX export:: How to insert figures into La@TeX{} output
362 * Beamer class export:: Turning the file into a presentation
366 * DocBook export commands:: How to invoke DocBook export
367 * Quoting DocBook code:: Incorporating DocBook code in Org files
368 * Recursive sections:: Recursive sections in DocBook
369 * Tables in DocBook export:: Tables are exported as HTML tables
370 * Images in DocBook export:: How to insert figures into DocBook output
371 * Special characters:: How to handle special characters
375 * Configuration:: Defining projects
376 * Uploading files:: How to get files up on the server
377 * Sample configuration:: Example projects
378 * Triggering publication:: Publication commands
382 * Project alist:: The central configuration variable
383 * Sources and destinations:: From here to there
384 * Selecting files:: What files are part of the project?
385 * Publishing action:: Setting the function doing the publishing
386 * Publishing options:: Tweaking HTML export
387 * Publishing links:: Which links keep working after publishing?
388 * Project page index:: Publishing a list of project files
392 * Simple example:: One-component publishing
393 * Complex example:: A multi-component publishing example
397 * Completion:: M-TAB knows what you need
398 * Speed keys:: Electic commands at the beginning of a headline
399 * Customization:: Adapting Org to your taste
400 * In-buffer settings:: Overview of the #+KEYWORDS
401 * The very busy C-c C-c key:: When in doubt, press C-c C-c
402 * Clean view:: Getting rid of leading stars in the outline
403 * TTY keys:: Using Org on a tty
404 * Interaction:: Other Emacs packages
406 Interaction with other packages
408 * Cooperation:: Packages Org cooperates with
409 * Conflicts:: Packages that lead to conflicts
413 * Hooks:: Who to reach into Org's internals
414 * Add-on packages:: Available extensions
415 * Adding hyperlink types:: New custom link types
416 * Context-sensitive commands:: How to add functionality to such commands
417 * Tables in arbitrary syntax:: Orgtbl for La@TeX{} and other programs
418 * Dynamic blocks:: Automatically filled blocks
419 * Special agenda views:: Customized views
420 * Extracting agenda information:: Postprocessing of agenda information
421 * Using the property API:: Writing programs that use entry properties
422 * Using the mapping API:: Mapping over all or selected entries
424 Tables and lists in arbitrary syntax
426 * Radio tables:: Sending and receiving radio tables
427 * A LaTeX example:: Step by step, almost a tutorial
428 * Translator functions:: Copy and modify
429 * Radio lists:: Doing the same for lists
433 * Setting up the staging area:: Where to interact with the mobile device
434 * Pushing to MobileOrg:: Uploading Org files and agendas
435 * Pulling from MobileOrg:: Integrating captured and flagged items
440 @node Introduction, Document Structure, Top, Top
441 @chapter Introduction
445 * Summary:: Brief summary of what Org does
446 * Installation:: How to install a downloaded version of Org
447 * Activation:: How to activate Org for certain buffers
448 * Feedback:: Bug reports, ideas, patches etc.
449 * Conventions:: Type-setting conventions in the manual
452 @node Summary, Installation, Introduction, Introduction
456 Org is a mode for keeping notes, maintaining TODO lists, and doing
457 project planning with a fast and effective plain-text system.
459 Org develops organizational tasks around NOTES files that contain
460 lists or information about projects as plain text. Org is
461 implemented on top of Outline mode, which makes it possible to keep the
462 content of large files well structured. Visibility cycling and
463 structure editing help to work with the tree. Tables are easily created
464 with a built-in table editor. Org supports TODO items, deadlines,
465 timestamps, and scheduling. It dynamically compiles entries into an
466 agenda that utilizes and smoothly integrates much of the Emacs calendar
467 and diary. Plain text URL-like links connect to websites, emails,
468 Usenet messages, BBDB entries, and any files related to the projects.
469 For printing and sharing of notes, an Org file can be exported as a
470 structured ASCII file, as HTML, or (TODO and agenda items only) as an
471 iCalendar file. It can also serve as a publishing tool for a set of
474 An important design aspect that distinguishes Org from, for example,
475 Planner/Muse is that it encourages you to store every piece of information
476 only once. In Planner, you have project pages, day pages and possibly
477 other files, duplicating some information such as tasks. In Org,
478 you only have notes files. In your notes you mark entries as tasks, and
479 label them with tags and timestamps. All necessary lists, like a
480 schedule for the day, the agenda for a meeting, tasks lists selected by
481 tags, etc., are created dynamically when you need them.
483 Org keeps simple things simple. When first fired up, it should
484 feel like a straightforward, easy to use outliner. Complexity is not
485 imposed, but a large amount of functionality is available when you need
486 it. Org is a toolbox and can be used in different ways, for
490 @r{@bullet{} an outline extension with visibility cycling and structure editing}
491 @r{@bullet{} an ASCII system and table editor for taking structured notes}
492 @r{@bullet{} an ASCII table editor with spreadsheet-like capabilities}
493 @r{@bullet{} a TODO list editor}
494 @r{@bullet{} a full agenda and planner with deadlines and work scheduling}
495 @pindex GTD, Getting Things Done
496 @r{@bullet{} an environment to implement David Allen's GTD system}
497 @r{@bullet{} a basic database application}
498 @r{@bullet{} a simple hypertext system, with HTML and La@TeX{} export}
499 @r{@bullet{} a publishing tool to create a set of interlinked webpages}
502 Org's automatic, context-sensitive table editor with spreadsheet
503 capabilities can be integrated into any major mode by activating the
504 minor Orgtbl mode. Using a translation step, it can be used to maintain
505 tables in arbitrary file types, for example in La@TeX{}. The structure
506 editing and list creation capabilities can be used outside Org with
507 the minor Orgstruct mode.
510 There is a website for Org which provides links to the newest
511 version of Org, as well as additional information, frequently asked
512 questions (FAQ), links to tutorials, etc@. This page is located at
513 @uref{http://orgmode.org}.
518 @node Installation, Activation, Summary, Introduction
519 @section Installation
523 @b{Important:} @i{If you are using a version of Org that is part of the Emacs
524 distribution or an XEmacs package, please skip this section and go directly
525 to @ref{Activation}.}
527 If you have downloaded Org from the Web, either as a distribution @file{.zip}
528 or @file{.tar} file, or as a Git archive, you must take the following steps
529 to install it: go into the unpacked Org distribution directory and edit the
530 top section of the file @file{Makefile}. You must set the name of the Emacs
531 binary (likely either @file{emacs} or @file{xemacs}), and the paths to the
532 directories where local Lisp and Info files are kept. If you don't have
533 access to the system-wide directories, you can simply run Org directly from
534 the distribution directory by adding the @file{lisp} subdirectory to the
535 Emacs load path. To do this, add the following line to @file{.emacs}:
538 (setq load-path (cons "~/path/to/orgdir/lisp" load-path))
542 If you plan to use code from the @file{contrib} subdirectory, do a similar
543 step for this directory:
546 (setq load-path (cons "~/path/to/orgdir/contrib/lisp" load-path))
551 XEmacs users now need to install the file @file{noutline.el} from
552 the @file{xemacs} sub-directory of the Org distribution. Use the
556 make install-noutline
561 @noindent Now byte-compile the Lisp files with the shell command:
567 @noindent If you are running Org from the distribution directory, this is
568 all. If you want to install Org into the system directories, use (as
575 Installing Info files is system dependent, because of differences in the
576 @file{install-info} program. In Debian it copies the info files into the
577 correct directory and modifies the info directory file. In many other
578 systems, the files need to be copied to the correct directory separately, and
579 @file{install-info} then only modifies the directory file. Check your system
580 documentation to find out which of the following commands you need:
584 make install-info-debian
587 Then add the following line to @file{.emacs}. It is needed so that
588 Emacs can autoload functions that are located in files not immediately loaded
589 when Org-mode starts.
591 (require 'org-install)
594 Do not forget to activate Org as described in the following section.
597 @node Activation, Feedback, Installation, Introduction
601 @cindex global key bindings
602 @cindex key bindings, global
605 @b{Important:} @i{If you use copy-and-paste to copy Lisp code from the
606 PDF documentation as viewed by some PDF viewers to your @file{.emacs} file, the
607 single-quote character comes out incorrectly and the code will not work.
608 You need to fix the single-quotes by hand, or copy from Info
612 Add the following lines to your @file{.emacs} file. The last three lines
613 define @emph{global} keys for the commands @command{org-store-link},
614 @command{org-agenda}, and @command{org-iswitchb}---please choose suitable
618 ;; The following lines are always needed. Choose your own keys.
619 (add-to-list 'auto-mode-alist '("\\.org\\'" . org-mode))
620 (global-set-key "\C-cl" 'org-store-link)
621 (global-set-key "\C-ca" 'org-agenda)
622 (global-set-key "\C-cb" 'org-iswitchb)
625 Furthermore, you must activate @code{font-lock-mode} in Org
626 buffers, because significant functionality depends on font-locking being
627 active. You can do this with either one of the following two lines
628 (XEmacs users must use the second option):
630 (global-font-lock-mode 1) ; for all buffers
631 (add-hook 'org-mode-hook 'turn-on-font-lock) ; Org buffers only
634 @cindex Org mode, turning on
635 With this setup, all files with extension @samp{.org} will be put
636 into Org mode. As an alternative, make the first line of a file look
640 MY PROJECTS -*- mode: org; -*-
643 @vindex org-insert-mode-line-in-empty-file
644 @noindent which will select Org mode for this buffer no matter what
645 the file's name is. See also the variable
646 @code{org-insert-mode-line-in-empty-file}.
648 Many commands in Org work on the region if the region is @i{active}. To make
649 use of this, you need to have @code{transient-mark-mode}
650 (@code{zmacs-regions} in XEmacs) turned on. In Emacs 23 this is the default,
651 in Emacs 22 you need to do this yourself with
653 (transient-mark-mode 1)
655 @noindent If you do not like @code{transient-mark-mode}, you can create an
656 active region by using the mouse to select a region, or pressing
657 @kbd{C-@key{SPC}} twice before moving the cursor.
659 @node Feedback, Conventions, Activation, Introduction
666 If you find problems with Org, or if you have questions, remarks, or ideas
667 about it, please mail to the Org mailing list @email{emacs-orgmode@@gnu.org}.
668 If you are not a member of the mailing list, your mail will be passed to the
669 list after a moderator has approved it.
671 For bug reports, please provide as much information as possible, including
672 the version information of Emacs (@kbd{M-x emacs-version @key{RET}}) and Org
673 (@kbd{M-x org-version @key{RET}}), as well as the Org related setup in
674 @file{.emacs}. The easiest way to do this is to use the command
676 @kbd{M-x org-submit-bug-report}
678 @noindent which will put all this information into an Emacs mail buffer so
679 that you only need to add your description. If you re not sending the Email
680 from within Emacs, please copy and paste the content into your Email program.
682 If an error occurs, a backtrace can be very useful (see below on how to
683 create one). Often a small example file helps, along with clear information
687 @item What exactly did you do?
688 @item What did you expect to happen?
689 @item What happened instead?
691 @noindent Thank you for helping to improve this mode.
693 @subsubheading How to create a useful backtrace
695 @cindex backtrace of an error
696 If working with Org produces an error with a message you don't
697 understand, you may have hit a bug. The best way to report this is by
698 providing, in addition to what was mentioned above, a @emph{backtrace}.
699 This is information from the built-in debugger about where and how the
700 error occurred. Here is how to produce a useful backtrace:
704 Reload uncompiled versions of all Org-mode Lisp files. The backtrace
705 contains much more information if it is produced with uncompiled code.
708 C-u M-x org-reload RET
711 or select @code{Org -> Refresh/Reload -> Reload Org uncompiled} from the
714 Go to the @code{Options} menu and select @code{Enter Debugger on Error}
715 (XEmacs has this option in the @code{Troubleshooting} sub-menu).
717 Do whatever you have to do to hit the error. Don't forget to
718 document the steps you take.
720 When you hit the error, a @file{*Backtrace*} buffer will appear on the
721 screen. Save this buffer to a file (for example using @kbd{C-x C-w}) and
722 attach it to your bug report.
725 @node Conventions, , Feedback, Introduction
726 @section Typesetting conventions used in this manual
728 Org uses three types of keywords: TODO keywords, tags, and property
729 names. In this manual we use the following conventions:
734 TODO keywords are written with all capitals, even if they are
738 User-defined tags are written in lowercase; built-in tags with special
739 meaning are written with all capitals.
742 User-defined properties are capitalized; built-in properties with
743 special meaning are written with all capitals.
746 @node Document Structure, Tables, Introduction, Top
747 @chapter Document Structure
748 @cindex document structure
749 @cindex structure of document
751 Org is based on Outline mode and provides flexible commands to
752 edit the structure of the document.
755 * Outlines:: Org is based on Outline mode
756 * Headlines:: How to typeset Org tree headlines
757 * Visibility cycling:: Show and hide, much simplified
758 * Motion:: Jumping to other headlines
759 * Structure editing:: Changing sequence and level of headlines
760 * Sparse trees:: Matches embedded in context
761 * Plain lists:: Additional structure within an entry
762 * Drawers:: Tucking stuff away
763 * Blocks:: Folding blocks
764 * Footnotes:: How footnotes are defined in Org's syntax
765 * Orgstruct mode:: Structure editing outside Org
768 @node Outlines, Headlines, Document Structure, Document Structure
773 Org is implemented on top of Outline mode. Outlines allow a
774 document to be organized in a hierarchical structure, which (at least
775 for me) is the best representation of notes and thoughts. An overview
776 of this structure is achieved by folding (hiding) large parts of the
777 document to show only the general document structure and the parts
778 currently being worked on. Org greatly simplifies the use of
779 outlines by compressing the entire show/hide functionality into a single
780 command, @command{org-cycle}, which is bound to the @key{TAB} key.
782 @node Headlines, Visibility cycling, Outlines, Document Structure
786 @vindex org-special-ctrl-a/e
788 Headlines define the structure of an outline tree. The headlines in
789 Org start with one or more stars, on the left margin@footnote{See
790 the variable @code{org-special-ctrl-a/e} to configure special behavior
791 of @kbd{C-a} and @kbd{C-e} in headlines.}. For example:
801 * Another top level headline
804 @noindent Some people find the many stars too noisy and would prefer an
805 outline that has whitespace followed by a single star as headline
806 starters. @ref{Clean view}, describes a setup to realize this.
808 @vindex org-cycle-separator-lines
809 An empty line after the end of a subtree is considered part of it and
810 will be hidden when the subtree is folded. However, if you leave at
811 least two empty lines, one empty line will remain visible after folding
812 the subtree, in order to structure the collapsed view. See the
813 variable @code{org-cycle-separator-lines} to modify this behavior.
815 @node Visibility cycling, Motion, Headlines, Document Structure
816 @section Visibility cycling
817 @cindex cycling, visibility
818 @cindex visibility cycling
819 @cindex trees, visibility
820 @cindex show hidden text
823 Outlines make it possible to hide parts of the text in the buffer.
824 Org uses just two commands, bound to @key{TAB} and
825 @kbd{S-@key{TAB}} to change the visibility in the buffer.
827 @cindex subtree visibility states
828 @cindex subtree cycling
829 @cindex folded, subtree visibility state
830 @cindex children, subtree visibility state
831 @cindex subtree, subtree visibility state
835 @emph{Subtree cycling}: Rotate current subtree among the states
838 ,-> FOLDED -> CHILDREN -> SUBTREE --.
839 '-----------------------------------'
842 @vindex org-cycle-emulate-tab
843 @vindex org-cycle-global-at-bob
844 The cursor must be on a headline for this to work@footnote{see, however,
845 the option @code{org-cycle-emulate-tab}.}. When the cursor is at the
846 beginning of the buffer and the first line is not a headline, then
847 @key{TAB} actually runs global cycling (see below)@footnote{see the
848 option @code{org-cycle-global-at-bob}.}. Also when called with a prefix
849 argument (@kbd{C-u @key{TAB}}), global cycling is invoked.
851 @cindex global visibility states
852 @cindex global cycling
853 @cindex overview, global visibility state
854 @cindex contents, global visibility state
855 @cindex show all, global visibility state
859 @emph{Global cycling}: Rotate the entire buffer among the states
862 ,-> OVERVIEW -> CONTENTS -> SHOW ALL --.
863 '--------------------------------------'
866 When @kbd{S-@key{TAB}} is called with a numeric prefix argument N, the
867 CONTENTS view up to headlines of level N will be shown. Note that inside
868 tables, @kbd{S-@key{TAB}} jumps to the previous field.
870 @cindex show all, command
871 @kindex C-u C-u C-u @key{TAB}
872 @item C-u C-u C-u @key{TAB}
873 Show all, including drawers.
876 Reveal context around point, showing the current entry, the following heading
877 and the hierarchy above. Useful for working near a location that has been
878 exposed by a sparse tree command (@pxref{Sparse trees}) or an agenda command
879 (@pxref{Agenda commands}). With a prefix argument show, on each
880 level, all sibling headings.
883 Show the current subtree in an indirect buffer@footnote{The indirect
886 (@pxref{Indirect Buffers,,,emacs,GNU Emacs Manual})
889 (see the Emacs manual for more information about indirect buffers)
891 will contain the entire buffer, but will be narrowed to the current
892 tree. Editing the indirect buffer will also change the original buffer,
893 but without affecting visibility in that buffer.}. With a numeric
894 prefix argument N, go up to level N and then take that tree. If N is
895 negative then go up that many levels. With a @kbd{C-u} prefix, do not remove
896 the previously used indirect buffer.
899 @vindex org-startup-folded
900 @cindex @code{overview}, STARTUP keyword
901 @cindex @code{content}, STARTUP keyword
902 @cindex @code{showall}, STARTUP keyword
903 @cindex @code{showeverything}, STARTUP keyword
905 When Emacs first visits an Org file, the global state is set to
906 OVERVIEW, i.e. only the top level headlines are visible. This can be
907 configured through the variable @code{org-startup-folded}, or on a
908 per-file basis by adding one of the following lines anywhere in the
915 #+STARTUP: showeverything
918 @cindex property, VISIBILITY
920 Furthermore, any entries with a @samp{VISIBILITY} property (@pxref{Properties
921 and Columns}) will get their visibility adapted accordingly. Allowed values
922 for this property are @code{folded}, @code{children}, @code{content}, and
925 @kindex C-u C-u @key{TAB}
926 @item C-u C-u @key{TAB}
927 Switch back to the startup visibility of the buffer, i.e. whatever is
928 requested by startup options and @samp{VISIBILITY} properties in individual
932 @node Motion, Structure editing, Visibility cycling, Document Structure
934 @cindex motion, between headlines
935 @cindex jumping, to headlines
936 @cindex headline navigation
937 The following commands jump to other headlines in the buffer.
948 Next heading same level.
951 Previous heading same level.
954 Backward to higher level heading.
957 Jump to a different place without changing the current outline
958 visibility. Shows the document structure in a temporary buffer, where
959 you can use the following keys to find your destination:
960 @vindex org-goto-auto-isearch
962 @key{TAB} @r{Cycle visibility.}
963 @key{down} / @key{up} @r{Next/previous visible headline.}
964 @key{RET} @r{Select this location.}
965 @kbd{/} @r{Do a Sparse-tree search}
966 @r{The following keys work if you turn off @code{org-goto-auto-isearch}}
967 n / p @r{Next/previous visible headline.}
968 f / b @r{Next/previous headline same level.}
970 0-9 @r{Digit argument.}
973 @vindex org-goto-interface
975 See also the variable @code{org-goto-interface}.
978 @node Structure editing, Sparse trees, Motion, Document Structure
979 @section Structure editing
980 @cindex structure editing
981 @cindex headline, promotion and demotion
982 @cindex promotion, of subtrees
983 @cindex demotion, of subtrees
984 @cindex subtree, cut and paste
985 @cindex pasting, of subtrees
986 @cindex cutting, of subtrees
987 @cindex copying, of subtrees
988 @cindex sorting, of subtrees
989 @cindex subtrees, cut and paste
994 @vindex org-M-RET-may-split-line
995 Insert new heading with same level as current. If the cursor is in a
996 plain list item, a new item is created (@pxref{Plain lists}). To force
997 creation of a new headline, use a prefix argument, or first press @key{RET}
998 to get to the beginning of the next line. When this command is used in
999 the middle of a line, the line is split and the rest of the line becomes
1000 the new headline@footnote{If you do not want the line to be split,
1001 customize the variable @code{org-M-RET-may-split-line}.}. If the
1002 command is used at the beginning of a headline, the new headline is
1003 created before the current line. If at the beginning of any other line,
1004 the content of that line is made the new heading. If the command is
1005 used at the end of a folded subtree (i.e. behind the ellipses at the end
1006 of a headline), then a headline like the current one will be inserted
1007 after the end of the subtree.
1010 Just like @kbd{M-@key{RET}}, except when adding a new heading below the
1011 current heading, the new heading is placed after the body instead of before
1012 it. This command works from anywhere in the entry.
1013 @kindex M-S-@key{RET}
1015 @vindex org-treat-insert-todo-heading-as-state-change
1016 Insert new TODO entry with same level as current heading. See also the
1017 variable @code{org-treat-insert-todo-heading-as-state-change}.
1018 @kindex C-S-@key{RET}
1020 Insert new TODO entry with same level as current heading. Like
1021 @kbd{C-@key{RET}}, the new headline will be inserted after the current
1024 @item @key{TAB} @r{in new, empty entry}
1025 In a new entry with no text yet, the first @key{TAB} demotes the entry to
1026 become a child of the previous one. The next @key{TAB} makes it a parent,
1027 and so on, all the way to top level. Yet another @key{TAB}, and you are back
1028 to the initial level.
1029 @kindex M-@key{left}
1031 Promote current heading by one level.
1032 @kindex M-@key{right}
1034 Demote current heading by one level.
1035 @kindex M-S-@key{left}
1036 @item M-S-@key{left}
1037 Promote the current subtree by one level.
1038 @kindex M-S-@key{right}
1039 @item M-S-@key{right}
1040 Demote the current subtree by one level.
1041 @kindex M-S-@key{up}
1043 Move subtree up (swap with previous subtree of same
1045 @kindex M-S-@key{down}
1046 @item M-S-@key{down}
1047 Move subtree down (swap with next subtree of same level).
1050 Kill subtree, i.e. remove it from buffer but save in kill ring.
1051 With a numeric prefix argument N, kill N sequential subtrees.
1054 Copy subtree to kill ring. With a numeric prefix argument N, copy the N
1055 sequential subtrees.
1058 Yank subtree from kill ring. This does modify the level of the subtree to
1059 make sure the tree fits in nicely at the yank position. The yank level can
1060 also be specified with a numeric prefix argument, or by yanking after a
1061 headline marker like @samp{****}.
1064 @vindex org-yank-adjusted-subtrees
1065 @vindex org-yank-folded-subtrees
1066 Depending on the variables @code{org-yank-adjusted-subtrees} and
1067 @code{org-yank-folded-subtrees}, Org's internal @code{yank} command will
1068 paste subtrees folded and in a clever way, using the same command as @kbd{C-c
1069 C-x C-y}. With the default settings, no level adjustment will take place,
1070 but the yanked tree will be folded unless doing so would swallow text
1071 previously visible. Any prefix argument to this command will force a normal
1072 @code{yank} to be executed, with the prefix passed along. A good way to
1073 force a normal yank is @kbd{C-u C-y}. If you use @code{yank-pop} after a
1074 yank, it will yank previous kill items plainly, without adjustment and
1078 Clone a subtree by making a number of sibling copies of it. You will be
1079 prompted for the number of copies to make, and you can also specify if any
1080 timestamps in the entry should be shifted. This can be useful, for example,
1081 to create a number of tasks related to a series of lectures to prepare. For
1082 more details, see the docstring of the command
1083 @code{org-clone-subtree-with-time-shift}.
1086 Refile entry or region to a different location. @xref{Refiling notes}.
1089 Sort same-level entries. When there is an active region, all entries in the
1090 region will be sorted. Otherwise the children of the current headline are
1091 sorted. The command prompts for the sorting method, which can be
1092 alphabetically, numerically, by time (first timestamp with active preferred,
1093 creation time, scheduled time, deadline time), by priority, by TODO keyword
1094 (in the sequence the keywords have been defined in the setup) or by the value
1095 of a property. Reverse sorting is possible as well. You can also supply
1096 your own function to extract the sorting key. With a @kbd{C-u} prefix,
1097 sorting will be case-sensitive. With two @kbd{C-u C-u} prefixes, duplicate
1098 entries will also be removed.
1101 Narrow buffer to current subtree.
1104 Widen buffer to remove narrowing.
1107 Turn a normal line or plain list item into a headline (so that it becomes a
1108 subheading at its location). Also turn a headline into a normal line by
1109 removing the stars. If there is an active region, turn all lines in the
1110 region into headlines. If the first line in the region was an item, turn
1111 only the item lines into headlines. Finally, if the first line is a
1112 headline, remove the stars from all headlines in the region.
1115 @cindex region, active
1116 @cindex active region
1117 @cindex transient mark mode
1118 When there is an active region (Transient Mark mode), promotion and
1119 demotion work on all headlines in the region. To select a region of
1120 headlines, it is best to place both point and mark at the beginning of a
1121 line, mark at the beginning of the first headline, and point at the line
1122 just after the last headline to change. Note that when the cursor is
1123 inside a table (@pxref{Tables}), the Meta-Cursor keys have different
1127 @node Sparse trees, Plain lists, Structure editing, Document Structure
1128 @section Sparse trees
1129 @cindex sparse trees
1130 @cindex trees, sparse
1131 @cindex folding, sparse trees
1132 @cindex occur, command
1134 @vindex org-show-hierarchy-above
1135 @vindex org-show-following-heading
1136 @vindex org-show-siblings
1137 @vindex org-show-entry-below
1138 An important feature of Org mode is the ability to construct @emph{sparse
1139 trees} for selected information in an outline tree, so that the entire
1140 document is folded as much as possible, but the selected information is made
1141 visible along with the headline structure above it@footnote{See also the
1142 variables @code{org-show-hierarchy-above}, @code{org-show-following-heading},
1143 @code{org-show-siblings}, and @code{org-show-entry-below} for detailed
1144 control on how much context is shown around each match.}. Just try it out
1145 and you will see immediately how it works.
1147 Org mode contains several commands creating such trees, all these
1148 commands can be accessed through a dispatcher:
1153 This prompts for an extra key to select a sparse-tree creating command.
1156 @vindex org-remove-highlights-with-change
1157 Occur. Prompts for a regexp and shows a sparse tree with all matches. If
1158 the match is in a headline, the headline is made visible. If the match is in
1159 the body of an entry, headline and body are made visible. In order to
1160 provide minimal context, also the full hierarchy of headlines above the match
1161 is shown, as well as the headline following the match. Each match is also
1162 highlighted; the highlights disappear when the buffer is changed by an
1163 editing command@footnote{This depends on the option
1164 @code{org-remove-highlights-with-change}}, or by pressing @kbd{C-c C-c}.
1165 When called with a @kbd{C-u} prefix argument, previous highlights are kept,
1166 so several calls to this command can be stacked.
1170 @vindex org-agenda-custom-commands
1171 For frequently used sparse trees of specific search strings, you can
1172 use the variable @code{org-agenda-custom-commands} to define fast
1173 keyboard access to specific sparse trees. These commands will then be
1174 accessible through the agenda dispatcher (@pxref{Agenda dispatcher}).
1178 (setq org-agenda-custom-commands
1179 '(("f" occur-tree "FIXME")))
1182 @noindent will define the key @kbd{C-c a f} as a shortcut for creating
1183 a sparse tree matching the string @samp{FIXME}.
1185 The other sparse tree commands select headings based on TODO keywords,
1186 tags, or properties and will be discussed later in this manual.
1189 @cindex printing sparse trees
1190 @cindex visible text, printing
1191 To print a sparse tree, you can use the Emacs command
1192 @code{ps-print-buffer-with-faces} which does not print invisible parts
1193 of the document @footnote{This does not work under XEmacs, because
1194 XEmacs uses selective display for outlining, not text properties.}.
1195 Or you can use the command @kbd{C-c C-e v} to export only the visible
1196 part of the document and print the resulting file.
1198 @node Plain lists, Drawers, Sparse trees, Document Structure
1199 @section Plain lists
1201 @cindex lists, plain
1202 @cindex lists, ordered
1203 @cindex ordered lists
1205 Within an entry of the outline tree, hand-formatted lists can provide
1206 additional structure. They also provide a way to create lists of
1207 checkboxes (@pxref{Checkboxes}). Org supports editing such lists,
1208 and the HTML exporter (@pxref{Exporting}) parses and formats them.
1210 Org knows ordered lists, unordered lists, and description lists.
1213 @emph{Unordered} list items start with @samp{-}, @samp{+}, or
1214 @samp{*}@footnote{When using @samp{*} as a bullet, lines must be indented or
1215 they will be seen as top-level headlines. Also, when you are hiding leading
1216 stars to get a clean outline view, plain list items starting with a star are
1217 visually indistinguishable from true headlines. In short: even though
1218 @samp{*} is supported, it may be better to not use it for plain list items.}
1221 @emph{Ordered} list items start with a numeral followed by either a period or
1222 a right parenthesis, such as @samp{1.} or @samp{1)}.
1224 @emph{Description} list items are unordered list items, and contain the
1225 separator @samp{ :: } to separate the description @emph{term} from the
1229 @vindex org-empty-line-terminates-plain-lists
1230 Items belonging to the same list must have the same indentation on the first
1231 line. In particular, if an ordered list reaches number @samp{10.}, then the
1232 2--digit numbers must be written left-aligned with the other numbers in the
1233 list. Indentation also determines the end of a list item. It ends before
1234 the next line that is indented like the bullet/number, or less. Empty lines
1235 are part of the previous item, so you can have several paragraphs in one
1236 item. If you would like an empty line to terminate all currently open plain
1237 lists, configure the variable @code{org-empty-line-terminates-plain-lists}.
1242 ** Lord of the Rings
1243 My favorite scenes are (in this order)
1244 1. The attack of the Rohirrim
1245 2. Eowyn's fight with the witch king
1246 + this was already my favorite scene in the book
1247 + I really like Miranda Otto.
1248 3. Peter Jackson being shot by Legolas
1250 He makes a really funny face when it happens.
1251 But in the end, no individual scenes matter but the film as a whole.
1252 Important actors in this film are:
1253 - @b{Elijah Wood} :: He plays Frodo
1254 - @b{Sean Austin} :: He plays Sam, Frodo's friend. I still remember
1255 him very well from his role as Mikey Walsh in @i{The Goonies}.
1259 Org supports these lists by tuning filling and wrapping commands to deal with
1260 them correctly@footnote{Org only changes the filling settings for Emacs. For
1261 XEmacs, you should use Kyle E. Jones' @file{filladapt.el}. To turn this on,
1262 put into @file{.emacs}: @code{(require 'filladapt)}}, and by exporting them
1263 properly (@pxref{Exporting}). Since indentation is what governs the
1264 structure of these lists, many structural constructs like @code{#+BEGIN_...}
1265 blocks can be indented to signal that they should be part of a list item.
1267 The following commands act on items when the cursor is in the first line
1268 of an item (the line with the bullet or number).
1273 @vindex org-cycle-include-plain-lists
1274 Items can be folded just like headline levels. Normally this works only if
1275 the cursor is on a plain list item. For more details, see the variable
1276 @code{org-cycle-include-plain-lists}. to @code{integrate}, plain list items
1277 will be treated like low-level. The level of an item is then given by the
1278 indentation of the bullet/number. Items are always subordinate to real
1279 headlines, however; the hierarchies remain completely separated.
1281 If @code{org-cycle-include-plain-lists} has not been set, @key{TAB}
1282 fixes the indentation of the current line in a heuristic way.
1285 @vindex org-M-RET-may-split-line
1286 Insert new item at current level. With a prefix argument, force a new
1287 heading (@pxref{Structure editing}). If this command is used in the middle
1288 of a line, the line is @emph{split} and the rest of the line becomes the new
1289 item@footnote{If you do not want the line to be split, customize the variable
1290 @code{org-M-RET-may-split-line}.}. If this command is executed in the
1291 @emph{whitespace before a bullet or number}, the new item is created
1292 @emph{before} the current item. If the command is executed in the white
1293 space before the text that is part of an item but does not contain the
1294 bullet, a bullet is added to the current line.
1295 @kindex M-S-@key{RET}
1297 Insert a new item with a checkbox (@pxref{Checkboxes}).
1299 @item @key{TAB} @r{in new, empty item}
1300 In a new item with no text yet, the first @key{TAB} demotes the item to
1301 become a child of the previous one. The next @key{TAB} makes it a parent,
1302 and so on, all the way to the left margin. Yet another @key{TAB}, and you
1303 are back to the initial level.
1305 @kindex S-@key{down}
1308 @cindex shift-selection-mode
1309 @vindex org-support-shift-select
1310 Jump to the previous/next item in the current list, but only if
1311 @code{org-support-shift-select} is off. If not, you can still use paragraph
1312 jumping commands like @kbd{C-@key{up}} and @kbd{C-@key{down}} to quite
1314 @kindex M-S-@key{up}
1315 @kindex M-S-@key{down}
1317 @itemx M-S-@key{down}
1318 Move the item including subitems up/down (swap with previous/next item
1319 of same indentation). If the list is ordered, renumbering is
1321 @kindex M-S-@key{left}
1322 @kindex M-S-@key{right}
1323 @item M-S-@key{left}
1324 @itemx M-S-@key{right}
1325 Decrease/increase the indentation of the item, including subitems.
1326 Initially, the item tree is selected based on current indentation.
1327 When these commands are executed several times in direct succession,
1328 the initially selected region is used, even if the new indentation
1329 would imply a different hierarchy. To use the new hierarchy, break
1330 the command chain with a cursor motion or so.
1333 If there is a checkbox (@pxref{Checkboxes}) in the item line, toggle the
1334 state of the checkbox. If not, this command makes sure that all the
1335 items on this list level use the same bullet. Furthermore, if this is
1336 an ordered list, make sure the numbering is OK.
1339 Cycle the entire list level through the different itemize/enumerate bullets
1340 (@samp{-}, @samp{+}, @samp{*}, @samp{1.}, @samp{1)}). With a numeric prefix
1341 argument N, select the Nth bullet from this list. If there is an active
1342 region when calling this, all lines will be converted to list items. If the
1343 first line already was a list item, any item markers will be removed from the
1344 list. Finally, even without an active region, a normal line will be
1345 converted into a list item.
1348 Turn a plain list item into a headline (so that it becomes a subheading at
1349 its location). @xref{Structure editing}, for a detailed explanation.
1350 @kindex S-@key{left}
1351 @kindex S-@key{right}
1352 @item S-@key{left}/@key{right}
1353 @vindex org-support-shift-select
1354 This command also cycles bullet styles when the cursor in on the bullet or
1355 anywhere in an item line, details depending on
1356 @code{org-support-shift-select}.
1359 Sort the plain list. You will be prompted for the sorting method:
1360 numerically, alphabetically, by time, or by custom function.
1363 @node Drawers, Blocks, Plain lists, Document Structure
1367 @cindex visibility cycling, drawers
1370 Sometimes you want to keep information associated with an entry, but you
1371 normally don't want to see it. For this, Org mode has @emph{drawers}.
1372 Drawers need to be configured with the variable
1373 @code{org-drawers}@footnote{You can define drawers on a per-file basis
1374 with a line like @code{#+DRAWERS: HIDDEN PROPERTIES STATE}}. Drawers
1378 ** This is a headline
1379 Still outside the drawer
1381 This is inside the drawer.
1386 Visibility cycling (@pxref{Visibility cycling}) on the headline will hide and
1387 show the entry, but keep the drawer collapsed to a single line. In order to
1388 look inside the drawer, you need to move the cursor to the drawer line and
1389 press @key{TAB} there. Org mode uses the @code{PROPERTIES} drawer for
1390 storing properties (@pxref{Properties and Columns}), and you can also arrange
1391 for state change notes (@pxref{Tracking TODO state changes}) and clock times
1392 (@pxref{Clocking work time}) to be stored in a drawer @code{LOGBOOK}.
1394 @node Blocks, Footnotes, Drawers, Document Structure
1397 @vindex org-hide-block-startup
1398 @cindex blocks, folding
1399 Org-mode uses begin...end blocks for various purposes from including source
1400 code examples (@pxref{Literal examples}) to capturing time logging
1401 information (@pxref{Clocking work time}). These blocks can be folded and
1402 unfolded by pressing TAB in the begin line. You can also get all blocks
1403 folded at startup by configuring the variable @code{org-hide-block-startup}
1404 or on a per-file basis by using
1406 @cindex @code{hideblocks}, STARTUP keyword
1407 @cindex @code{nohideblocks}, STARTUP keyword
1409 #+STARTUP: hideblocks
1410 #+STARTUP: nohideblocks
1413 @node Footnotes, Orgstruct mode, Blocks, Document Structure
1417 Org mode supports the creation of footnotes. In contrast to the
1418 @file{footnote.el} package, Org mode's footnotes are designed for work on a
1419 larger document, not only for one-off documents like emails. The basic
1420 syntax is similar to the one used by @file{footnote.el}, i.e. a footnote is
1421 defined in a paragraph that is started by a footnote marker in square
1422 brackets in column 0, no indentation allowed. If you need a paragraph break
1423 inside a footnote, use the La@TeX{} idiom @samp{\par}. The footnote reference
1424 is simply the marker in square brackets, inside text. For example:
1427 The Org homepage[fn:1] now looks a lot better than it used to.
1429 [fn:1] The link is: http://orgmode.org
1432 Org mode extends the number-based syntax to @emph{named} footnotes and
1433 optional inline definition. Using plain numbers as markers (as
1434 @file{footnote.el} does) is supported for backward compatibility, but not
1435 encouraged because of possible conflicts with La@TeX{} snippets (@pxref{Embedded
1436 LaTeX}). Here are the valid references:
1440 A plain numeric footnote marker. Compatible with @file{footnote.el}, but not
1441 recommended because somthing like @samp{[1]} could easily be part of a code
1444 A named footnote reference, where @code{name} is a unique label word, or, for
1445 simplicity of automatic creation, a number.
1446 @item [fn:: This is the inline definition of this footnote]
1447 A La@TeX{}-like anonymous footnote where the definition is given directly at the
1449 @item [fn:name: a definition]
1450 An inline definition of a footnote, which also specifies a name for the note.
1451 Since Org allows multiple references to the same note, you can then use
1452 @code{[fn:name]} to create additional references.
1455 @vindex org-footnote-auto-label
1456 Footnote labels can be created automatically, or you can create names yourself.
1457 This is handled by the variable @code{org-footnote-auto-label} and its
1458 corresponding @code{#+STARTUP} keywords, see the docstring of that variable
1461 @noindent The following command handles footnotes:
1466 The footnote action command.
1468 When the cursor is on a footnote reference, jump to the definition. When it
1469 is at a definition, jump to the (first) reference.
1471 @vindex org-footnote-define-inline
1472 @vindex org-footnote-section
1473 @vindex org-footnote-auto-adjust
1474 Otherwise, create a new footnote. Depending on the variable
1475 @code{org-footnote-define-inline}@footnote{The corresponding in-buffer
1476 setting is: @code{#+STARTUP: fninline} or @code{#+STARTUP: nofninline}}, the
1477 definition will be placed right into the text as part of the reference, or
1478 separately into the location determined by the variable
1479 @code{org-footnote-section}.
1481 When this command is called with a prefix argument, a menu of additional
1484 s @r{Sort the footnote definitions by reference sequence. During editing,}
1485 @r{Org makes no effort to sort footnote definitions into a particular}
1486 @r{sequence. If you want them sorted, use this command, which will}
1487 @r{also move entries according to @code{org-footnote-section}. Automatic}
1488 @r{sorting after each insertion/deletion can be configured using the}
1489 @r{variable @code{org-footnote-auto-adjust}.}
1490 r @r{Renumber the simple @code{fn:N} footnotes. Automatic renumbering}
1491 @r{after each insertion/deletion can be configured using the variable}
1492 @r{@code{org-footnote-auto-adjust}.}
1493 S @r{Short for first @code{r}, then @code{s} action.}
1494 n @r{Normalize the footnotes by collecting all definitions (including}
1495 @r{inline definitions) into a special section, and then numbering them}
1496 @r{in sequence. The references will then also be numbers. This is}
1497 @r{meant to be the final step before finishing a document (e.g. sending}
1498 @r{off an email). The exporters do this automatically, and so could}
1499 @r{something like @code{message-send-hook}.}
1500 d @r{Delete the footnote at point, and all definitions of and references}
1503 Depending on the variable @code{org-footnote-auto-adjust}@footnote{the
1504 corresponding in-buffer options are @code{fnadjust} and @code{nofnadjust}.},
1505 renumbering and sorting footnotes can be automatic after each insertion or
1510 If the cursor is on a footnote reference, jump to the definition. If it is a
1511 the definition, jump back to the reference. When called at a footnote
1512 location with a prefix argument, offer the same menu as @kbd{C-c C-x f}.
1516 @item C-c C-o @r{or} mouse-1/2
1517 Footnote labels are also links to the corresponding definition/reference, and
1518 you can use the usual commands to follow these links.
1521 @node Orgstruct mode, , Footnotes, Document Structure
1522 @section The Orgstruct minor mode
1523 @cindex Orgstruct mode
1524 @cindex minor mode for structure editing
1526 If you like the intuitive way the Org mode structure editing and list
1527 formatting works, you might want to use these commands in other modes like
1528 Text mode or Mail mode as well. The minor mode @code{orgstruct-mode} makes
1529 this possible. Toggle the mode with @kbd{M-x orgstruct-mode}, or
1530 turn it on by default, for example in Mail mode, with one of:
1533 (add-hook 'mail-mode-hook 'turn-on-orgstruct)
1534 (add-hook 'mail-mode-hook 'turn-on-orgstruct++)
1537 When this mode is active and the cursor is on a line that looks to Org like a
1538 headline or the first line of a list item, most structure editing commands
1539 will work, even if the same keys normally have different functionality in the
1540 major mode you are using. If the cursor is not in one of those special
1541 lines, Orgstruct mode lurks silently in the shadow. When you use
1542 @code{orgstruct++-mode}, Org will also export indentation and autofill
1543 settings into that mode, and detect item context after the first line of an
1546 @node Tables, Hyperlinks, Document Structure, Top
1549 @cindex editing tables
1551 Org comes with a fast and intuitive table editor. Spreadsheet-like
1552 calculations are supported in connection with the Emacs @file{calc}
1555 (@pxref{Top,Calc,,Calc,Gnu Emacs Calculator Manual}).
1558 (see the Emacs Calculator manual for more information about the Emacs
1563 * Built-in table editor:: Simple tables
1564 * Column width and alignment:: Overrule the automatic settings
1565 * Column groups:: Grouping to trigger vertical lines
1566 * Orgtbl mode:: The table editor as minor mode
1567 * The spreadsheet:: The table editor has spreadsheet capabilities
1568 * Org-Plot:: Plotting from org tables
1571 @node Built-in table editor, Column width and alignment, Tables, Tables
1572 @section The built-in table editor
1573 @cindex table editor, built-in
1575 Org makes it easy to format tables in plain ASCII. Any line with
1576 @samp{|} as the first non-whitespace character is considered part of a
1577 table. @samp{|} is also the column separator. A table might look like
1581 | Name | Phone | Age |
1582 |-------+-------+-----|
1583 | Peter | 1234 | 17 |
1584 | Anna | 4321 | 25 |
1587 A table is re-aligned automatically each time you press @key{TAB} or
1588 @key{RET} or @kbd{C-c C-c} inside the table. @key{TAB} also moves to
1589 the next field (@key{RET} to the next row) and creates new table rows
1590 at the end of the table or before horizontal lines. The indentation
1591 of the table is set by the first line. Any line starting with
1592 @samp{|-} is considered as a horizontal separator line and will be
1593 expanded on the next re-align to span the whole table width. So, to
1594 create the above table, you would only type
1601 @noindent and then press @key{TAB} to align the table and start filling in
1602 fields. Even faster would be to type @code{|Name|Phone|Age} followed by
1603 @kbd{C-c @key{RET}}.
1605 @vindex org-enable-table-editor
1606 @vindex org-table-auto-blank-field
1607 When typing text into a field, Org treats @key{DEL},
1608 @key{Backspace}, and all character keys in a special way, so that
1609 inserting and deleting avoids shifting other fields. Also, when
1610 typing @emph{immediately after the cursor was moved into a new field
1611 with @kbd{@key{TAB}}, @kbd{S-@key{TAB}} or @kbd{@key{RET}}}, the
1612 field is automatically made blank. If this behavior is too
1613 unpredictable for you, configure the variables
1614 @code{org-enable-table-editor} and @code{org-table-auto-blank-field}.
1617 @tsubheading{Creation and conversion}
1620 Convert the active region to table. If every line contains at least one
1621 TAB character, the function assumes that the material is tab separated.
1622 If every line contains a comma, comma-separated values (CSV) are assumed.
1623 If not, lines are split at whitespace into fields. You can use a prefix
1624 argument to force a specific separator: @kbd{C-u} forces CSV, @kbd{C-u
1625 C-u} forces TAB, and a numeric argument N indicates that at least N
1626 consecutive spaces, or alternatively a TAB will be the separator.
1628 If there is no active region, this command creates an empty Org
1629 table. But it's easier just to start typing, like
1630 @kbd{|Name|Phone|Age @key{RET} |- @key{TAB}}.
1632 @tsubheading{Re-aligning and field motion}
1635 Re-align the table without moving the cursor.
1639 Re-align the table, move to the next field. Creates a new row if
1644 Re-align, move to previous field.
1648 Re-align the table and move down to next row. Creates a new row if
1649 necessary. At the beginning or end of a line, @key{RET} still does
1650 NEWLINE, so it can be used to split a table.
1654 Move to beginning of the current table field, or on to the previous field.
1657 Move to end of the current table field, or on to the next field.
1659 @tsubheading{Column and row editing}
1660 @kindex M-@key{left}
1661 @kindex M-@key{right}
1663 @itemx M-@key{right}
1664 Move the current column left/right.
1666 @kindex M-S-@key{left}
1667 @item M-S-@key{left}
1668 Kill the current column.
1670 @kindex M-S-@key{right}
1671 @item M-S-@key{right}
1672 Insert a new column to the left of the cursor position.
1675 @kindex M-@key{down}
1678 Move the current row up/down.
1680 @kindex M-S-@key{up}
1682 Kill the current row or horizontal line.
1684 @kindex M-S-@key{down}
1685 @item M-S-@key{down}
1686 Insert a new row above the current row. With a prefix argument, the line is
1687 created below the current one.
1691 Insert a horizontal line below current row. With a prefix argument, the line
1692 is created above the current line.
1694 @kindex C-c @key{RET}
1696 Insert a horizontal line below current row, and move the cursor into the row
1701 Sort the table lines in the region. The position of point indicates the
1702 column to be used for sorting, and the range of lines is the range
1703 between the nearest horizontal separator lines, or the entire table. If
1704 point is before the first column, you will be prompted for the sorting
1705 column. If there is an active region, the mark specifies the first line
1706 and the sorting column, while point should be in the last line to be
1707 included into the sorting. The command prompts for the sorting type
1708 (alphabetically, numerically, or by time). When called with a prefix
1709 argument, alphabetic sorting will be case-sensitive.
1711 @tsubheading{Regions}
1714 Copy a rectangular region from a table to a special clipboard. Point and
1715 mark determine edge fields of the rectangle. If there is no active region,
1716 copy just the current field. The process ignores horizontal separator lines.
1720 Copy a rectangular region from a table to a special clipboard, and
1721 blank all fields in the rectangle. So this is the ``cut'' operation.
1725 Paste a rectangular region into a table.
1726 The upper left corner ends up in the current field. All involved fields
1727 will be overwritten. If the rectangle does not fit into the present table,
1728 the table is enlarged as needed. The process ignores horizontal separator
1733 Wrap several fields in a column like a paragraph. If there is an active
1734 region, and both point and mark are in the same column, the text in the
1735 column is wrapped to minimum width for the given number of lines. A numeric
1736 prefix argument may be used to change the number of desired lines. If there
1737 is no region, the current field is split at the cursor position and the text
1738 fragment to the right of the cursor is prepended to the field one line
1739 down. If there is no region, but you specify a prefix argument, the current
1740 field is made blank, and the content is appended to the field above.
1742 @tsubheading{Calculations}
1743 @cindex formula, in tables
1744 @cindex calculations, in tables
1745 @cindex region, active
1746 @cindex active region
1747 @cindex transient mark mode
1750 Sum the numbers in the current column, or in the rectangle defined by
1751 the active region. The result is shown in the echo area and can
1752 be inserted with @kbd{C-y}.
1756 @vindex org-table-copy-increment
1757 When current field is empty, copy from first non-empty field above. When not
1758 empty, copy current field down to next row and move cursor along with it.
1759 Depending on the variable @code{org-table-copy-increment}, integer field
1760 values will be incremented during copy. Integers that are too large will not
1761 be incremented. Also, a @code{0} prefix argument temporarily disables the
1762 increment. This key is also used by shift-selection and related modes
1763 (@pxref{Conflicts}).
1765 @tsubheading{Miscellaneous}
1768 Edit the current field in a separate window. This is useful for fields that
1769 are not fully visible (@pxref{Column width and alignment}). When called with
1770 a @kbd{C-u} prefix, just make the full field visible, so that it can be
1773 @item M-x org-table-import
1774 Import a file as a table. The table should be TAB or whitespace
1775 separated. Use, for example, to import a spreadsheet table or data
1776 from a database, because these programs generally can write
1777 TAB-separated text files. This command works by inserting the file into
1778 the buffer and then converting the region to a table. Any prefix
1779 argument is passed on to the converter, which uses it to determine the
1782 Tables can also be imported by pasting tabular text into the Org
1783 buffer, selecting the pasted text with @kbd{C-x C-x} and then using the
1784 @kbd{C-c |} command (see above under @i{Creation and conversion}).
1786 @item M-x org-table-export
1787 @vindex org-table-export-default-format
1788 Export the table, by default as a TAB-separated file. Use for data
1789 exchange with, for example, spreadsheet or database programs. The format
1790 used to export the file can be configured in the variable
1791 @code{org-table-export-default-format}. You may also use properties
1792 @code{TABLE_EXPORT_FILE} and @code{TABLE_EXPORT_FORMAT} to specify the file
1793 name and the format for table export in a subtree. Org supports quite
1794 general formats for exported tables. The exporter format is the same as the
1795 format used by Orgtbl radio tables, see @ref{Translator functions}, for a
1796 detailed description.
1799 If you don't like the automatic table editor because it gets in your
1800 way on lines which you would like to start with @samp{|}, you can turn
1804 (setq org-enable-table-editor nil)
1807 @noindent Then the only table command that still works is
1808 @kbd{C-c C-c} to do a manual re-align.
1810 @node Column width and alignment, Column groups, Built-in table editor, Tables
1811 @section Column width and alignment
1812 @cindex narrow columns in tables
1813 @cindex alignment in tables
1815 The width of columns is automatically determined by the table editor. And
1816 also the alignment of a column is determined automatically from the fraction
1817 of number-like versus non-number fields in the column.
1819 Sometimes a single field or a few fields need to carry more text,
1820 leading to inconveniently wide columns. To limit@footnote{This feature
1821 does not work on XEmacs.} the width of a column, one field anywhere in
1822 the column may contain just the string @samp{<N>} where @samp{N} is an
1823 integer specifying the width of the column in characters. The next
1824 re-align will then set the width of this column to no more than this
1829 |---+------------------------------| |---+--------|
1831 | 1 | one | | 1 | one |
1832 | 2 | two | ----\ | 2 | two |
1833 | 3 | This is a long chunk of text | ----/ | 3 | This=> |
1834 | 4 | four | | 4 | four |
1835 |---+------------------------------| |---+--------|
1840 Fields that are wider become clipped and end in the string @samp{=>}.
1841 Note that the full text is still in the buffer, it is only invisible.
1842 To see the full text, hold the mouse over the field---a tool-tip window
1843 will show the full content. To edit such a field, use the command
1844 @kbd{C-c `} (that is @kbd{C-c} followed by the backquote). This will
1845 open a new window with the full field. Edit it and finish with @kbd{C-c
1848 @vindex org-startup-align-all-tables
1849 When visiting a file containing a table with narrowed columns, the
1850 necessary character hiding has not yet happened, and the table needs to
1851 be aligned before it looks nice. Setting the option
1852 @code{org-startup-align-all-tables} will realign all tables in a file
1853 upon visiting, but also slow down startup. You can also set this option
1854 on a per-file basis with:
1861 If you would like to overrule the automatic alignment of number-rich columns
1862 to the right and of string-rich column to the left, you and use @samp{<r>} or
1863 @samp{<l>} in a similar fashion. You may also combine alignment and field
1864 width like this: @samp{<l10>}.
1866 @node Column groups, Orgtbl mode, Column width and alignment, Tables
1867 @section Column groups
1868 @cindex grouping columns in tables
1870 When Org exports tables, it does so by default without vertical
1871 lines because that is visually more satisfying in general. Occasionally
1872 however, vertical lines can be useful to structure a table into groups
1873 of columns, much like horizontal lines can do for groups of rows. In
1874 order to specify column groups, you can use a special row where the
1875 first field contains only @samp{/}. The further fields can either
1876 contain @samp{<} to indicate that this column should start a group,
1877 @samp{>} to indicate the end of a column, or @samp{<>} to make a column
1878 a group of its own. Boundaries between column groups will upon export be
1879 marked with vertical lines. Here is an example:
1882 | | N | N^2 | N^3 | N^4 | sqrt(n) | sqrt[4](N) |
1883 |---+----+-----+-----+-----+---------+------------|
1884 | / | <> | < | | > | < | > |
1885 | # | 1 | 1 | 1 | 1 | 1 | 1 |
1886 | # | 2 | 4 | 8 | 16 | 1.4142 | 1.1892 |
1887 | # | 3 | 9 | 27 | 81 | 1.7321 | 1.3161 |
1888 |---+----+-----+-----+-----+---------+------------|
1889 #+TBLFM: $3=$2^2::$4=$2^3::$5=$2^4::$6=sqrt($2)::$7=sqrt(sqrt(($2)))
1892 It is also sufficient to just insert the column group starters after
1893 every vertical line you'd like to have:
1896 | N | N^2 | N^3 | N^4 | sqrt(n) | sqrt[4](N) |
1897 |----+-----+-----+-----+---------+------------|
1901 @node Orgtbl mode, The spreadsheet, Column groups, Tables
1902 @section The Orgtbl minor mode
1904 @cindex minor mode for tables
1906 If you like the intuitive way the Org table editor works, you
1907 might also want to use it in other modes like Text mode or Mail mode.
1908 The minor mode Orgtbl mode makes this possible. You can always toggle
1909 the mode with @kbd{M-x orgtbl-mode}. To turn it on by default, for
1910 example in mail mode, use
1913 (add-hook 'mail-mode-hook 'turn-on-orgtbl)
1916 Furthermore, with some special setup, it is possible to maintain tables
1917 in arbitrary syntax with Orgtbl mode. For example, it is possible to
1918 construct La@TeX{} tables with the underlying ease and power of
1919 Orgtbl mode, including spreadsheet capabilities. For details, see
1920 @ref{Tables in arbitrary syntax}.
1922 @node The spreadsheet, Org-Plot, Orgtbl mode, Tables
1923 @section The spreadsheet
1924 @cindex calculations, in tables
1925 @cindex spreadsheet capabilities
1926 @cindex @file{calc} package
1928 The table editor makes use of the Emacs @file{calc} package to implement
1929 spreadsheet-like capabilities. It can also evaluate Emacs Lisp forms to
1930 derive fields from other fields. While fully featured, Org's
1931 implementation is not identical to other spreadsheets. For example,
1932 Org knows the concept of a @emph{column formula} that will be
1933 applied to all non-header fields in a column without having to copy the
1934 formula to each relevant field.
1937 * References:: How to refer to another field or range
1938 * Formula syntax for Calc:: Using Calc to compute stuff
1939 * Formula syntax for Lisp:: Writing formulas in Emacs Lisp
1940 * Field formulas:: Formulas valid for a single field
1941 * Column formulas:: Formulas valid for an entire column
1942 * Editing and debugging formulas:: Fixing formulas
1943 * Updating the table:: Recomputing all dependent fields
1944 * Advanced features:: Field names, parameters and automatic recalc
1947 @node References, Formula syntax for Calc, The spreadsheet, The spreadsheet
1948 @subsection References
1951 To compute fields in the table from other fields, formulas must
1952 reference other fields or ranges. In Org, fields can be referenced
1953 by name, by absolute coordinates, and by relative coordinates. To find
1954 out what the coordinates of a field are, press @kbd{C-c ?} in that
1955 field, or press @kbd{C-c @}} to toggle the display of a grid.
1957 @subsubheading Field references
1958 @cindex field references
1959 @cindex references, to fields
1961 Formulas can reference the value of another field in two ways. Like in
1962 any other spreadsheet, you may reference fields with a letter/number
1963 combination like @code{B3}, meaning the 2nd field in the 3rd row.
1964 @c Such references are always fixed to that field, they don't change
1965 @c when you copy and paste a formula to a different field. So
1966 @c Org's @code{B3} behaves like @code{$B$3} in other spreadsheets.
1969 Org also uses another, more general operator that looks like this:
1971 @@@var{row}$@var{column}
1975 Column references can be absolute like @samp{1}, @samp{2},...@samp{@var{N}},
1976 or relative to the current column like @samp{+1} or @samp{-2}.
1978 The row specification only counts data lines and ignores horizontal
1979 separator lines (hlines). You can use absolute row numbers
1980 @samp{1}...@samp{@var{N}}, and row numbers relative to the current row like
1981 @samp{+3} or @samp{-1}. Or specify the row relative to one of the
1982 hlines: @samp{I} refers to the first hline@footnote{Note that only
1983 hlines are counted that @emph{separate} table lines. If the table
1984 starts with a hline above the header, it does not count.}, @samp{II} to
1985 the second, etc@. @samp{-I} refers to the first such line above the
1986 current line, @samp{+I} to the first such line below the current line.
1987 You can also write @samp{III+2} which is the second data line after the
1988 third hline in the table.
1990 @samp{0} refers to the current row and column. Also, if you omit
1991 either the column or the row part of the reference, the current
1992 row/column is implied.
1994 Org's references with @emph{unsigned} numbers are fixed references
1995 in the sense that if you use the same reference in the formula for two
1996 different fields, the same field will be referenced each time.
1997 Org's references with @emph{signed} numbers are floating
1998 references because the same reference operator can reference different
1999 fields depending on the field being calculated by the formula.
2001 As a special case, references like @samp{$LR5} and @samp{$LR12} can be used
2002 to refer in a stable way to the 5th and 12th field in the last row of the
2005 Here are a few examples:
2008 @@2$3 @r{2nd row, 3rd column}
2009 C2 @r{same as previous}
2010 $5 @r{column 5 in the current row}
2011 E& @r{same as previous}
2012 @@2 @r{current column, row 2}
2013 @@-1$-3 @r{the field one row up, three columns to the left}
2014 @@-I$2 @r{field just under hline above current row, column 2}
2017 @subsubheading Range references
2018 @cindex range references
2019 @cindex references, to ranges
2021 You may reference a rectangular range of fields by specifying two field
2022 references connected by two dots @samp{..}. If both fields are in the
2023 current row, you may simply use @samp{$2..$7}, but if at least one field
2024 is in a different row, you need to use the general @code{@@row$column}
2025 format at least for the first field (i.e the reference must start with
2026 @samp{@@} in order to be interpreted correctly). Examples:
2029 $1..$3 @r{First three fields in the current row.}
2030 $P..$Q @r{Range, using column names (see under Advanced)}
2031 @@2$1..@@4$3 @r{6 fields between these two fields.}
2032 A2..C4 @r{Same as above.}
2033 @@-1$-2..@@-1 @r{3 numbers from the column to the left, 2 up to current row}
2036 @noindent Range references return a vector of values that can be fed
2037 into Calc vector functions. Empty fields in ranges are normally
2038 suppressed, so that the vector contains only the non-empty fields (but
2039 see the @samp{E} mode switch below). If there are no non-empty fields,
2040 @samp{[0]} is returned to avoid syntax errors in formulas.
2042 @subsubheading Named references
2043 @cindex named references
2044 @cindex references, named
2045 @cindex name, of column or field
2046 @cindex constants, in calculations
2049 @vindex org-table-formula-constants
2050 @samp{$name} is interpreted as the name of a column, parameter or
2051 constant. Constants are defined globally through the variable
2052 @code{org-table-formula-constants}, and locally (for the file) through a
2056 #+CONSTANTS: c=299792458. pi=3.14 eps=2.4e-6
2060 @vindex constants-unit-system
2061 @pindex constants.el
2062 Also properties (@pxref{Properties and Columns}) can be used as
2063 constants in table formulas: for a property @samp{:Xyz:} use the name
2064 @samp{$PROP_Xyz}, and the property will be searched in the current
2065 outline entry and in the hierarchy above it. If you have the
2066 @file{constants.el} package, it will also be used to resolve constants,
2067 including natural constants like @samp{$h} for Planck's constant, and
2068 units like @samp{$km} for kilometers@footnote{@file{constants.el} can
2069 supply the values of constants in two different unit systems, @code{SI}
2070 and @code{cgs}. Which one is used depends on the value of the variable
2071 @code{constants-unit-system}. You can use the @code{#+STARTUP} options
2072 @code{constSI} and @code{constcgs} to set this value for the current
2073 buffer.}. Column names and parameters can be specified in special table
2074 lines. These are described below, see @ref{Advanced features}. All
2075 names must start with a letter, and further consist of letters and
2078 @subsubheading Remote references
2079 @cindex remote references
2080 @cindex references, remote
2081 @cindex references, to a different table
2082 @cindex name, of column or field
2083 @cindex constants, in calculations
2086 You may also reference constants, fields and ranges from a different table,
2087 either in the current file or even in a different file. The syntax is
2090 remote(NAME-OR-ID,REF)
2094 where NAME can be the name of a table in the current file as set by a
2095 @code{#+TBLNAME: NAME} line before the table. It can also be the ID of an
2096 entry, even in a different file, and the reference then refers to the first
2097 table in that entry. REF is an absolute field or range reference as
2098 described above for example @code{@@3$3} or @code{$somename}, valid in the
2101 @node Formula syntax for Calc, Formula syntax for Lisp, References, The spreadsheet
2102 @subsection Formula syntax for Calc
2103 @cindex formula syntax, Calc
2104 @cindex syntax, of formulas
2106 A formula can be any algebraic expression understood by the Emacs
2107 @file{Calc} package. @b{Note that @file{calc} has the
2108 non-standard convention that @samp{/} has lower precedence than
2109 @samp{*}, so that @samp{a/b*c} is interpreted as @samp{a/(b*c)}.} Before
2110 evaluation by @code{calc-eval} (@pxref{Calling Calc from
2111 Your Programs,calc-eval,Calling Calc from Your Lisp Programs,Calc,GNU
2112 Emacs Calc Manual}),
2113 @c FIXME: The link to the Calc manual in HTML does not work.
2114 variable substitution takes place according to the rules described above.
2115 @cindex vectors, in table calculations
2116 The range vectors can be directly fed into the Calc vector functions
2117 like @samp{vmean} and @samp{vsum}.
2119 @cindex format specifier
2120 @cindex mode, for @file{calc}
2121 @vindex org-calc-default-modes
2122 A formula can contain an optional mode string after a semicolon. This
2123 string consists of flags to influence Calc and other modes during
2124 execution. By default, Org uses the standard Calc modes (precision
2125 12, angular units degrees, fraction and symbolic modes off). The display
2126 format, however, has been changed to @code{(float 8)} to keep tables
2127 compact. The default settings can be configured using the variable
2128 @code{org-calc-default-modes}.
2131 p20 @r{switch the internal precision to 20 digits}
2132 n3 s3 e2 f4 @r{normal, scientific, engineering, or fixed display format}
2133 D R @r{angle modes: degrees, radians}
2134 F S @r{fraction and symbolic modes}
2135 N @r{interpret all fields as numbers, use 0 for non-numbers}
2136 T @r{force text interpretation}
2137 E @r{keep empty fields in ranges}
2142 In addition, you may provide a @code{printf} format specifier to
2143 reformat the final result. A few examples:
2146 $1+$2 @r{Sum of first and second field}
2147 $1+$2;%.2f @r{Same, format result to two decimals}
2148 exp($2)+exp($1) @r{Math functions can be used}
2149 $0;%.1f @r{Reformat current cell to 1 decimal}
2150 ($3-32)*5/9 @r{Degrees F -> C conversion}
2151 $c/$1/$cm @r{Hz -> cm conversion, using @file{constants.el}}
2152 tan($1);Dp3s1 @r{Compute in degrees, precision 3, display SCI 1}
2153 sin($1);Dp3%.1e @r{Same, but use printf specifier for display}
2154 vmean($2..$7) @r{Compute column range mean, using vector function}
2155 vmean($2..$7);EN @r{Same, but treat empty fields as 0}
2156 taylor($3,x=7,2) @r{taylor series of $3, at x=7, second degree}
2159 Calc also contains a complete set of logical operations. For example
2162 if($1<20,teen,string("")) @r{``teen'' if age $1 less than 20, else empty}
2165 @node Formula syntax for Lisp, Field formulas, Formula syntax for Calc, The spreadsheet
2166 @subsection Emacs Lisp forms as formulas
2167 @cindex Lisp forms, as table formulas
2169 It is also possible to write a formula in Emacs Lisp; this can be useful
2170 for string manipulation and control structures, if Calc's
2171 functionality is not enough. If a formula starts with a single-quote
2172 followed by an opening parenthesis, then it is evaluated as a Lisp form.
2173 The evaluation should return either a string or a number. Just as with
2174 @file{calc} formulas, you can specify modes and a printf format after a
2175 semicolon. With Emacs Lisp forms, you need to be conscious about the way
2176 field references are interpolated into the form. By default, a
2177 reference will be interpolated as a Lisp string (in double-quotes)
2178 containing the field. If you provide the @samp{N} mode switch, all
2179 referenced elements will be numbers (non-number fields will be zero) and
2180 interpolated as Lisp numbers, without quotes. If you provide the
2181 @samp{L} flag, all fields will be interpolated literally, without quotes.
2182 I.e., if you want a reference to be interpreted as a string by the Lisp
2183 form, enclose the reference operator itself in double-quotes, like
2184 @code{"$3"}. Ranges are inserted as space-separated fields, so you can
2185 embed them in list or vector syntax. A few examples, note how the
2186 @samp{N} mode is used when we do computations in Lisp.
2189 @r{Swap the first two characters of the content of column 1}
2190 '(concat (substring $1 1 2) (substring $1 0 1) (substring $1 2))
2191 @r{Add columns 1 and 2, equivalent to Calc's @code{$1+$2}}
2193 @r{Compute the sum of columns 1-4, like Calc's @code{vsum($1..$4)}}
2194 '(apply '+ '($1..$4));N
2197 @node Field formulas, Column formulas, Formula syntax for Lisp, The spreadsheet
2198 @subsection Field formulas
2199 @cindex field formula
2200 @cindex formula, for individual table field
2202 To assign a formula to a particular field, type it directly into the
2203 field, preceded by @samp{:=}, for example @samp{:=$1+$2}. When you
2204 press @key{TAB} or @key{RET} or @kbd{C-c C-c} with the cursor still in
2205 the field, the formula will be stored as the formula for this field,
2206 evaluated, and the current field replaced with the result.
2209 Formulas are stored in a special line starting with @samp{#+TBLFM:}
2210 directly below the table. If you typed the equation in the 4th field of
2211 the 3rd data line in the table, the formula will look like
2212 @samp{@@3$4=$1+$2}. When inserting/deleting/swapping column and rows
2213 with the appropriate commands, @i{absolute references} (but not relative
2214 ones) in stored formulas are modified in order to still reference the
2215 same field. Of course this is not true if you edit the table structure
2216 with normal editing commands---then you must fix the equations yourself.
2217 The left-hand side of a formula may also be a named field (@pxref{Advanced
2218 features}), or a last-row reference like @samp{$LR3}.
2220 Instead of typing an equation into the field, you may also use the
2226 Install a new formula for the current field. The command prompts for a
2227 formula with default taken from the @samp{#+TBLFM:} line, applies
2228 it to the current field, and stores it.
2231 @node Column formulas, Editing and debugging formulas, Field formulas, The spreadsheet
2232 @subsection Column formulas
2233 @cindex column formula
2234 @cindex formula, for table column
2236 Often in a table, the same formula should be used for all fields in a
2237 particular column. Instead of having to copy the formula to all fields
2238 in that column, Org allows you to assign a single formula to an entire
2239 column. If the table contains horizontal separator hlines, everything
2240 before the first such line is considered part of the table @emph{header}
2241 and will not be modified by column formulas.
2243 To assign a formula to a column, type it directly into any field in the
2244 column, preceded by an equal sign, like @samp{=$1+$2}. When you press
2245 @key{TAB} or @key{RET} or @kbd{C-c C-c} with the cursor still in the field,
2246 the formula will be stored as the formula for the current column, evaluated
2247 and the current field replaced with the result. If the field contains only
2248 @samp{=}, the previously stored formula for this column is used. For each
2249 column, Org will only remember the most recently used formula. In the
2250 @samp{#+TBLFM:} line, column formulas will look like @samp{$4=$1+$2}. The left-hand
2251 side of a column formula cannot currently be the name of column, it
2252 must be the numeric column reference.
2254 Instead of typing an equation into the field, you may also use the
2260 Install a new formula for the current column and replace current field with
2261 the result of the formula. The command prompts for a formula, with default
2262 taken from the @samp{#+TBLFM} line, applies it to the current field and
2263 stores it. With a numeric prefix argument(e.g. @kbd{C-5 C-c =}) the command
2264 will apply it to that many consecutive fields in the current column.
2267 @node Editing and debugging formulas, Updating the table, Column formulas, The spreadsheet
2268 @subsection Editing and debugging formulas
2269 @cindex formula editing
2270 @cindex editing, of table formulas
2272 @vindex org-table-use-standard-references
2273 You can edit individual formulas in the minibuffer or directly in the
2274 field. Org can also prepare a special buffer with all active
2275 formulas of a table. When offering a formula for editing, Org
2276 converts references to the standard format (like @code{B3} or @code{D&})
2277 if possible. If you prefer to only work with the internal format (like
2278 @code{@@3$2} or @code{$4}), configure the variable
2279 @code{org-table-use-standard-references}.
2286 Edit the formula associated with the current column/field in the
2287 minibuffer. See @ref{Column formulas}, and @ref{Field formulas}.
2288 @kindex C-u C-u C-c =
2290 Re-insert the active formula (either a
2291 field formula, or a column formula) into the current field, so that you
2292 can edit it directly in the field. The advantage over editing in the
2293 minibuffer is that you can use the command @kbd{C-c ?}.
2296 While editing a formula in a table field, highlight the field(s)
2297 referenced by the reference at the cursor position in the formula.
2300 Toggle the display of row and column numbers for a table, using
2301 overlays. These are updated each time the table is aligned; you can
2302 force it with @kbd{C-c C-c}.
2305 Toggle the formula debugger on and off. See below.
2308 Edit all formulas for the current table in a special buffer, where the
2309 formulas will be displayed one per line. If the current field has an
2310 active formula, the cursor in the formula editor will mark it.
2311 While inside the special buffer, Org will automatically highlight
2312 any field or range reference at the cursor position. You may edit,
2313 remove and add formulas, and use the following commands:
2319 Exit the formula editor and store the modified formulas. With @kbd{C-u}
2320 prefix, also apply the new formulas to the entire table.
2323 Exit the formula editor without installing changes.
2326 Toggle all references in the formula editor between standard (like
2327 @code{B3}) and internal (like @code{@@3$2}).
2330 Pretty-print or indent Lisp formula at point. When in a line containing
2331 a Lisp formula, format the formula according to Emacs Lisp rules.
2332 Another @key{TAB} collapses the formula back again. In the open
2333 formula, @key{TAB} re-indents just like in Emacs Lisp mode.
2336 Complete Lisp symbols, just like in Emacs Lisp mode.
2338 @kindex S-@key{down}
2339 @kindex S-@key{left}
2340 @kindex S-@key{right}
2341 @item S-@key{up}/@key{down}/@key{left}/@key{right}
2342 Shift the reference at point. For example, if the reference is
2343 @code{B3} and you press @kbd{S-@key{right}}, it will become @code{C3}.
2344 This also works for relative references and for hline references.
2345 @kindex M-S-@key{up}
2346 @kindex M-S-@key{down}
2347 @item M-S-@key{up}/@key{down}
2348 Move the test line for column formulas in the Org buffer up and
2351 @kindex M-@key{down}
2352 @item M-@key{up}/@key{down}
2353 Scroll the window displaying the table.
2356 Turn the coordinate grid in the table on and off.
2360 Making a table field blank does not remove the formula associated with
2361 the field, because that is stored in a different line (the @samp{#+TBLFM}
2362 line)---during the next recalculation the field will be filled again.
2363 To remove a formula from a field, you have to give an empty reply when
2364 prompted for the formula, or to edit the @samp{#+TBLFM} line.
2367 You may edit the @samp{#+TBLFM} directly and re-apply the changed
2368 equations with @kbd{C-c C-c} in that line or with the normal
2369 recalculation commands in the table.
2371 @subsubheading Debugging formulas
2372 @cindex formula debugging
2373 @cindex debugging, of table formulas
2374 When the evaluation of a formula leads to an error, the field content
2375 becomes the string @samp{#ERROR}. If you would like see what is going
2376 on during variable substitution and calculation in order to find a bug,
2377 turn on formula debugging in the @code{Tbl} menu and repeat the
2378 calculation, for example by pressing @kbd{C-u C-u C-c = @key{RET}} in a
2379 field. Detailed information will be displayed.
2381 @node Updating the table, Advanced features, Editing and debugging formulas, The spreadsheet
2382 @subsection Updating the table
2383 @cindex recomputing table fields
2384 @cindex updating, table
2386 Recalculation of a table is normally not automatic, but needs to be
2387 triggered by a command. See @ref{Advanced features}, for a way to make
2388 recalculation at least semi-automatic.
2390 In order to recalculate a line of a table or the entire table, use the
2396 Recalculate the current row by first applying the stored column formulas
2397 from left to right, and all field formulas in the current row.
2403 Recompute the entire table, line by line. Any lines before the first
2404 hline are left alone, assuming that these are part of the table header.
2406 @kindex C-u C-u C-c *
2407 @kindex C-u C-u C-c C-c
2409 @itemx C-u C-u C-c C-c
2410 Iterate the table by recomputing it until no further changes occur.
2411 This may be necessary if some computed fields use the value of other
2412 fields that are computed @i{later} in the calculation sequence.
2415 @node Advanced features, , Updating the table, The spreadsheet
2416 @subsection Advanced features
2418 If you want the recalculation of fields to happen automatically, or if
2419 you want to be able to assign @i{names} to fields and columns, you need
2420 to reserve the first column of the table for special marking characters.
2424 Rotate the calculation mark in first column through the states @samp{ },
2425 @samp{#}, @samp{*}, @samp{!}, @samp{$}. When there is an active region,
2426 change all marks in the region.
2429 Here is an example of a table that collects exam results of students and
2430 makes use of these features:
2434 |---+---------+--------+--------+--------+-------+------|
2435 | | Student | Prob 1 | Prob 2 | Prob 3 | Total | Note |
2436 |---+---------+--------+--------+--------+-------+------|
2437 | ! | | P1 | P2 | P3 | Tot | |
2438 | # | Maximum | 10 | 15 | 25 | 50 | 10.0 |
2439 | ^ | | m1 | m2 | m3 | mt | |
2440 |---+---------+--------+--------+--------+-------+------|
2441 | # | Peter | 10 | 8 | 23 | 41 | 8.2 |
2442 | # | Sam | 2 | 4 | 3 | 9 | 1.8 |
2443 |---+---------+--------+--------+--------+-------+------|
2444 | | Average | | | | 29.7 | |
2445 | ^ | | | | | at | |
2446 | $ | max=50 | | | | | |
2447 |---+---------+--------+--------+--------+-------+------|
2448 #+TBLFM: $6=vsum($P1..$P3)::$7=10*$Tot/$max;%.1f::$at=vmean(@@-II..@@-I);%.1f
2452 @noindent @b{Important}: please note that for these special tables,
2453 recalculating the table with @kbd{C-u C-c *} will only affect rows that
2454 are marked @samp{#} or @samp{*}, and fields that have a formula assigned
2455 to the field itself. The column formulas are not applied in rows with
2458 @cindex marking characters, tables
2459 The marking characters have the following meaning:
2462 The fields in this line define names for the columns, so that you may
2463 refer to a column as @samp{$Tot} instead of @samp{$6}.
2465 This row defines names for the fields @emph{above} the row. With such
2466 a definition, any formula in the table may use @samp{$m1} to refer to
2467 the value @samp{10}. Also, if you assign a formula to a names field, it
2468 will be stored as @samp{$name=...}.
2470 Similar to @samp{^}, but defines names for the fields in the row
2473 Fields in this row can define @emph{parameters} for formulas. For
2474 example, if a field in a @samp{$} row contains @samp{max=50}, then
2475 formulas in this table can refer to the value 50 using @samp{$max}.
2476 Parameters work exactly like constants, only that they can be defined on
2479 Fields in this row are automatically recalculated when pressing
2480 @key{TAB} or @key{RET} or @kbd{S-@key{TAB}} in this row. Also, this row
2481 is selected for a global recalculation with @kbd{C-u C-c *}. Unmarked
2482 lines will be left alone by this command.
2484 Selects this line for global recalculation with @kbd{C-u C-c *}, but
2485 not for automatic recalculation. Use this when automatic
2486 recalculation slows down editing too much.
2488 Unmarked lines are exempt from recalculation with @kbd{C-u C-c *}.
2489 All lines that should be recalculated should be marked with @samp{#}
2492 Do not export this line. Useful for lines that contain the narrowing
2493 @samp{<N>} markers or column group markers.
2496 Finally, just to whet your appetite for what can be done with the
2497 fantastic @file{calc.el} package, here is a table that computes the Taylor
2498 series of degree @code{n} at location @code{x} for a couple of
2503 |---+-------------+---+-----+--------------------------------------|
2504 | | Func | n | x | Result |
2505 |---+-------------+---+-----+--------------------------------------|
2506 | # | exp(x) | 1 | x | 1 + x |
2507 | # | exp(x) | 2 | x | 1 + x + x^2 / 2 |
2508 | # | exp(x) | 3 | x | 1 + x + x^2 / 2 + x^3 / 6 |
2509 | # | x^2+sqrt(x) | 2 | x=0 | x*(0.5 / 0) + x^2 (2 - 0.25 / 0) / 2 |
2510 | # | x^2+sqrt(x) | 2 | x=1 | 2 + 2.5 x - 2.5 + 0.875 (x - 1)^2 |
2511 | * | tan(x) | 3 | x | 0.0175 x + 1.77e-6 x^3 |
2512 |---+-------------+---+-----+--------------------------------------|
2513 #+TBLFM: $5=taylor($2,$4,$3);n3
2517 @node Org-Plot, , The spreadsheet, Tables
2519 @cindex graph, in tables
2520 @cindex plot tables using gnuplot
2523 Org-Plot can produce 2D and 3D graphs of information stored in org tables
2524 using @file{Gnuplot} @uref{http://www.gnuplot.info/} and @file{gnuplot-mode}
2525 @uref{http://cars9.uchicago.edu/~ravel/software/gnuplot-mode.html}. To see
2526 this in action, ensure that you have both Gnuplot and Gnuplot mode installed
2527 on your system, then call @code{org-plot/gnuplot} on the following table.
2531 #+PLOT: title:"Citas" ind:1 deps:(3) type:2d with:histograms set:"yrange [0:]"
2532 | Sede | Max cites | H-index |
2533 |-----------+-----------+---------|
2534 | Chile | 257.72 | 21.39 |
2535 | Leeds | 165.77 | 19.68 |
2536 | Sao Paolo | 71.00 | 11.50 |
2537 | Stockholm | 134.19 | 14.33 |
2538 | Morelia | 257.56 | 17.67 |
2542 Notice that Org Plot is smart enough to apply the table's headers as labels.
2543 Further control over the labels, type, content, and appearance of plots can
2544 be exercised through the @code{#+PLOT:} lines preceding a table. See below
2545 for a complete list of Org-plot options. For more information and examples
2546 see the Org-plot tutorial at
2547 @uref{http://orgmode.org/worg/org-tutorials/org-plot.php}.
2549 @subsubheading Plot Options
2553 Specify any @command{gnuplot} option to be set when graphing.
2556 Specify the title of the plot.
2559 Specify which column of the table to use as the @code{x} axis.
2562 Specify the columns to graph as a Lisp style list, surrounded by parentheses
2563 and separated by spaces for example @code{dep:(3 4)} to graph the third and
2564 fourth columns (defaults to graphing all other columns aside from the @code{ind}
2568 Specify whether the plot will be @code{2d}, @code{3d}, or @code{grid}.
2571 Specify a @code{with} option to be inserted for every col being plotted
2572 (e.g. @code{lines}, @code{points}, @code{boxes}, @code{impulses}, etc...).
2573 Defaults to @code{lines}.
2576 If you want to plot to a file, specify @code{"@var{path/to/desired/output-file}"}.
2579 List of labels to be used for the deps (defaults to the column headers if
2583 Specify an entire line to be inserted in the Gnuplot script.
2586 When plotting @code{3d} or @code{grid} types, set this to @code{t} to graph a
2587 flat mapping rather than a @code{3d} slope.
2590 Specify format of Org-mode timestamps as they will be parsed by Gnuplot.
2591 Defaults to @samp{%Y-%m-%d-%H:%M:%S}.
2594 If you want total control, you can specify a script file (place the file name
2595 between double-quotes) which will be used to plot. Before plotting, every
2596 instance of @code{$datafile} in the specified script will be replaced with
2597 the path to the generated data file. Note: even if you set this option, you
2598 may still want to specify the plot type, as that can impact the content of
2602 @node Hyperlinks, TODO Items, Tables, Top
2606 Like HTML, Org provides links inside a file, external links to
2607 other files, Usenet articles, emails, and much more.
2610 * Link format:: How links in Org are formatted
2611 * Internal links:: Links to other places in the current file
2612 * External links:: URL-like links to the world
2613 * Handling links:: Creating, inserting and following
2614 * Using links outside Org:: Linking from my C source code?
2615 * Link abbreviations:: Shortcuts for writing complex links
2616 * Search options:: Linking to a specific location
2617 * Custom searches:: When the default search is not enough
2620 @node Link format, Internal links, Hyperlinks, Hyperlinks
2621 @section Link format
2623 @cindex format, of links
2625 Org will recognize plain URL-like links and activate them as
2626 clickable links. The general link format, however, looks like this:
2629 [[link][description]] @r{or alternatively} [[link]]
2633 Once a link in the buffer is complete (all brackets present), Org
2634 will change the display so that @samp{description} is displayed instead
2635 of @samp{[[link][description]]} and @samp{link} is displayed instead of
2636 @samp{[[link]]}. Links will be highlighted in the face @code{org-link},
2637 which by default is an underlined face. You can directly edit the
2638 visible part of a link. Note that this can be either the @samp{link}
2639 part (if there is no description) or the @samp{description} part. To
2640 edit also the invisible @samp{link} part, use @kbd{C-c C-l} with the
2643 If you place the cursor at the beginning or just behind the end of the
2644 displayed text and press @key{BACKSPACE}, you will remove the
2645 (invisible) bracket at that location. This makes the link incomplete
2646 and the internals are again displayed as plain text. Inserting the
2647 missing bracket hides the link internals again. To show the
2648 internal structure of all links, use the menu entry
2649 @code{Org->Hyperlinks->Literal links}.
2651 @node Internal links, External links, Link format, Hyperlinks
2652 @section Internal links
2653 @cindex internal links
2654 @cindex links, internal
2655 @cindex targets, for links
2657 @cindex property, CUSTOM_ID
2658 If the link does not look like a URL, it is considered to be internal in the
2659 current file. The most important case is a link like
2660 @samp{[[#my-custom-id]]} which will link to the entry with the
2661 @code{CUSTOM_ID} property @samp{my-custom-id}. Such custom IDs are very good
2662 for HTML export (@pxref{HTML export}) where they produce pretty section
2663 links. You are responsible yourself to make sure these custom IDs are unique
2666 Links such as @samp{[[My Target]]} or @samp{[[My Target][Find my target]]}
2667 lead to a text search in the current file.
2669 The link can be followed with @kbd{C-c C-o} when the cursor is on the link,
2670 or with a mouse click (@pxref{Handling links}). Links to custom IDs will
2671 point to the corresponding headline. The preferred match for a text link is
2672 a @i{dedicated target}: the same string in double angular brackets. Targets
2673 may be located anywhere; sometimes it is convenient to put them into a
2674 comment line. For example
2680 @noindent In HTML export (@pxref{HTML export}), such targets will become
2681 named anchors for direct access through @samp{http} links@footnote{Note that
2682 text before the first headline is usually not exported, so the first such
2683 target should be after the first headline, or in the line directly before the
2686 If no dedicated target exists, Org will search for the words in the link. In
2687 the above example the search would be for @samp{my target}. Links starting
2688 with a star like @samp{*My Target} restrict the search to
2689 headlines@footnote{To insert a link targeting a headline, in-buffer
2690 completion can be used. Just type a star followed by a few optional letters
2691 into the buffer and press @kbd{M-@key{TAB}}. All headlines in the current
2692 buffer will be offered as completions. @xref{Handling links}, for more
2693 commands creating links.}. When searching, Org mode will first try an
2694 exact match, but then move on to more and more lenient searches. For
2695 example, the link @samp{[[*My Targets]]} will find any of the following:
2699 ** TODO my targets are bright
2700 ** my 20 targets are
2704 Following a link pushes a mark onto Org's own mark ring. You can
2705 return to the previous position with @kbd{C-c &}. Using this command
2706 several times in direct succession goes back to positions recorded
2710 * Radio targets:: Make targets trigger links in plain text
2713 @node Radio targets, , Internal links, Internal links
2714 @subsection Radio targets
2715 @cindex radio targets
2716 @cindex targets, radio
2717 @cindex links, radio targets
2719 Org can automatically turn any occurrences of certain target names
2720 in normal text into a link. So without explicitly creating a link, the
2721 text connects to the target radioing its position. Radio targets are
2722 enclosed by triple angular brackets. For example, a target @samp{<<<My
2723 Target>>>} causes each occurrence of @samp{my target} in normal text to
2724 become activated as a link. The Org file is scanned automatically
2725 for radio targets only when the file is first loaded into Emacs. To
2726 update the target list during editing, press @kbd{C-c C-c} with the
2727 cursor on or at a target.
2729 @node External links, Handling links, Internal links, Hyperlinks
2730 @section External links
2731 @cindex links, external
2732 @cindex external links
2733 @cindex links, external
2741 @cindex WANDERLUST links
2743 @cindex USENET links
2748 Org supports links to files, websites, Usenet and email messages,
2749 BBDB database entries and links to both IRC conversations and their
2750 logs. External links are URL-like locators. They start with a short
2751 identifying string followed by a colon. There can be no space after
2752 the colon. The following list shows examples for each link type.
2755 http://www.astro.uva.nl/~dominik @r{on the web}
2756 file:/home/dominik/images/jupiter.jpg @r{file, absolute path}
2757 /home/dominik/images/jupiter.jpg @r{same as above}
2758 file:papers/last.pdf @r{file, relative path}
2759 ./papers/last.pdf @r{same as above}
2760 file:sometextfile::NNN @r{file with line number to jump to}
2761 file:projects.org @r{another Org file}
2762 file:projects.org::some words @r{text search in Org file}
2763 file:projects.org::*task title @r{heading search in Org file}
2764 docview:papers/last.pdf::NNN @r{open file in doc-view mode at page NNN}
2765 id:B7423F4D-2E8A-471B-8810-C40F074717E9 @r{Link to heading by ID}
2766 news:comp.emacs @r{Usenet link}
2767 mailto:adent@@galaxy.net @r{Mail link}
2768 vm:folder @r{VM folder link}
2769 vm:folder#id @r{VM message link}
2770 vm://myself@@some.where.org/folder#id @r{VM on remote machine}
2771 wl:folder @r{WANDERLUST folder link}
2772 wl:folder#id @r{WANDERLUST message link}
2773 mhe:folder @r{MH-E folder link}
2774 mhe:folder#id @r{MH-E message link}
2775 rmail:folder @r{RMAIL folder link}
2776 rmail:folder#id @r{RMAIL message link}
2777 gnus:group @r{Gnus group link}
2778 gnus:group#id @r{Gnus article link}
2779 bbdb:R.*Stallman @r{BBDB link (with regexp)}
2780 irc:/irc.com/#emacs/bob @r{IRC link}
2781 shell:ls *.org @r{A shell command}
2782 elisp:org-agenda @r{Interactive Elisp command}
2783 elisp:(find-file-other-frame "Elisp.org") @r{Elisp form to evaluate}
2786 A link should be enclosed in double brackets and may contain a
2787 descriptive text to be displayed instead of the URL (@pxref{Link
2788 format}), for example:
2791 [[http://www.gnu.org/software/emacs/][GNU Emacs]]
2795 If the description is a file name or URL that points to an image, HTML
2796 export (@pxref{HTML export}) will inline the image as a clickable
2797 button. If there is no description at all and the link points to an
2799 that image will be inlined into the exported HTML file.
2801 @cindex square brackets, around links
2802 @cindex plain text external links
2803 Org also finds external links in the normal text and activates them
2804 as links. If spaces must be part of the link (for example in
2805 @samp{bbdb:Richard Stallman}), or if you need to remove ambiguities
2806 about the end of the link, enclose them in square brackets.
2808 @node Handling links, Using links outside Org, External links, Hyperlinks
2809 @section Handling links
2810 @cindex links, handling
2812 Org provides methods to create a link in the correct syntax, to
2813 insert it into an Org file, and to follow the link.
2817 @cindex storing links
2819 Store a link to the current location. This is a @emph{global} command (you
2820 must create the key binding yourself) which can be used in any buffer to
2821 create a link. The link will be stored for later insertion into an Org
2822 buffer (see below). What kind of link will be created depends on the current
2825 @b{Org-mode buffers}@*
2826 For Org files, if there is a @samp{<<target>>} at the cursor, the link points
2827 to the target. Otherwise it points to the current headline, which will also
2830 @vindex org-link-to-org-use-id
2831 @cindex property, CUSTOM_ID
2832 @cindex property, ID
2833 If the headline has a @code{CUSTOM_ID} property, a link to this custom ID
2834 will be stored. In addition or alternatively (depending on the value of
2835 @code{org-link-to-org-use-id}), a globally unique @code{ID} property will be
2836 created and/or used to construct a link. So using this command in Org
2837 buffers will potentially create two links: a human-readable from the custom
2838 ID, and one that is globally unique and works even if the entry is moved from
2839 file to file. Later, when inserting the link, you need to decide which one
2842 @b{Email/News clients: VM, Rmail, Wanderlust, MH-E, Gnus}@*
2843 Pretty much all Emacs mail clients are supported. The link will point to the
2844 current article, or, in some GNUS buffers, to the group. The description is
2845 constructed from the author and the subject.
2847 @b{Web browsers: W3 and W3M}@*
2848 Here the link will be the current URL, with the page title as description.
2850 @b{Contacts: BBDB}@*
2851 Links created in a BBDB buffer will point to the current entry.
2854 @vindex org-irc-link-to-logs
2855 For IRC links, if you set the variable @code{org-irc-link-to-logs} to
2856 @code{t}, a @samp{file:/} style link to the relevant point in the logs for
2857 the current conversation is created. Otherwise an @samp{irc:/} style link to
2858 the user/channel/server under the point will be stored.
2861 For any other files, the link will point to the file, with a search string
2862 (@pxref{Search options}) pointing to the contents of the current line. If
2863 there is an active region, the selected words will form the basis of the
2864 search string. If the automatically created link is not working correctly or
2865 accurately enough, you can write custom functions to select the search string
2866 and to do the search for particular file types---see @ref{Custom searches}.
2867 The key binding @kbd{C-c l} is only a suggestion---see @ref{Installation}.
2870 When the cursor is in an agenda view, the created link points to the
2871 entry referenced by the current line.
2875 @cindex link completion
2876 @cindex completion, of links
2877 @cindex inserting links
2879 @vindex org-keep-stored-link-after-insertion
2880 Insert a link@footnote{ Note that you don't have to use this command to
2881 insert a link. Links in Org are plain text, and you can type or paste them
2882 straight into the buffer. By using this command, the links are automatically
2883 enclosed in double brackets, and you will be asked for the optional
2884 descriptive text.}. This prompts for a link to be inserted into the buffer.
2885 You can just type a link, using text for an internal link, or one of the link
2886 type prefixes mentioned in the examples above. The link will be inserted
2887 into the buffer@footnote{After insertion of a stored link, the link will be
2888 removed from the list of stored links. To keep it in the list later use, use
2889 a triple @kbd{C-u} prefix argument to @kbd{C-c C-l}, or configure the option
2890 @code{org-keep-stored-link-after-insertion}.}, along with a descriptive text.
2891 If some text was selected when this command is called, the selected text
2892 becomes the default description.
2894 @b{Inserting stored links}@*
2895 All links stored during the
2896 current session are part of the history for this prompt, so you can access
2897 them with @key{up} and @key{down} (or @kbd{M-p/n}).
2899 @b{Completion support}@* Completion with @key{TAB} will help you to insert
2900 valid link prefixes like @samp{http:} or @samp{ftp:}, including the prefixes
2901 defined through link abbreviations (@pxref{Link abbreviations}). If you
2902 press @key{RET} after inserting only the @var{prefix}, Org will offer
2903 specific completion support for some link types@footnote{This works by
2904 calling a special function @code{org-PREFIX-complete-link}.} For
2905 example, if you type @kbd{file @key{RET}}, file name completion (alternative
2906 access: @kbd{C-u C-c C-l}, see below) will be offered, and after @kbd{bbdb
2907 @key{RET}} you can complete contact names.
2909 @cindex file name completion
2910 @cindex completion, of file names
2912 When @kbd{C-c C-l} is called with a @kbd{C-u} prefix argument, a link to
2913 a file will be inserted and you may use file name completion to select
2914 the name of the file. The path to the file is inserted relative to the
2915 directory of the current Org file, if the linked file is in the current
2916 directory or in a sub-directory of it, or if the path is written relative
2917 to the current directory using @samp{../}. Otherwise an absolute path
2918 is used, if possible with @samp{~/} for your home directory. You can
2919 force an absolute path with two @kbd{C-u} prefixes.
2921 @item C-c C-l @r{(with cursor on existing link)}
2922 When the cursor is on an existing link, @kbd{C-c C-l} allows you to edit the
2923 link and description parts of the link.
2925 @cindex following links
2928 @item C-c C-o @r{or} @key{RET}
2929 @vindex org-file-apps
2930 Open link at point. This will launch a web browser for URLs (using
2931 @command{browse-url-at-point}), run VM/MH-E/Wanderlust/Rmail/Gnus/BBDB for
2932 the corresponding links, and execute the command in a shell link. When the
2933 cursor is on an internal link, this commands runs the corresponding search.
2934 When the cursor is on a TAG list in a headline, it creates the corresponding
2935 TAGS view. If the cursor is on a timestamp, it compiles the agenda for that
2936 date. Furthermore, it will visit text and remote files in @samp{file:} links
2937 with Emacs and select a suitable application for local non-text files.
2938 Classification of files is based on file extension only. See option
2939 @code{org-file-apps}. If you want to override the default application and
2940 visit the file with Emacs, use a @kbd{C-u} prefix. If you want to avoid
2941 opening in Emacs, use a @kbd{C-u C-u} prefix.@*
2942 If the cursor is on a headline, but not on a link, offer all links in the
2943 headline and entry text.
2949 On links, @kbd{mouse-2} will open the link just as @kbd{C-c C-o}
2950 would. Under Emacs 22, @kbd{mouse-1} will also follow a link.
2954 @vindex org-display-internal-link-with-indirect-buffer
2955 Like @kbd{mouse-2}, but force file links to be opened with Emacs, and
2956 internal links to be displayed in another window@footnote{See the
2957 variable @code{org-display-internal-link-with-indirect-buffer}}.
2962 Push the current position onto the mark ring, to be able to return
2963 easily. Commands following an internal link do this automatically.
2965 @cindex links, returning to
2968 Jump back to a recorded position. A position is recorded by the
2969 commands following internal links, and by @kbd{C-c %}. Using this
2970 command several times in direct succession moves through a ring of
2971 previously recorded positions.
2975 @cindex links, finding next/previous
2978 Move forward/backward to the next link in the buffer. At the limit of
2979 the buffer, the search fails once, and then wraps around. The key
2980 bindings for this are really too long, you might want to bind this also
2981 to @kbd{C-n} and @kbd{C-p}
2983 (add-hook 'org-load-hook
2985 (define-key 'org-mode-map "\C-n" 'org-next-link)
2986 (define-key 'org-mode-map "\C-p" 'org-previous-link)))
2990 @node Using links outside Org, Link abbreviations, Handling links, Hyperlinks
2991 @section Using links outside Org
2993 You can insert and follow links that have Org syntax not only in
2994 Org, but in any Emacs buffer. For this, you should create two
2995 global commands, like this (please select suitable global keys
2999 (global-set-key "\C-c L" 'org-insert-link-global)
3000 (global-set-key "\C-c o" 'org-open-at-point-global)
3003 @node Link abbreviations, Search options, Using links outside Org, Hyperlinks
3004 @section Link abbreviations
3005 @cindex link abbreviations
3006 @cindex abbreviation, links
3008 Long URLs can be cumbersome to type, and often many similar links are
3009 needed in a document. For this you can use link abbreviations. An
3010 abbreviated link looks like this
3013 [[linkword:tag][description]]
3017 @vindex org-link-abbrev-alist
3018 where the tag is optional. The @i{linkword} must be a word; letter, numbers,
3019 @samp{-}, and @samp{_} are allowed here. Abbreviations are resolved
3020 according to the information in the variable @code{org-link-abbrev-alist}
3021 that relates the linkwords to replacement text. Here is an example:
3025 (setq org-link-abbrev-alist
3026 '(("bugzilla" . "http://10.1.2.9/bugzilla/show_bug.cgi?id=")
3027 ("google" . "http://www.google.com/search?q=")
3028 ("ads" . "http://adsabs.harvard.edu/cgi-bin/
3029 nph-abs_connect?author=%s&db_key=AST")))
3033 If the replacement text contains the string @samp{%s}, it will be
3034 replaced with the tag. Otherwise the tag will be appended to the string
3035 in order to create the link. You may also specify a function that will
3036 be called with the tag as the only argument to create the link.
3038 With the above setting, you could link to a specific bug with
3039 @code{[[bugzilla:129]]}, search the web for @samp{OrgMode} with
3040 @code{[[google:OrgMode]]} and find out what the Org author is
3041 doing besides Emacs hacking with @code{[[ads:Dominik,C]]}.
3043 If you need special abbreviations just for a single Org buffer, you
3044 can define them in the file with
3048 #+LINK: bugzilla http://10.1.2.9/bugzilla/show_bug.cgi?id=
3049 #+LINK: google http://www.google.com/search?q=%s
3053 In-buffer completion (@pxref{Completion}) can be used after @samp{[} to
3054 complete link abbreviations. You may also define a function
3055 @code{org-PREFIX-complete-link} that implements special (e.g. completion)
3056 support for inserting such a link with @kbd{C-c C-l}. Such a function should
3057 not accept any arguments, and return the full link with prefix.
3059 @node Search options, Custom searches, Link abbreviations, Hyperlinks
3060 @section Search options in file links
3061 @cindex search option in file links
3062 @cindex file links, searching
3064 File links can contain additional information to make Emacs jump to a
3065 particular location in the file when following a link. This can be a
3066 line number or a search option after a double@footnote{For backward
3067 compatibility, line numbers can also follow a single colon.} colon. For
3068 example, when the command @kbd{C-c l} creates a link (@pxref{Handling
3069 links}) to a file, it encodes the words in the current line as a search
3070 string that can be used to find this line back later when following the
3071 link with @kbd{C-c C-o}.
3073 Here is the syntax of the different ways to attach a search to a file
3074 link, together with an explanation:
3077 [[file:~/code/main.c::255]]
3078 [[file:~/xx.org::My Target]]
3079 [[file:~/xx.org::*My Target]]
3080 [[file:~/xx.org::/regexp/]]
3087 Search for a link target @samp{<<My Target>>}, or do a text search for
3088 @samp{my target}, similar to the search in internal links, see
3089 @ref{Internal links}. In HTML export (@pxref{HTML export}), such a file
3090 link will become an HTML reference to the corresponding named anchor in
3093 In an Org file, restrict search to headlines.
3095 Do a regular expression search for @code{regexp}. This uses the Emacs
3096 command @code{occur} to list all matches in a separate window. If the
3097 target file is in Org mode, @code{org-occur} is used to create a
3098 sparse tree with the matches.
3099 @c If the target file is a directory,
3100 @c @code{grep} will be used to search all files in the directory.
3103 As a degenerate case, a file link with an empty file name can be used
3104 to search the current file. For example, @code{[[file:::find me]]} does
3105 a search for @samp{find me} in the current file, just as
3106 @samp{[[find me]]} would.
3108 @node Custom searches, , Search options, Hyperlinks
3109 @section Custom Searches
3110 @cindex custom search strings
3111 @cindex search strings, custom
3113 The default mechanism for creating search strings and for doing the
3114 actual search related to a file link may not work correctly in all
3115 cases. For example, Bib@TeX{} database files have many entries like
3116 @samp{year="1993"} which would not result in good search strings,
3117 because the only unique identification for a Bib@TeX{} entry is the
3120 @vindex org-create-file-search-functions
3121 @vindex org-execute-file-search-functions
3122 If you come across such a problem, you can write custom functions to set
3123 the right search string for a particular file type, and to do the search
3124 for the string in the file. Using @code{add-hook}, these functions need
3125 to be added to the hook variables
3126 @code{org-create-file-search-functions} and
3127 @code{org-execute-file-search-functions}. See the docstring for these
3128 variables for more information. Org actually uses this mechanism
3129 for Bib@TeX{} database files, and you can use the corresponding code as
3130 an implementation example. See the file @file{org-bibtex.el}.
3132 @node TODO Items, Tags, Hyperlinks, Top
3136 Org mode does not maintain TODO lists as separate documents@footnote{Of
3137 course, you can make a document that contains only long lists of TODO items,
3138 but this is not required.}. Instead, TODO items are an integral part of the
3139 notes file, because TODO items usually come up while taking notes! With Org
3140 mode, simply mark any entry in a tree as being a TODO item. In this way,
3141 information is not duplicated, and the entire context from which the TODO
3142 item emerged is always present.
3144 Of course, this technique for managing TODO items scatters them
3145 throughout your notes file. Org mode compensates for this by providing
3146 methods to give you an overview of all the things that you have to do.
3149 * TODO basics:: Marking and displaying TODO entries
3150 * TODO extensions:: Workflow and assignments
3151 * Progress logging:: Dates and notes for progress
3152 * Priorities:: Some things are more important than others
3153 * Breaking down tasks:: Splitting a task into manageable pieces
3154 * Checkboxes:: Tick-off lists
3157 @node TODO basics, TODO extensions, TODO Items, TODO Items
3158 @section Basic TODO functionality
3160 Any headline becomes a TODO item when it starts with the word
3161 @samp{TODO}, for example:
3164 *** TODO Write letter to Sam Fortune
3168 The most important commands to work with TODO entries are:
3172 @cindex cycling, of TODO states
3174 Rotate the TODO state of the current item among
3177 ,-> (unmarked) -> TODO -> DONE --.
3178 '--------------------------------'
3181 The same rotation can also be done ``remotely'' from the timeline and
3182 agenda buffers with the @kbd{t} command key (@pxref{Agenda commands}).
3186 Select a specific keyword using completion or (if it has been set up)
3187 the fast selection interface. For the latter, you need to assign keys
3188 to TODO states, see @ref{Per-file keywords}, and @ref{Setting tags}, for
3191 @kindex S-@key{right}
3192 @kindex S-@key{left}
3193 @vindex org-treat-S-cursor-todo-selection-as-state-change
3196 Select the following/preceding TODO state, similar to cycling. Useful
3197 mostly if more than two TODO states are possible (@pxref{TODO
3198 extensions}). See also @ref{Conflicts}, for a discussion of the interaction
3199 with @code{shift-selection-mode}. See also the variable
3200 @code{org-treat-S-cursor-todo-selection-as-state-change}.
3203 @cindex sparse tree, for TODO
3206 @vindex org-todo-keywords
3207 View TODO items in a @emph{sparse tree} (@pxref{Sparse trees}). Folds the
3208 entire buffer, but shows all TODO items and the headings hierarchy above
3209 them. With a prefix argument, search for a specific TODO. You will be
3210 prompted for the keyword, and you can also give a list of keywords like
3211 @code{KWD1|KWD2|...} to list entries that match any one of these keywords.
3212 With numeric prefix argument N, show the tree for the Nth keyword in the
3213 variable @code{org-todo-keywords}. With two prefix arguments, find all TODO
3217 Show the global TODO list. Collects the TODO items from all agenda
3218 files (@pxref{Agenda Views}) into a single buffer. The new buffer will
3219 be in @code{agenda-mode}, which provides commands to examine and
3220 manipulate the TODO entries from the new buffer (@pxref{Agenda
3221 commands}). @xref{Global TODO list}, for more information.
3222 @kindex S-M-@key{RET}
3224 Insert a new TODO entry below the current one.
3228 @vindex org-todo-state-tags-triggers
3229 Changing a TODO state can also trigger tag changes. See the docstring of the
3230 option @code{org-todo-state-tags-triggers} for details.
3232 @node TODO extensions, Progress logging, TODO basics, TODO Items
3233 @section Extended use of TODO keywords
3234 @cindex extended TODO keywords
3236 @vindex org-todo-keywords
3237 By default, marked TODO entries have one of only two states: TODO and
3238 DONE. Org mode allows you to classify TODO items in more complex ways
3239 with @emph{TODO keywords} (stored in @code{org-todo-keywords}). With
3240 special setup, the TODO keyword system can work differently in different
3243 Note that @i{tags} are another way to classify headlines in general and
3244 TODO items in particular (@pxref{Tags}).
3247 * Workflow states:: From TODO to DONE in steps
3248 * TODO types:: I do this, Fred does the rest
3249 * Multiple sets in one file:: Mixing it all, and still finding your way
3250 * Fast access to TODO states:: Single letter selection of a state
3251 * Per-file keywords:: Different files, different requirements
3252 * Faces for TODO keywords:: Highlighting states
3253 * TODO dependencies:: When one task needs to wait for others
3256 @node Workflow states, TODO types, TODO extensions, TODO extensions
3257 @subsection TODO keywords as workflow states
3258 @cindex TODO workflow
3259 @cindex workflow states as TODO keywords
3261 You can use TODO keywords to indicate different @emph{sequential} states
3262 in the process of working on an item, for example@footnote{Changing
3263 this variable only becomes effective after restarting Org mode in a
3267 (setq org-todo-keywords
3268 '((sequence "TODO" "FEEDBACK" "VERIFY" "|" "DONE" "DELEGATED")))
3271 The vertical bar separates the TODO keywords (states that @emph{need
3272 action}) from the DONE states (which need @emph{no further action}). If
3273 you don't provide the separator bar, the last state is used as the DONE
3275 @cindex completion, of TODO keywords
3276 With this setup, the command @kbd{C-c C-t} will cycle an entry from TODO
3277 to FEEDBACK, then to VERIFY, and finally to DONE and DELEGATED. You may
3278 also use a numeric prefix argument to quickly select a specific state. For
3279 example @kbd{C-3 C-c C-t} will change the state immediately to VERIFY.
3280 Or you can use @kbd{S-@key{left}} to go backward through the sequence. If you
3281 define many keywords, you can use in-buffer completion
3282 (@pxref{Completion}) or even a special one-key selection scheme
3283 (@pxref{Fast access to TODO states}) to insert these words into the
3284 buffer. Changing a TODO state can be logged with a timestamp, see
3285 @ref{Tracking TODO state changes}, for more information.
3287 @node TODO types, Multiple sets in one file, Workflow states, TODO extensions
3288 @subsection TODO keywords as types
3290 @cindex names as TODO keywords
3291 @cindex types as TODO keywords
3293 The second possibility is to use TODO keywords to indicate different
3294 @emph{types} of action items. For example, you might want to indicate
3295 that items are for ``work'' or ``home''. Or, when you work with several
3296 people on a single project, you might want to assign action items
3297 directly to persons, by using their names as TODO keywords. This would
3298 be set up like this:
3301 (setq org-todo-keywords '((type "Fred" "Sara" "Lucy" "|" "DONE")))
3304 In this case, different keywords do not indicate a sequence, but rather
3305 different types. So the normal work flow would be to assign a task to a
3306 person, and later to mark it DONE. Org mode supports this style by adapting
3307 the workings of the command @kbd{C-c C-t}@footnote{This is also true for the
3308 @kbd{t} command in the timeline and agenda buffers.}. When used several
3309 times in succession, it will still cycle through all names, in order to first
3310 select the right type for a task. But when you return to the item after some
3311 time and execute @kbd{C-c C-t} again, it will switch from any name directly
3312 to DONE. Use prefix arguments or completion to quickly select a specific
3313 name. You can also review the items of a specific TODO type in a sparse tree
3314 by using a numeric prefix to @kbd{C-c C-v}. For example, to see all things
3315 Lucy has to do, you would use @kbd{C-3 C-c C-v}. To collect Lucy's items
3316 from all agenda files into a single buffer, you would use the numeric prefix
3317 argument as well when creating the global TODO list: @kbd{C-3 C-c t}.
3319 @node Multiple sets in one file, Fast access to TODO states, TODO types, TODO extensions
3320 @subsection Multiple keyword sets in one file
3321 @cindex TODO keyword sets
3323 Sometimes you may want to use different sets of TODO keywords in
3324 parallel. For example, you may want to have the basic
3325 @code{TODO}/@code{DONE}, but also a workflow for bug fixing, and a
3326 separate state indicating that an item has been canceled (so it is not
3327 DONE, but also does not require action). Your setup would then look
3331 (setq org-todo-keywords
3332 '((sequence "TODO" "|" "DONE")
3333 (sequence "REPORT" "BUG" "KNOWNCAUSE" "|" "FIXED")
3334 (sequence "|" "CANCELED")))
3337 The keywords should all be different, this helps Org mode to keep track
3338 of which subsequence should be used for a given entry. In this setup,
3339 @kbd{C-c C-t} only operates within a subsequence, so it switches from
3340 @code{DONE} to (nothing) to @code{TODO}, and from @code{FIXED} to
3341 (nothing) to @code{REPORT}. Therefore you need a mechanism to initially
3342 select the correct sequence. Besides the obvious ways like typing a
3343 keyword or using completion, you may also apply the following commands:
3346 @kindex C-S-@key{right}
3347 @kindex C-S-@key{left}
3348 @kindex C-u C-u C-c C-t
3349 @item C-u C-u C-c C-t
3350 @itemx C-S-@key{right}
3351 @itemx C-S-@key{left}
3352 These keys jump from one TODO subset to the next. In the above example,
3353 @kbd{C-u C-u C-c C-t} or @kbd{C-S-@key{right}} would jump from @code{TODO} or
3354 @code{DONE} to @code{REPORT}, and any of the words in the second row to
3355 @code{CANCELED}. Note that the @kbd{C-S-} key binding conflict with
3356 @code{shift-selection-mode} (@pxref{Conflicts}).
3357 @kindex S-@key{right}
3358 @kindex S-@key{left}
3361 @kbd{S-@key{<left>}} and @kbd{S-@key{<right>}} and walk through @emph{all}
3362 keywords from all sets, so for example @kbd{S-@key{<right>}} would switch
3363 from @code{DONE} to @code{REPORT} in the example above. See also
3364 @ref{Conflicts}, for a discussion of the interaction with
3365 @code{shift-selection-mode}.
3368 @node Fast access to TODO states, Per-file keywords, Multiple sets in one file, TODO extensions
3369 @subsection Fast access to TODO states
3371 If you would like to quickly change an entry to an arbitrary TODO state
3372 instead of cycling through the states, you can set up keys for
3373 single-letter access to the states. This is done by adding the section
3374 key after each keyword, in parentheses. For example:
3377 (setq org-todo-keywords
3378 '((sequence "TODO(t)" "|" "DONE(d)")
3379 (sequence "REPORT(r)" "BUG(b)" "KNOWNCAUSE(k)" "|" "FIXED(f)")
3380 (sequence "|" "CANCELED(c)")))
3383 @vindex org-fast-tag-selection-include-todo
3384 If you then press @code{C-c C-t} followed by the selection key, the entry
3385 will be switched to this state. @key{SPC} can be used to remove any TODO
3386 keyword from an entry.@footnote{Check also the variable
3387 @code{org-fast-tag-selection-include-todo}, it allows you to change the TODO
3388 state through the tags interface (@pxref{Setting tags}), in case you like to
3389 mingle the two concepts. Note that this means you need to come up with
3390 unique keys across both sets of keywords.}
3392 @node Per-file keywords, Faces for TODO keywords, Fast access to TODO states, TODO extensions
3393 @subsection Setting up keywords for individual files
3394 @cindex keyword options
3395 @cindex per-file keywords
3400 It can be very useful to use different aspects of the TODO mechanism in
3401 different files. For file-local settings, you need to add special lines
3402 to the file which set the keywords and interpretation for that file
3403 only. For example, to set one of the two examples discussed above, you
3404 need one of the following lines, starting in column zero anywhere in the
3408 #+TODO: TODO FEEDBACK VERIFY | DONE CANCELED
3410 @noindent (you may also write @code{#+SEQ_TODO} to be explicit about the
3411 interpretation, but it means the same as @code{#+TODO}), or
3413 #+TYP_TODO: Fred Sara Lucy Mike | DONE
3416 A setup for using several sets in parallel would be:
3420 #+TODO: REPORT BUG KNOWNCAUSE | FIXED
3424 @cindex completion, of option keywords
3426 @noindent To make sure you are using the correct keyword, type
3427 @samp{#+} into the buffer and then use @kbd{M-@key{TAB}} completion.
3429 @cindex DONE, final TODO keyword
3430 Remember that the keywords after the vertical bar (or the last keyword
3431 if no bar is there) must always mean that the item is DONE (although you
3432 may use a different word). After changing one of these lines, use
3433 @kbd{C-c C-c} with the cursor still in the line to make the changes
3434 known to Org mode@footnote{Org mode parses these lines only when
3435 Org mode is activated after visiting a file. @kbd{C-c C-c} with the
3436 cursor in a line starting with @samp{#+} is simply restarting Org mode
3437 for the current buffer.}.
3439 @node Faces for TODO keywords, TODO dependencies, Per-file keywords, TODO extensions
3440 @subsection Faces for TODO keywords
3441 @cindex faces, for TODO keywords
3443 @vindex org-todo @r{(face)}
3444 @vindex org-done @r{(face)}
3445 @vindex org-todo-keyword-faces
3446 Org mode highlights TODO keywords with special faces: @code{org-todo}
3447 for keywords indicating that an item still has to be acted upon, and
3448 @code{org-done} for keywords indicating that an item is finished. If
3449 you are using more than 2 different states, you might want to use
3450 special faces for some of them. This can be done using the variable
3451 @code{org-todo-keyword-faces}. For example:
3455 (setq org-todo-keyword-faces
3456 '(("TODO" . org-warning)
3457 ("DEFERRED" . shadow)
3458 ("CANCELED" . (:foreground "blue" :weight bold))))
3462 While using a list with face properties as shown for CANCELED
3463 @emph{should} work, this does not aways seem to be the case. If
3464 necessary, define a special face and use that.
3466 @node TODO dependencies, , Faces for TODO keywords, TODO extensions
3467 @subsection TODO dependencies
3468 @cindex TODO dependencies
3469 @cindex dependencies, of TODO states
3471 @vindex org-enforce-todo-dependencies
3472 @cindex property, ORDERED
3473 The structure of Org files (hierarchy and lists) makes it easy to define TODO
3474 dependencies. Usually, a parent TODO task should not be marked DONE until
3475 all subtasks (defined as children tasks) are marked as DONE. And sometimes
3476 there is a logical sequence to a number of (sub)tasks, so that one task
3477 cannot be acted upon before all siblings above it are done. If you customize
3478 the variable @code{org-enforce-todo-dependencies}, Org will block entries
3479 from changing state to DONE while they have children that are not DONE.
3480 Furthermore, if an entry has a property @code{ORDERED}, each of its children
3481 will be blocked until all earlier siblings are marked DONE. Here is an
3485 * TODO Blocked until (two) is done
3494 ** TODO b, needs to wait for (a)
3495 ** TODO c, needs to wait for (a) and (b)
3501 @vindex org-track-ordered-property-with-tag
3502 @cindex property, ORDERED
3503 Toggle the @code{ORDERED} property of the current entry. A property is used
3504 for this behavior because this should be local to the current entry, not
3505 inherited like a tag. However, if you would like to @i{track} the value of
3506 this property with a tag for better visibility, customize the variable
3507 @code{org-track-ordered-property-with-tag}.
3508 @kindex C-u C-u C-u C-c C-t
3509 @item C-u C-u C-u C-c C-t
3510 Change TODO state, circumventing any state blocking.
3513 @vindex org-agenda-dim-blocked-tasks
3514 If you set the variable @code{org-agenda-dim-blocked-tasks}, TODO entries
3515 that cannot be closed because of such dependencies will be shown in a dimmed
3516 font or even made invisible in agenda views (@pxref{Agenda Views}).
3518 @cindex checkboxes and TODO dependencies
3519 @vindex org-enforce-todo-dependencies
3520 You can also block changes of TODO states by looking at checkboxes
3521 (@pxref{Checkboxes}). If you set the variable
3522 @code{org-enforce-todo-checkbox-dependencies}, an entry that has unchecked
3523 checkboxes will be blocked from switching to DONE.
3525 If you need more complex dependency structures, for example dependencies
3526 between entries in different trees or files, check out the contributed
3527 module @file{org-depend.el}.
3530 @node Progress logging, Priorities, TODO extensions, TODO Items
3531 @section Progress logging
3532 @cindex progress logging
3533 @cindex logging, of progress
3535 Org mode can automatically record a timestamp and possibly a note when
3536 you mark a TODO item as DONE, or even each time you change the state of
3537 a TODO item. This system is highly configurable, settings can be on a
3538 per-keyword basis and can be localized to a file or even a subtree. For
3539 information on how to clock working time for a task, see @ref{Clocking
3543 * Closing items:: When was this entry marked DONE?
3544 * Tracking TODO state changes:: When did the status change?
3545 * Tracking your habits:: How consistent have you been?
3548 @node Closing items, Tracking TODO state changes, Progress logging, Progress logging
3549 @subsection Closing items
3551 The most basic logging is to keep track of @emph{when} a certain TODO
3552 item was finished. This is achieved with@footnote{The corresponding
3553 in-buffer setting is: @code{#+STARTUP: logdone}}.
3556 (setq org-log-done 'time)
3560 Then each time you turn an entry from a TODO (not-done) state into any
3561 of the DONE states, a line @samp{CLOSED: [timestamp]} will be inserted
3562 just after the headline. If you turn the entry back into a TODO item
3563 through further state cycling, that line will be removed again. If you
3564 want to record a note along with the timestamp, use@footnote{The
3565 corresponding in-buffer setting is: @code{#+STARTUP: lognotedone}}
3568 (setq org-log-done 'note)
3572 You will then be prompted for a note, and that note will be stored below
3573 the entry with a @samp{Closing Note} heading.
3575 In the timeline (@pxref{Timeline}) and in the agenda
3576 (@pxref{Weekly/daily agenda}), you can then use the @kbd{l} key to
3577 display the TODO items with a @samp{CLOSED} timestamp on each day,
3578 giving you an overview of what has been done.
3580 @node Tracking TODO state changes, Tracking your habits, Closing items, Progress logging
3581 @subsection Tracking TODO state changes
3582 @cindex drawer, for state change recording
3584 @vindex org-log-states-order-reversed
3585 @vindex org-log-into-drawer
3586 @cindex property, LOG_INTO_DRAWER
3587 When TODO keywords are used as workflow states (@pxref{Workflow states}), you
3588 might want to keep track of when a state change occurred and maybe take a
3589 note about this change. You can either record just a timestamp, or a
3590 time-stamped note for a change. These records will be inserted after the
3591 headline as an itemized list, newest first@footnote{See the variable
3592 @code{org-log-states-order-reversed}}. When taking a lot of notes, you might
3593 want to get the notes out of the way into a drawer (@pxref{Drawers}).
3594 Customize the variable @code{org-log-into-drawer} to get this
3595 behavior---the recommended drawer for this is called @code{LOGBOOK}. You can
3596 also overrule the setting of this variable for a subtree by setting a
3597 @code{LOG_INTO_DRAWER} property.
3599 Since it is normally too much to record a note for every state, Org mode
3600 expects configuration on a per-keyword basis for this. This is achieved by
3601 adding special markers @samp{!} (for a timestamp) and @samp{@@} (for a note)
3602 in parentheses after each keyword. For example, with the setting
3605 (setq org-todo-keywords
3606 '((sequence "TODO(t)" "WAIT(w@@/!)" "|" "DONE(d!)" "CANCELED(c@@)")))
3610 @vindex org-log-done
3611 you not only define global TODO keywords and fast access keys, but also
3612 request that a time is recorded when the entry is set to
3613 DONE@footnote{It is possible that Org mode will record two timestamps
3614 when you are using both @code{org-log-done} and state change logging.
3615 However, it will never prompt for two notes---if you have configured
3616 both, the state change recording note will take precedence and cancel
3617 the @samp{Closing Note}.}, and that a note is recorded when switching to
3618 WAIT or CANCELED. The setting for WAIT is even more special: the
3619 @samp{!} after the slash means that in addition to the note taken when
3620 entering the state, a timestamp should be recorded when @i{leaving} the
3621 WAIT state, if and only if the @i{target} state does not configure
3622 logging for entering it. So it has no effect when switching from WAIT
3623 to DONE, because DONE is configured to record a timestamp only. But
3624 when switching from WAIT back to TODO, the @samp{/!} in the WAIT
3625 setting now triggers a timestamp even though TODO has no logging
3628 You can use the exact same syntax for setting logging preferences local
3631 #+TODO: TODO(t) WAIT(w@@/!) | DONE(d!) CANCELED(c@@)
3634 @cindex property, LOGGING
3635 In order to define logging settings that are local to a subtree or a
3636 single item, define a LOGGING property in this entry. Any non-empty
3637 LOGGING property resets all logging settings to nil. You may then turn
3638 on logging for this specific tree using STARTUP keywords like
3639 @code{lognotedone} or @code{logrepeat}, as well as adding state specific
3640 settings like @code{TODO(!)}. For example
3643 * TODO Log each state with only a time
3645 :LOGGING: TODO(!) WAIT(!) DONE(!) CANCELED(!)
3647 * TODO Only log when switching to WAIT, and when repeating
3649 :LOGGING: WAIT(@@) logrepeat
3651 * TODO No logging at all
3657 @node Tracking your habits, , Tracking TODO state changes, Progress logging
3658 @subsection Tracking your habits
3661 Org has the ability to track the consistency of a special category of TODOs,
3662 called ``habits''. A habit has the following properties:
3666 You have enabled the @code{habits} module by customizing the variable
3669 The habit is a TODO, with a TODO keyword representing an open state.
3671 The property @code{STYLE} is set to the value @code{habit}.
3673 The TODO has a scheduled date, with a @code{.+} style repeat interval.
3675 The TODO may also have minimum and maximum ranges specified by using the
3676 syntax @samp{.+2d/3d}, which says that you want to do the task at least every
3677 three days, but at most every two days.
3679 You must also have state logging for the @code{DONE} state enabled, in order
3680 for historical data to be represented in the consistency graph. If it's not
3681 enabled it's not an error, but the consistency graphs will be largely
3685 To give you an idea of what the above rules look like in action, here's an
3686 actual habit with some history:
3690 SCHEDULED: <2009-10-17 Sat .+2d/4d>
3691 - State "DONE" from "TODO" [2009-10-15 Thu]
3692 - State "DONE" from "TODO" [2009-10-12 Mon]
3693 - State "DONE" from "TODO" [2009-10-10 Sat]
3694 - State "DONE" from "TODO" [2009-10-04 Sun]
3695 - State "DONE" from "TODO" [2009-10-02 Fri]
3696 - State "DONE" from "TODO" [2009-09-29 Tue]
3697 - State "DONE" from "TODO" [2009-09-25 Fri]
3698 - State "DONE" from "TODO" [2009-09-19 Sat]
3699 - State "DONE" from "TODO" [2009-09-16 Wed]
3700 - State "DONE" from "TODO" [2009-09-12 Sat]
3703 :LAST_REPEAT: [2009-10-19 Mon 00:36]
3707 What this habit says is: I want to shave at most every 2 days (given by the
3708 @code{SCHEDULED} date and repeat interval) and at least every 4 days. If
3709 today is the 15th, then the habit first appears in the agenda on Oct 17,
3710 after the minimum of 2 days has elapsed, and will appear overdue on Oct 19,
3711 after four days have elapsed.
3713 What's really useful about habits is that they are displayed along with a
3714 consistency graph, to show how consistent you've been at getting that task
3715 done in the past. This graph shows every day that the task was done over the
3716 past three weeks, with colors for each day. The colors used are:
3720 If the task wasn't to be done yet on that day.
3722 If the task could have been done on that day.
3724 If the task was going to be overdue the next day.
3726 If the task was overdue on that day.
3729 In addition to coloring each day, the day is also marked with an asterix if
3730 the task was actually done that day, and an exclamation mark to show where
3731 the current day falls in the graph.
3733 There are several configuration variables that can be used to change the way
3734 habits are displayed in the agenda.
3737 @item org-habit-graph-column
3738 The buffer column at which the consistency graph should be drawn. This will
3739 overwrite any text in that column, so it's a good idea to keep your habits'
3740 titles brief and to the point.
3741 @item org-habit-preceding-days
3742 The amount of history, in days before today, to appear in consistency graphs.
3743 @item org-habit-following-days
3744 The number of days after today that will appear in consistency graphs.
3745 @item org-habit-show-habits-only-for-today
3746 If non-nil, only show habits in today's agenda view. This is set to true by
3750 Lastly, pressing @kbd{K} in the agenda buffer will cause habits to
3751 temporarily be disabled and they won't appear at all. Press @kbd{K} again to
3752 bring them back. They are also subject to tag filtering, if you have habits
3753 which should only be done in certain contexts, for example.
3755 @node Priorities, Breaking down tasks, Progress logging, TODO Items
3759 If you use Org mode extensively, you may end up enough TODO items that
3760 it starts to make sense to prioritize them. Prioritizing can be done by
3761 placing a @emph{priority cookie} into the headline of a TODO item, like
3765 *** TODO [#A] Write letter to Sam Fortune
3769 By default, Org mode supports three priorities: @samp{A}, @samp{B}, and
3770 @samp{C}. @samp{A} is the highest priority. An entry without a cookie
3771 is treated as priority @samp{B}. Priorities make a difference only in
3772 the agenda (@pxref{Weekly/daily agenda}); outside the agenda, they have
3773 no inherent meaning to Org mode.
3775 Priorities can be attached to any outline tree entries; they do not need
3781 Set the priority of the current headline. The command prompts for a
3782 priority character @samp{A}, @samp{B} or @samp{C}. When you press
3783 @key{SPC} instead, the priority cookie is removed from the headline.
3784 The priorities can also be changed ``remotely'' from the timeline and
3785 agenda buffer with the @kbd{,} command (@pxref{Agenda commands}).
3788 @kindex S-@key{down}
3791 @vindex org-priority-start-cycle-with-default
3792 Increase/decrease priority of current headline@footnote{See also the option
3793 @code{org-priority-start-cycle-with-default}.}. Note that these keys are
3794 also used to modify timestamps (@pxref{Creating timestamps}). See also
3795 @ref{Conflicts}, for a discussion of the interaction with
3796 @code{shift-selection-mode}.
3799 @vindex org-highest-priority
3800 @vindex org-lowest-priority
3801 @vindex org-default-priority
3802 You can change the range of allowed priorities by setting the variables
3803 @code{org-highest-priority}, @code{org-lowest-priority}, and
3804 @code{org-default-priority}. For an individual buffer, you may set
3805 these values (highest, lowest, default) like this (please make sure that
3806 the highest priority is earlier in the alphabet than the lowest
3809 @cindex #+PRIORITIES
3814 @node Breaking down tasks, Checkboxes, Priorities, TODO Items
3815 @section Breaking tasks down into subtasks
3816 @cindex tasks, breaking down
3817 @cindex statistics, for TODO items
3819 @vindex org-agenda-todo-list-sublevels
3820 It is often advisable to break down large tasks into smaller, manageable
3821 subtasks. You can do this by creating an outline tree below a TODO item,
3822 with detailed subtasks on the tree@footnote{To keep subtasks out of the
3823 global TODO list, see the @code{org-agenda-todo-list-sublevels}.}. To keep
3824 the overview over the fraction of subtasks that are already completed, insert
3825 either @samp{[/]} or @samp{[%]} anywhere in the headline. These cookies will
3826 be updates each time the todo status of a child changes, or when pressing
3827 @kbd{C-c C-c} on the cookie. For example:
3830 * Organize Party [33%]
3831 ** TODO Call people [1/2]
3835 ** DONE Talk to neighbor
3838 @cindex property, COOKIE_DATA
3839 If a heading has both checkboxes and TODO children below it, the meaning of
3840 the statistics cookie become ambiguous. Set the property
3841 @code{COOKIE_DATA} to either @samp{checkbox} or @samp{todo} to resolve
3844 @vindex org-hierarchical-todo-statistics
3845 If you would like to have the statistics cookie count any TODO entries in the
3846 subtree (not just direct children), configure the variable
3847 @code{org-hierarchical-todo-statistics}. To do this for a single subtree,
3848 include the word @samp{recursive} into the value of the @code{COOKIE_DATA}
3852 * Parent capturing statistics [2/20]
3854 :COOKIE_DATA: todo recursive
3858 If you would like a TODO entry to automatically change to DONE
3859 when all children are done, you can use the following setup:
3862 (defun org-summary-todo (n-done n-not-done)
3863 "Switch entry to DONE when all subentries are done, to TODO otherwise."
3864 (let (org-log-done org-log-states) ; turn off logging
3865 (org-todo (if (= n-not-done 0) "DONE" "TODO"))))
3867 (add-hook 'org-after-todo-statistics-hook 'org-summary-todo)
3871 Another possibility is the use of checkboxes to identify (a hierarchy of) a
3872 large number of subtasks (@pxref{Checkboxes}).
3875 @node Checkboxes, , Breaking down tasks, TODO Items
3879 Every item in a plain list (@pxref{Plain lists}) can be made into a
3880 checkbox by starting it with the string @samp{[ ]}. This feature is
3881 similar to TODO items (@pxref{TODO Items}), but is more lightweight.
3882 Checkboxes are not included into the global TODO list, so they are often
3883 great to split a task into a number of simple steps. Or you can use
3884 them in a shopping list. To toggle a checkbox, use @kbd{C-c C-c}, or
3885 use the mouse (thanks to Piotr Zielinski's @file{org-mouse.el}).
3887 Here is an example of a checkbox list.
3890 * TODO Organize party [2/4]
3891 - [-] call people [1/3]
3896 - [ ] think about what music to play
3897 - [X] talk to the neighbors
3900 Checkboxes work hierarchically, so if a checkbox item has children that
3901 are checkboxes, toggling one of the children checkboxes will make the
3902 parent checkbox reflect if none, some, or all of the children are
3905 @cindex statistics, for checkboxes
3906 @cindex checkbox statistics
3907 @cindex property, COOKIE_DATA
3908 @vindex org-hierarchical-checkbox-statistics
3909 The @samp{[2/4]} and @samp{[1/3]} in the first and second line are cookies
3910 indicating how many checkboxes present in this entry have been checked off,
3911 and the total number of checkboxes present. This can give you an idea on how
3912 many checkboxes remain, even without opening a folded entry. The cookies can
3913 be placed into a headline or into (the first line of) a plain list item.
3914 Each cookie covers checkboxes of direct children structurally below the
3915 headline/item on which the cookie appears@footnote{Set the variable
3916 @code{org-hierarchical-checkbox-statistics} if you want such cookies to
3917 represent the all checkboxes below the cookie, not just the direct
3918 children.}. You have to insert the cookie yourself by typing either
3919 @samp{[/]} or @samp{[%]}. With @samp{[/]} you get an @samp{n out of m}
3920 result, as in the examples above. With @samp{[%]} you get information about
3921 the percentage of checkboxes checked (in the above example, this would be
3922 @samp{[50%]} and @samp{[33%]}, respectively). In a headline, a cookie can
3923 count either checkboxes below the heading or TODO states of children, and it
3924 will display whatever was changed last. Set the property @code{COOKIE_DATA}
3925 to either @samp{checkbox} or @samp{todo} to resolve this issue.
3927 @cindex blocking, of checkboxes
3928 @cindex checkbox blocking
3929 @cindex property, ORDERED
3930 If the current outline node has an @code{ORDERED} property, checkboxes must
3931 be checked off in sequence, and an error will be thrown if you try to check
3932 off a box while there are unchecked boxes above it.
3934 @noindent The following commands work with checkboxes:
3939 Toggle checkbox status or (with prefix arg) checkbox presence at point. With
3940 double prefix argument, set it to @samp{[-]}, which is considered to be an
3944 Toggle checkbox status or (with prefix arg) checkbox presence at point. With
3945 double prefix argument, set it to @samp{[-]}, which is considered to be an
3949 If there is an active region, toggle the first checkbox in the region
3950 and set all remaining boxes to the same status as the first. With a prefix
3951 arg, add or remove the checkbox for all items in the region.
3953 If the cursor is in a headline, toggle checkboxes in the region between
3954 this headline and the next (so @emph{not} the entire subtree).
3956 If there is no active region, just toggle the checkbox at point.
3958 @kindex M-S-@key{RET}
3960 Insert a new item with a checkbox.
3961 This works only if the cursor is already in a plain list item
3962 (@pxref{Plain lists}).
3965 @vindex org-track-ordered-property-with-tag
3966 @cindex property, ORDERED
3967 Toggle the @code{ORDERED} property of the entry, to toggle if checkboxes must
3968 be checked off in sequence. A property is used for this behavior because
3969 this should be local to the current entry, not inherited like a tag.
3970 However, if you would like to @i{track} the value of this property with a tag
3971 for better visibility, customize the variable
3972 @code{org-track-ordered-property-with-tag}.
3975 Update the statistics cookie in the current outline entry. When called with
3976 a @kbd{C-u} prefix, update the entire file. Checkbox statistic cookies are
3977 updated automatically if you toggle checkboxes with @kbd{C-c C-c} and make
3978 new ones with @kbd{M-S-@key{RET}}. TODO statistics cookies update when
3979 changing TODO states. If you delete boxes/entries or add/change them by
3980 hand, use this command to get things back into sync. Or simply toggle any
3981 entry twice (checkboxes with @kbd{C-c C-c}).
3984 @node Tags, Properties and Columns, TODO Items, Top
3987 @cindex headline tagging
3988 @cindex matching, tags
3989 @cindex sparse tree, tag based
3991 An excellent way to implement labels and contexts for cross-correlating
3992 information is to assign @i{tags} to headlines. Org mode has extensive
3995 @vindex org-tag-faces
3996 Every headline can contain a list of tags; they occur at the end of the
3997 headline. Tags are normal words containing letters, numbers, @samp{_}, and
3998 @samp{@@}. Tags must be preceded and followed by a single colon, e.g.,
3999 @samp{:work:}. Several tags can be specified, as in @samp{:work:urgent:}.
4000 Tags will by default be in bold face with the same color as the headline.
4001 You may specify special faces for specific tags using the variable
4002 @code{org-tag-faces}, in much the same way as you can for TODO keywords
4003 (@pxref{Faces for TODO keywords}).
4006 * Tag inheritance:: Tags use the tree structure of the outline
4007 * Setting tags:: How to assign tags to a headline
4008 * Tag searches:: Searching for combinations of tags
4011 @node Tag inheritance, Setting tags, Tags, Tags
4012 @section Tag inheritance
4013 @cindex tag inheritance
4014 @cindex inheritance, of tags
4015 @cindex sublevels, inclusion into tags match
4017 @i{Tags} make use of the hierarchical structure of outline trees. If a
4018 heading has a certain tag, all subheadings will inherit the tag as
4019 well. For example, in the list
4022 * Meeting with the French group :work:
4023 ** Summary by Frank :boss:notes:
4024 *** TODO Prepare slides for him :action:
4028 the final heading will have the tags @samp{:work:}, @samp{:boss:},
4029 @samp{:notes:}, and @samp{:action:} even though the final heading is not
4030 explicitly marked with those tags. You can also set tags that all entries in
4031 a file should inherit just as if these tags were defined in a hypothetical
4032 level zero that surrounds the entire file. Use a line like this@footnote{As
4033 with all these in-buffer settings, pressing @kbd{C-c C-c} activates any
4034 changes in the line.}:
4038 #+FILETAGS: :Peter:Boss:Secret:
4042 @vindex org-use-tag-inheritance
4043 @vindex org-tags-exclude-from-inheritance
4044 To limit tag inheritance to specific tags, or to turn it off entirely, use
4045 the variables @code{org-use-tag-inheritance} and
4046 @code{org-tags-exclude-from-inheritance}.
4048 @vindex org-tags-match-list-sublevels
4049 When a headline matches during a tags search while tag inheritance is turned
4050 on, all the sublevels in the same tree will (for a simple match form) match
4051 as well@footnote{This is only true if the search does not involve more
4052 complex tests including properties (@pxref{Property searches}).}. The list
4053 of matches may then become very long. If you only want to see the first tags
4054 match in a subtree, configure the variable
4055 @code{org-tags-match-list-sublevels} (not recommended).
4057 @node Setting tags, Tag searches, Tag inheritance, Tags
4058 @section Setting tags
4059 @cindex setting tags
4060 @cindex tags, setting
4063 Tags can simply be typed into the buffer at the end of a headline.
4064 After a colon, @kbd{M-@key{TAB}} offers completion on tags. There is
4065 also a special command for inserting tags:
4070 @cindex completion, of tags
4071 @vindex org-tags-column
4072 Enter new tags for the current headline. Org mode will either offer
4073 completion or a special single-key interface for setting tags, see
4074 below. After pressing @key{RET}, the tags will be inserted and aligned
4075 to @code{org-tags-column}. When called with a @kbd{C-u} prefix, all
4076 tags in the current buffer will be aligned to that column, just to make
4077 things look nice. TAGS are automatically realigned after promotion,
4078 demotion, and TODO state changes (@pxref{TODO basics}).
4081 When the cursor is in a headline, this does the same as @kbd{C-c C-q}.
4084 @vindex org-tag-alist
4085 Org will support tag insertion based on a @emph{list of tags}. By
4086 default this list is constructed dynamically, containing all tags
4087 currently used in the buffer. You may also globally specify a hard list
4088 of tags with the variable @code{org-tag-alist}. Finally you can set
4089 the default tags for a given file with lines like
4093 #+TAGS: @@work @@home @@tennisclub
4094 #+TAGS: laptop car pc sailboat
4097 If you have globally defined your preferred set of tags using the
4098 variable @code{org-tag-alist}, but would like to use a dynamic tag list
4099 in a specific file, add an empty TAGS option line to that file:
4105 @vindex org-tag-persistent-alist
4106 If you have a preferred set of tags that you would like to use in every file,
4107 in addition to those defined on a per-file basis by TAGS option lines, then
4108 you may specify a list of tags with the variable
4109 @code{org-tag-persistent-alist}. You may turn this off on a per-file basis
4110 by adding a STARTUP option line to that file:
4116 By default Org mode uses the standard minibuffer completion facilities for
4117 entering tags. However, it also implements another, quicker, tag selection
4118 method called @emph{fast tag selection}. This allows you to select and
4119 deselect tags with just a single key press. For this to work well you should
4120 assign unique letters to most of your commonly used tags. You can do this
4121 globally by configuring the variable @code{org-tag-alist} in your
4122 @file{.emacs} file. For example, you may find the need to tag many items in
4123 different files with @samp{:@@home:}. In this case you can set something
4127 (setq org-tag-alist '(("@@work" . ?w) ("@@home" . ?h) ("laptop" . ?l)))
4130 @noindent If the tag is only relevant to the file you are working on, then you
4131 can instead set the TAGS option line as:
4134 #+TAGS: @@work(w) @@home(h) @@tennisclub(t) laptop(l) pc(p)
4137 @noindent The tags interface will show the available tags in a splash
4138 window. If you want to start a new line after a specific tag, insert
4139 @samp{\n} into the tag list
4142 #+TAGS: @@work(w) @@home(h) @@tennisclub(t) \n laptop(l) pc(p)
4145 @noindent or write them in two lines:
4148 #+TAGS: @@work(w) @@home(h) @@tennisclub(t)
4149 #+TAGS: laptop(l) pc(p)
4153 You can also group together tags that are mutually exclusive by using
4157 #+TAGS: @{ @@work(w) @@home(h) @@tennisclub(t) @} laptop(l) pc(p)
4160 @noindent you indicate that at most one of @samp{@@work}, @samp{@@home},
4161 and @samp{@@tennisclub} should be selected. Multiple such groups are allowed.
4163 @noindent Don't forget to press @kbd{C-c C-c} with the cursor in one of
4164 these lines to activate any changes.
4167 To set these mutually exclusive groups in the variable @code{org-tags-alist},
4168 you must use the dummy tags @code{:startgroup} and @code{:endgroup} instead
4169 of the braces. Similarly, you can use @code{:newline} to indicate a line
4170 break. The previous example would be set globally by the following
4174 (setq org-tag-alist '((:startgroup . nil)
4175 ("@@work" . ?w) ("@@home" . ?h)
4176 ("@@tennisclub" . ?t)
4178 ("laptop" . ?l) ("pc" . ?p)))
4181 If at least one tag has a selection key then pressing @kbd{C-c C-c} will
4182 automatically present you with a special interface, listing inherited tags,
4183 the tags of the current headline, and a list of all valid tags with
4184 corresponding keys@footnote{Keys will automatically be assigned to tags which
4185 have no configured keys.}. In this interface, you can use the following
4190 Pressing keys assigned to tags will add or remove them from the list of
4191 tags in the current line. Selecting a tag in a group of mutually
4192 exclusive tags will turn off any other tags from that group.
4195 Enter a tag in the minibuffer, even if the tag is not in the predefined
4196 list. You will be able to complete on all tags present in the buffer.
4199 Clear all tags for this line.
4202 Accept the modified set.
4204 Abort without installing changes.
4206 If @kbd{q} is not assigned to a tag, it aborts like @kbd{C-g}.
4208 Turn off groups of mutually exclusive tags. Use this to (as an
4209 exception) assign several tags from such a group.
4211 Toggle auto-exit after the next change (see below).
4212 If you are using expert mode, the first @kbd{C-c} will display the
4217 This method lets you assign tags to a headline with very few keys. With
4218 the above setup, you could clear the current tags and set @samp{@@home},
4219 @samp{laptop} and @samp{pc} tags with just the following keys: @kbd{C-c
4220 C-c @key{SPC} h l p @key{RET}}. Switching from @samp{@@home} to
4221 @samp{@@work} would be done with @kbd{C-c C-c w @key{RET}} or
4222 alternatively with @kbd{C-c C-c C-c w}. Adding the non-predefined tag
4223 @samp{Sarah} could be done with @kbd{C-c C-c @key{TAB} S a r a h
4224 @key{RET} @key{RET}}.
4226 @vindex org-fast-tag-selection-single-key
4227 If you find that most of the time you need only a single key press to
4228 modify your list of tags, set the variable
4229 @code{org-fast-tag-selection-single-key}. Then you no longer have to
4230 press @key{RET} to exit fast tag selection---it will immediately exit
4231 after the first change. If you then occasionally need more keys, press
4232 @kbd{C-c} to turn off auto-exit for the current tag selection process
4233 (in effect: start selection with @kbd{C-c C-c C-c} instead of @kbd{C-c
4234 C-c}). If you set the variable to the value @code{expert}, the special
4235 window is not even shown for single-key tag selection, it comes up only
4236 when you press an extra @kbd{C-c}.
4238 @vindex org-complete-tags-always-offer-all-agenda-tags
4239 As said before, when setting tags and @code{org-tag-alist} is nil, then the
4240 list of tags in the current buffer is used. Normally, this behavior is very
4241 convenient, except in org remember buffers (@pxref{Remember}), because there
4242 are no tags that can be calculated dynamically. Here, you most probably want
4243 to have completion for all tags in all agenda files. This can be done by
4244 setting @code{org-complete-tags-always-offer-all-agenda-tags} to non-nil in
4248 (add-hook 'org-remember-mode-hook
4250 (set (make-local-variable
4251 'org-complete-tags-always-offer-all-agenda-tags)
4255 Of course, you can also set it to @code{t} globally if you always want to
4256 have completion of all tags in all agenda files.
4258 @node Tag searches, , Setting tags, Tags
4259 @section Tag searches
4260 @cindex tag searches
4261 @cindex searching for tags
4263 Once a system of tags has been set up, it can be used to collect related
4264 information into special lists.
4271 Create a sparse tree with all headlines matching a tags search. With a
4272 @kbd{C-u} prefix argument, ignore headlines that are not a TODO line.
4275 Create a global list of tag matches from all agenda files.
4276 @xref{Matching tags and properties}.
4279 @vindex org-tags-match-list-sublevels
4280 Create a global list of tag matches from all agenda files, but check
4281 only TODO items and force checking subitems (see variable
4282 @code{org-tags-match-list-sublevels}).
4285 These commands all prompt for a match string which allows basic Boolean logic
4286 like @samp{+boss+urgent-project1}, to find entries with tags @samp{boss} and
4287 @samp{urgent}, but not @samp{project1}, or @samp{Kathy|Sally} to find entries
4288 which are tagged, like @samp{Kathy} or @samp{Sally}. The full syntax of the search
4289 string is rich and allows also matching against TODO keywords, entry levels
4290 and properties. For a complete description with many examples, see
4291 @ref{Matching tags and properties}.
4294 @node Properties and Columns, Dates and Times, Tags, Top
4295 @chapter Properties and Columns
4298 Properties are a set of key-value pairs associated with an entry. There
4299 are two main applications for properties in Org mode. First, properties
4300 are like tags, but with a value. Second, you can use properties to
4301 implement (very basic) database capabilities in an Org buffer. For
4302 an example of the first application, imagine maintaining a file where
4303 you document bugs and plan releases for a piece of software. Instead of
4304 using tags like @code{:release_1:}, @code{:release_2:}, one can use a
4305 property, say @code{:Release:}, that in different subtrees has different
4306 values, such as @code{1.0} or @code{2.0}. For an example of the second
4307 application of properties, imagine keeping track of your music CDs,
4308 where properties could be things such as the album, artist, date of
4309 release, number of tracks, and so on.
4311 Properties can be conveniently edited and viewed in column view
4312 (@pxref{Column view}).
4315 * Property syntax:: How properties are spelled out
4316 * Special properties:: Access to other Org mode features
4317 * Property searches:: Matching property values
4318 * Property inheritance:: Passing values down the tree
4319 * Column view:: Tabular viewing and editing
4320 * Property API:: Properties for Lisp programmers
4323 @node Property syntax, Special properties, Properties and Columns, Properties and Columns
4324 @section Property syntax
4325 @cindex property syntax
4326 @cindex drawer, for properties
4328 Properties are key-value pairs. They need to be inserted into a special
4329 drawer (@pxref{Drawers}) with the name @code{PROPERTIES}. Each property
4330 is specified on a single line, with the key (surrounded by colons)
4331 first, and the value after it. Here is an example:
4336 *** Goldberg Variations
4338 :Title: Goldberg Variations
4339 :Composer: J.S. Bach
4341 :Publisher: Deutsche Grammophon
4346 You may define the allowed values for a particular property @samp{:Xyz:}
4347 by setting a property @samp{:Xyz_ALL:}. This special property is
4348 @emph{inherited}, so if you set it in a level 1 entry, it will apply to
4349 the entire tree. When allowed values are defined, setting the
4350 corresponding property becomes easier and is less prone to typing
4351 errors. For the example with the CD collection, we can predefine
4352 publishers and the number of disks in a box like this:
4357 :NDisks_ALL: 1 2 3 4
4358 :Publisher_ALL: "Deutsche Grammophon" Philips EMI
4362 If you want to set properties that can be inherited by any entry in a
4363 file, use a line like
4364 @cindex property, _ALL
4367 #+PROPERTY: NDisks_ALL 1 2 3 4
4370 @vindex org-global-properties
4371 Property values set with the global variable
4372 @code{org-global-properties} can be inherited by all entries in all
4376 The following commands help to work with properties:
4381 After an initial colon in a line, complete property keys. All keys used
4382 in the current file will be offered as possible completions.
4385 Set a property. This prompts for a property name and a value. If
4386 necessary, the property drawer is created as well.
4387 @item M-x org-insert-property-drawer
4388 Insert a property drawer into the current entry. The drawer will be
4389 inserted early in the entry, but after the lines with planning
4390 information like deadlines.
4393 With the cursor in a property drawer, this executes property commands.
4395 Set a property in the current entry. Both the property and the value
4396 can be inserted using completion.
4397 @kindex S-@key{right}
4398 @kindex S-@key{left}
4399 @item S-@key{left}/@key{right}
4400 Switch property at point to the next/previous allowed value.
4402 Remove a property from the current entry.
4404 Globally remove a property, from all entries in the current file.
4406 Compute the property at point, using the operator and scope from the
4407 nearest column format definition.
4410 @node Special properties, Property searches, Property syntax, Properties and Columns
4411 @section Special properties
4412 @cindex properties, special
4414 Special properties provide an alternative access method to Org mode
4415 features, like the TODO state or the priority of an entry, discussed in the
4416 previous chapters. This interface exists so that you can include
4417 these states in a column view (@pxref{Column view}), or to use them in
4418 queries. The following property names are special and should not be
4419 used as keys in the properties drawer:
4421 @cindex property, special, TODO
4422 @cindex property, special, TAGS
4423 @cindex property, special, ALLTAGS
4424 @cindex property, special, CATEGORY
4425 @cindex property, special, PRIORITY
4426 @cindex property, special, DEADLINE
4427 @cindex property, special, SCHEDULED
4428 @cindex property, special, CLOSED
4429 @cindex property, special, TIMESTAMP
4430 @cindex property, special, TIMESTAMP_IA
4431 @cindex property, special, CLOCKSUM
4432 @c guessing that ITEM is needed in this area; also, should this list be sorted?
4433 @cindex property, special, ITEM
4435 TODO @r{The TODO keyword of the entry.}
4436 TAGS @r{The tags defined directly in the headline.}
4437 ALLTAGS @r{All tags, including inherited ones.}
4438 CATEGORY @r{The category of an entry.}
4439 PRIORITY @r{The priority of the entry, a string with a single letter.}
4440 DEADLINE @r{The deadline time string, without the angular brackets.}
4441 SCHEDULED @r{The scheduling timestamp, without the angular brackets.}
4442 CLOSED @r{When was this entry closed?}
4443 TIMESTAMP @r{The first keyword-less timestamp in the entry.}
4444 TIMESTAMP_IA @r{The first inactive timestamp in the entry.}
4445 CLOCKSUM @r{The sum of CLOCK intervals in the subtree. @code{org-clock-sum}}
4446 @r{must be run first to compute the values.}
4447 ITEM @r{The content of the entry.}
4450 @node Property searches, Property inheritance, Special properties, Properties and Columns
4451 @section Property searches
4452 @cindex properties, searching
4453 @cindex searching, of properties
4455 To create sparse trees and special lists with selection based on properties,
4456 the same commands are used as for tag searches (@pxref{Tag searches}).
4462 Create a sparse tree with all matching entries. With a
4463 @kbd{C-u} prefix argument, ignore headlines that are not a TODO line.
4466 Create a global list of tag/property matches from all agenda files.
4467 @xref{Matching tags and properties}.
4470 @vindex org-tags-match-list-sublevels
4471 Create a global list of tag matches from all agenda files, but check
4472 only TODO items and force checking of subitems (see variable
4473 @code{org-tags-match-list-sublevels}).
4476 The syntax for the search string is described in @ref{Matching tags and
4479 There is also a special command for creating sparse trees based on a
4485 Create a sparse tree based on the value of a property. This first
4486 prompts for the name of a property, and then for a value. A sparse tree
4487 is created with all entries that define this property with the given
4488 value. If you enclose the value into curly braces, it is interpreted as
4489 a regular expression and matched against the property values.
4492 @node Property inheritance, Column view, Property searches, Properties and Columns
4493 @section Property Inheritance
4494 @cindex properties, inheritance
4495 @cindex inheritance, of properties
4497 @vindex org-use-property-inheritance
4498 The outline structure of Org-mode documents lends itself for an
4499 inheritance model of properties: if the parent in a tree has a certain
4500 property, the children can inherit this property. Org mode does not
4501 turn this on by default, because it can slow down property searches
4502 significantly and is often not needed. However, if you find inheritance
4503 useful, you can turn it on by setting the variable
4504 @code{org-use-property-inheritance}. It may be set to @code{t} to make
4505 all properties inherited from the parent, to a list of properties
4506 that should be inherited, or to a regular expression that matches
4507 inherited properties.
4509 Org mode has a few properties for which inheritance is hard-coded, at
4510 least for the special applications for which they are used:
4512 @cindex property, COLUMNS
4515 The @code{:COLUMNS:} property defines the format of column view
4516 (@pxref{Column view}). It is inherited in the sense that the level
4517 where a @code{:COLUMNS:} property is defined is used as the starting
4518 point for a column view table, independently of the location in the
4519 subtree from where columns view is turned on.
4521 @cindex property, CATEGORY
4522 For agenda view, a category set through a @code{:CATEGORY:} property
4523 applies to the entire subtree.
4525 @cindex property, ARCHIVE
4526 For archiving, the @code{:ARCHIVE:} property may define the archive
4527 location for the entire subtree (@pxref{Moving subtrees}).
4529 @cindex property, LOGGING
4530 The LOGGING property may define logging settings for an entry or a
4531 subtree (@pxref{Tracking TODO state changes}).
4534 @node Column view, Property API, Property inheritance, Properties and Columns
4535 @section Column view
4537 A great way to view and edit properties in an outline tree is
4538 @emph{column view}. In column view, each outline node is turned into a
4539 table row. Columns in this table provide access to properties of the
4540 entries. Org mode implements columns by overlaying a tabular structure
4541 over the headline of each item. While the headlines have been turned
4542 into a table row, you can still change the visibility of the outline
4543 tree. For example, you get a compact table by switching to CONTENTS
4544 view (@kbd{S-@key{TAB} S-@key{TAB}}, or simply @kbd{c} while column view
4545 is active), but you can still open, read, and edit the entry below each
4546 headline. Or, you can switch to column view after executing a sparse
4547 tree command and in this way get a table only for the selected items.
4548 Column view also works in agenda buffers (@pxref{Agenda Views}) where
4549 queries have collected selected items, possibly from a number of files.
4552 * Defining columns:: The COLUMNS format property
4553 * Using column view:: How to create and use column view
4554 * Capturing column view:: A dynamic block for column view
4557 @node Defining columns, Using column view, Column view, Column view
4558 @subsection Defining columns
4559 @cindex column view, for properties
4560 @cindex properties, column view
4562 Setting up a column view first requires defining the columns. This is
4563 done by defining a column format line.
4566 * Scope of column definitions:: Where defined, where valid?
4567 * Column attributes:: Appearance and content of a column
4570 @node Scope of column definitions, Column attributes, Defining columns, Defining columns
4571 @subsubsection Scope of column definitions
4573 To define a column format for an entire file, use a line like
4577 #+COLUMNS: %25ITEM %TAGS %PRIORITY %TODO
4580 To specify a format that only applies to a specific tree, add a
4581 @code{:COLUMNS:} property to the top node of that tree, for example:
4584 ** Top node for columns view
4586 :COLUMNS: %25ITEM %TAGS %PRIORITY %TODO
4590 If a @code{:COLUMNS:} property is present in an entry, it defines columns
4591 for the entry itself, and for the entire subtree below it. Since the
4592 column definition is part of the hierarchical structure of the document,
4593 you can define columns on level 1 that are general enough for all
4594 sublevels, and more specific columns further down, when you edit a
4595 deeper part of the tree.
4597 @node Column attributes, , Scope of column definitions, Defining columns
4598 @subsubsection Column attributes
4599 A column definition sets the attributes of a column. The general
4600 definition looks like this:
4603 %[@var{width}]@var{property}[(@var{title})][@{@var{summary-type}@}]
4607 Except for the percent sign and the property name, all items are
4608 optional. The individual parts have the following meaning:
4611 @var{width} @r{An integer specifying the width of the column in characters.}
4612 @r{If omitted, the width will be determined automatically.}
4613 @var{property} @r{The property that should be edited in this column.}
4614 @r{Special properties representing meta data are allowed here}
4615 @r{as well (@pxref{Special properties})}
4616 (title) @r{The header text for the column. If omitted, the}
4617 @r{property name is used.}
4618 @{@var{summary-type}@} @r{The summary type. If specified, the column values for}
4619 @r{parent nodes are computed from the children.}
4620 @r{Supported summary types are:}
4621 @{+@} @r{Sum numbers in this column.}
4622 @{+;%.1f@} @r{Like @samp{+}, but format result with @samp{%.1f}.}
4623 @{$@} @r{Currency, short for @samp{+;%.2f}.}
4624 @{:@} @r{Sum times, HH:MM:SS, plain numbers are hours.}
4625 @{X@} @r{Checkbox status, @samp{[X]} if all children are @samp{[X]}.}
4626 @{X/@} @r{Checkbox status, @samp{[n/m]}.}
4627 @{X%@} @r{Checkbox status, @samp{[n%]}.}
4628 @{min@} @r{Smallest number in column.}
4629 @{max@} @r{Largest number.}
4630 @{mean@} @r{Arithmetic mean of numbers.}
4631 @{:min@} @r{Smallest time value in column.}
4632 @{:max@} @r{Largest time value.}
4633 @{:mean@} @r{Arithmetic mean of time values.}
4634 @{@@min@} @r{Minimum age (in days/hours/mins/seconds).}
4635 @{@@max@} @r{Maximum age (in days/hours/mins/seconds).}
4636 @{@@mean@} @r{Arithmetic mean of ages (in days/hours/mins/seconds).}
4640 Be aware that you can only have one summary type for any property you
4641 include. Subsequent columns referencing the same property will all display the
4642 same summary information.
4644 Here is an example for a complete columns definition, along with allowed
4648 :COLUMNS: %25ITEM %9Approved(Approved?)@{X@} %Owner %11Status \@footnote{Please note that the COLUMNS definition must be on a single line---it is wrapped here only because of formatting constraints.}
4649 %10Time_Estimate@{:@} %CLOCKSUM
4650 :Owner_ALL: Tammy Mark Karl Lisa Don
4651 :Status_ALL: "In progress" "Not started yet" "Finished" ""
4652 :Approved_ALL: "[ ]" "[X]"
4656 The first column, @samp{%25ITEM}, means the first 25 characters of the
4657 item itself, i.e. of the headline. You probably always should start the
4658 column definition with the @samp{ITEM} specifier. The other specifiers
4659 create columns @samp{Owner} with a list of names as allowed values, for
4660 @samp{Status} with four different possible values, and for a checkbox
4661 field @samp{Approved}. When no width is given after the @samp{%}
4662 character, the column will be exactly as wide as it needs to be in order
4663 to fully display all values. The @samp{Approved} column does have a
4664 modified title (@samp{Approved?}, with a question mark). Summaries will
4665 be created for the @samp{Time_Estimate} column by adding time duration
4666 expressions like HH:MM, and for the @samp{Approved} column, by providing
4667 an @samp{[X]} status if all children have been checked. The
4668 @samp{CLOCKSUM} column is special, it lists the sum of CLOCK intervals
4671 @node Using column view, Capturing column view, Defining columns, Column view
4672 @subsection Using column view
4675 @tsubheading{Turning column view on and off}
4678 @vindex org-columns-default-format
4679 Turn on column view. If the cursor is before the first headline in the file,
4680 column view is turned on for the entire file, using the @code{#+COLUMNS}
4681 definition. If the cursor is somewhere inside the outline, this command
4682 searches the hierarchy, up from point, for a @code{:COLUMNS:} property that
4683 defines a format. When one is found, the column view table is established
4684 for the tree starting at the entry that contains the @code{:COLUMNS:}
4685 property. If no such property is found, the format is taken from the
4686 @code{#+COLUMNS} line or from the variable @code{org-columns-default-format},
4687 and column view is established for the current entry and its subtree.
4690 Recreate the column view, to include recent changes made in the buffer.
4697 @tsubheading{Editing values}
4698 @item @key{left} @key{right} @key{up} @key{down}
4699 Move through the column view from field to field.
4700 @kindex S-@key{left}
4701 @kindex S-@key{right}
4702 @item S-@key{left}/@key{right}
4703 Switch to the next/previous allowed value of the field. For this, you
4704 have to have specified allowed values for a property.
4706 Directly select the nth allowed value, @kbd{0} selects the 10th value.
4710 Same as @kbd{S-@key{left}/@key{right}}
4713 Edit the property at point. For the special properties, this will
4714 invoke the same interface that you normally use to change that
4715 property. For example, when editing a TAGS property, the tag completion
4716 or fast selection interface will pop up.
4719 When there is a checkbox at point, toggle it.
4722 View the full value of this property. This is useful if the width of
4723 the column is smaller than that of the value.
4726 Edit the list of allowed values for this property. If the list is found
4727 in the hierarchy, the modified values is stored there. If no list is
4728 found, the new value is stored in the first entry that is part of the
4729 current column view.
4730 @tsubheading{Modifying the table structure}
4734 Make the column narrower/wider by one character.
4735 @kindex S-M-@key{right}
4736 @item S-M-@key{right}
4737 Insert a new column, to the left of the current column.
4738 @kindex S-M-@key{left}
4739 @item S-M-@key{left}
4740 Delete the current column.
4743 @node Capturing column view, , Using column view, Column view
4744 @subsection Capturing column view
4746 Since column view is just an overlay over a buffer, it cannot be
4747 exported or printed directly. If you want to capture a column view, use
4748 a @code{columnview} dynamic block (@pxref{Dynamic blocks}). The frame
4749 of this block looks like this:
4751 @cindex #+BEGIN, columnview
4754 #+BEGIN: columnview :hlines 1 :id "label"
4759 @noindent This dynamic block has the following parameters:
4763 This is the most important parameter. Column view is a feature that is
4764 often localized to a certain (sub)tree, and the capture block might be
4765 at a different location in the file. To identify the tree whose view to
4766 capture, you can use 4 values:
4767 @cindex property, ID
4769 local @r{use the tree in which the capture block is located}
4770 global @r{make a global view, including all headings in the file}
4771 "file:@var{path-to-file}"
4772 @r{run column view at the top of this file}
4773 "@var{ID}" @r{call column view in the tree that has an @code{:ID:}}
4774 @r{property with the value @i{label}. You can use}
4775 @r{@kbd{M-x org-id-copy} to create a globally unique ID for}
4776 @r{the current entry and copy it to the kill-ring.}
4779 When @code{t}, insert an hline after every line. When a number @var{N}, insert
4780 an hline before each headline with level @code{<= @var{N}}.
4782 When set to @code{t}, force column groups to get vertical lines.
4784 When set to a number, don't capture entries below this level.
4785 @item :skip-empty-rows
4786 When set to @code{t}, skip rows where the only non-empty specifier of the
4787 column view is @code{ITEM}.
4792 The following commands insert or update the dynamic block:
4797 Insert a dynamic block capturing a column view. You will be prompted
4798 for the scope or ID of the view.
4803 Update dynamic block at point. The cursor needs to be in the
4804 @code{#+BEGIN} line of the dynamic block.
4805 @kindex C-u C-c C-x C-u
4806 @item C-u C-c C-x C-u
4807 Update all dynamic blocks (@pxref{Dynamic blocks}). This is useful if
4808 you have several clock table blocks in a buffer.
4811 You can add formulas to the column view table and you may add plotting
4812 instructions in front of the table---these will survive an update of the
4813 block. If there is a @code{#+TBLFM:} after the table, the table will
4814 actually be recalculated automatically after an update.
4816 An alternative way to capture and process property values into a table is
4817 provided by Eric Schulte's @file{org-collector.el} which is a contributed
4818 package@footnote{Contributed packages are not part of Emacs, but are
4819 distributed with the main distribution of Org (visit
4820 @uref{http://orgmode.org}).}. It provides a general API to collect
4821 properties from entries in a certain scope, and arbitrary Lisp expressions to
4822 process these values before inserting them into a table or a dynamic block.
4824 @node Property API, , Column view, Properties and Columns
4825 @section The Property API
4826 @cindex properties, API
4827 @cindex API, for properties
4829 There is a full API for accessing and changing properties. This API can
4830 be used by Emacs Lisp programs to work with properties and to implement
4831 features based on them. For more information see @ref{Using the
4834 @node Dates and Times, Capture - Refile - Archive, Properties and Columns, Top
4835 @chapter Dates and Times
4841 To assist project planning, TODO items can be labeled with a date and/or
4842 a time. The specially formatted string carrying the date and time
4843 information is called a @emph{timestamp} in Org mode. This may be a
4844 little confusing because timestamp is often used as indicating when
4845 something was created or last changed. However, in Org mode this term
4846 is used in a much wider sense.
4849 * Timestamps:: Assigning a time to a tree entry
4850 * Creating timestamps:: Commands which insert timestamps
4851 * Deadlines and scheduling:: Planning your work
4852 * Clocking work time:: Tracking how long you spend on a task
4853 * Resolving idle time:: Resolving time if you've been idle
4854 * Effort estimates:: Planning work effort in advance
4855 * Relative timer:: Notes with a running timer
4859 @node Timestamps, Creating timestamps, Dates and Times, Dates and Times
4860 @section Timestamps, deadlines, and scheduling
4862 @cindex ranges, time
4867 A timestamp is a specification of a date (possibly with a time or a range of
4868 times) in a special format, either @samp{<2003-09-16 Tue>} or
4869 @samp{<2003-09-16 Tue 09:39>} or @samp{<2003-09-16 Tue
4870 12:00-12:30>}@footnote{This is inspired by the standard ISO 6801 date/time
4871 format. To use an alternative format, see @ref{Custom time format}.}. A
4872 timestamp can appear anywhere in the headline or body of an Org tree entry.
4873 Its presence causes entries to be shown on specific dates in the agenda
4874 (@pxref{Weekly/daily agenda}). We distinguish:
4877 @item Plain timestamp; Event; Appointment
4879 A simple timestamp just assigns a date/time to an item. This is just
4880 like writing down an appointment or event in a paper agenda. In the
4881 timeline and agenda displays, the headline of an entry associated with a
4882 plain timestamp will be shown exactly on that date.
4885 * Meet Peter at the movies <2006-11-01 Wed 19:15>
4886 * Discussion on climate change <2006-11-02 Thu 20:00-22:00>
4889 @item Timestamp with repeater interval
4890 @cindex timestamp, with repeater interval
4891 A timestamp may contain a @emph{repeater interval}, indicating that it
4892 applies not only on the given date, but again and again after a certain
4893 interval of N days (d), weeks (w), months (m), or years (y). The
4894 following will show up in the agenda every Wednesday:
4897 * Pick up Sam at school <2007-05-16 Wed 12:30 +1w>
4900 @item Diary-style sexp entries
4901 For more complex date specifications, Org mode supports using the
4902 special sexp diary entries implemented in the Emacs calendar/diary
4903 package. For example
4906 * The nerd meeting on every 2nd Thursday of the month
4907 <%%(diary-float t 4 2)>
4910 @item Time/Date range
4913 Two timestamps connected by @samp{--} denote a range. The headline
4914 will be shown on the first and last day of the range, and on any dates
4915 that are displayed and fall in the range. Here is an example:
4918 ** Meeting in Amsterdam
4919 <2004-08-23 Mon>--<2004-08-26 Thu>
4922 @item Inactive timestamp
4923 @cindex timestamp, inactive
4924 @cindex inactive timestamp
4925 Just like a plain timestamp, but with square brackets instead of
4926 angular ones. These timestamps are inactive in the sense that they do
4927 @emph{not} trigger an entry to show up in the agenda.
4930 * Gillian comes late for the fifth time [2006-11-01 Wed]
4935 @node Creating timestamps, Deadlines and scheduling, Timestamps, Dates and Times
4936 @section Creating timestamps
4937 @cindex creating timestamps
4938 @cindex timestamps, creating
4940 For Org mode to recognize timestamps, they need to be in the specific
4941 format. All commands listed below produce timestamps in the correct
4947 Prompt for a date and insert a corresponding timestamp. When the cursor is
4948 at an existing timestamp in the buffer, the command is used to modify this
4949 timestamp instead of inserting a new one. When this command is used twice in
4950 succession, a time range is inserted.
4954 Like @kbd{C-c .}, but insert an inactive timestamp that will not cause
4961 @vindex org-time-stamp-rounding-minutes
4962 Like @kbd{C-c .} and @kbd{C-c !}, but use the alternative format which
4963 contains date and time. The default time can be rounded to multiples of 5
4964 minutes, see the option @code{org-time-stamp-rounding-minutes}.
4968 Insert a timestamp corresponding to the cursor date in the Calendar.
4972 Access the Emacs calendar for the current date. If there is a
4973 timestamp in the current line, go to the corresponding date
4978 Access the agenda for the date given by the timestamp or -range at
4979 point (@pxref{Weekly/daily agenda}).
4981 @kindex S-@key{left}
4982 @kindex S-@key{right}
4984 @itemx S-@key{right}
4985 Change date at cursor by one day. These key bindings conflict with
4986 shift-selection and related modes (@pxref{Conflicts}).
4989 @kindex S-@key{down}
4992 Change the item under the cursor in a timestamp. The cursor can be on a
4993 year, month, day, hour or minute. When the timestamp contains a time range
4994 like @samp{15:30-16:30}, modifying the first time will also shift the second,
4995 shifting the time block with constant length. To change the length, modify
4996 the second time. Note that if the cursor is in a headline and not at a
4997 timestamp, these same keys modify the priority of an item.
4998 (@pxref{Priorities}). The key bindings also conflict with shift-selection and
4999 related modes (@pxref{Conflicts}).
5002 @cindex evaluate time range
5004 Evaluate a time range by computing the difference between start and end.
5005 With a prefix argument, insert result after the time range (in a table: into
5006 the following column).
5011 * The date/time prompt:: How Org mode helps you entering date and time
5012 * Custom time format:: Making dates look different
5015 @node The date/time prompt, Custom time format, Creating timestamps, Creating timestamps
5016 @subsection The date/time prompt
5017 @cindex date, reading in minibuffer
5018 @cindex time, reading in minibuffer
5020 @vindex org-read-date-prefer-future
5021 When Org mode prompts for a date/time, the default is shown in default
5022 date/time format, and the prompt therefore seems to ask for a specific
5023 format. But it will in fact accept any string containing some date and/or
5024 time information, and it is really smart about interpreting your input. You
5025 can, for example, use @kbd{C-y} to paste a (possibly multi-line) string
5026 copied from an email message. Org mode will find whatever information is in
5027 there and derive anything you have not specified from the @emph{default date
5028 and time}. The default is usually the current date and time, but when
5029 modifying an existing timestamp, or when entering the second stamp of a
5030 range, it is taken from the stamp in the buffer. When filling in
5031 information, Org mode assumes that most of the time you will want to enter a
5032 date in the future: if you omit the month/year and the given day/month is
5033 @i{before} today, it will assume that you mean a future date@footnote{See the
5034 variable @code{org-read-date-prefer-future}. You may set that variable to
5035 the symbol @code{time} to even make a time before now shift the date to
5036 tomorrow.}. If the date has been automatically shifted into the future, the
5037 time prompt will show this with @samp{(=>F).}
5039 For example, let's assume that today is @b{June 13, 2006}. Here is how
5040 various inputs will be interpreted, the items filled in by Org mode are
5044 3-2-5 --> 2003-02-05
5045 14 --> @b{2006}-@b{06}-14
5046 12 --> @b{2006}-@b{07}-12
5047 Fri --> nearest Friday (defaultdate or later)
5048 sep 15 --> @b{2006}-09-15
5049 feb 15 --> @b{2007}-02-15
5050 sep 12 9 --> 2009-09-12
5051 12:45 --> @b{2006}-@b{06}-@b{13} 12:45
5052 22 sept 0:34 --> @b{2006}-09-22 0:34
5053 w4 --> ISO week for of the current year @b{2006}
5054 2012 w4 fri --> Friday of ISO week 4 in 2012
5055 2012-w04-5 --> Same as above
5058 Furthermore you can specify a relative date by giving, as the
5059 @emph{first} thing in the input: a plus/minus sign, a number and a
5060 letter ([dwmy]) to indicate change in days, weeks, months, or years. With a
5061 single plus or minus, the date is always relative to today. With a
5062 double plus or minus, it is relative to the default date. If instead of
5063 a single letter, you use the abbreviation of day name, the date will be
5064 the nth such day. E.g.
5069 +4d --> four days from today
5070 +4 --> same as above
5071 +2w --> two weeks from today
5072 ++5 --> five days from default date
5073 +2tue --> second Tuesday from now.
5076 @vindex parse-time-months
5077 @vindex parse-time-weekdays
5078 The function understands English month and weekday abbreviations. If
5079 you want to use unabbreviated names and/or other languages, configure
5080 the variables @code{parse-time-months} and @code{parse-time-weekdays}.
5082 @cindex calendar, for selecting date
5083 @vindex org-popup-calendar-for-date-prompt
5084 Parallel to the minibuffer prompt, a calendar is popped up@footnote{If
5085 you don't need/want the calendar, configure the variable
5086 @code{org-popup-calendar-for-date-prompt}.}. When you exit the date
5087 prompt, either by clicking on a date in the calendar, or by pressing
5088 @key{RET}, the date selected in the calendar will be combined with the
5089 information entered at the prompt. You can control the calendar fully
5090 from the minibuffer:
5095 @kindex S-@key{right}
5096 @kindex S-@key{left}
5097 @kindex S-@key{down}
5099 @kindex M-S-@key{right}
5100 @kindex M-S-@key{left}
5103 > / < @r{Scroll calendar forward/backward by one month.}
5104 mouse-1 @r{Select date by clicking on it.}
5105 S-@key{right}/@key{left} @r{One day forward/backward.}
5106 S-@key{down}/@key{up} @r{One week forward/backward.}
5107 M-S-@key{right}/@key{left} @r{One month forward/backward.}
5108 @key{RET} @r{Choose date in calendar.}
5111 @vindex org-read-date-display-live
5112 The actions of the date/time prompt may seem complex, but I assure you they
5113 will grow on you, and you will start getting annoyed by pretty much any other
5114 way of entering a date/time out there. To help you understand what is going
5115 on, the current interpretation of your input will be displayed live in the
5116 minibuffer@footnote{If you find this distracting, turn the display of with
5117 @code{org-read-date-display-live}.}.
5119 @node Custom time format, , The date/time prompt, Creating timestamps
5120 @subsection Custom time format
5121 @cindex custom date/time format
5122 @cindex time format, custom
5123 @cindex date format, custom
5125 @vindex org-display-custom-times
5126 @vindex org-time-stamp-custom-formats
5127 Org mode uses the standard ISO notation for dates and times as it is
5128 defined in ISO 8601. If you cannot get used to this and require another
5129 representation of date and time to keep you happy, you can get it by
5130 customizing the variables @code{org-display-custom-times} and
5131 @code{org-time-stamp-custom-formats}.
5136 Toggle the display of custom formats for dates and times.
5140 Org mode needs the default format for scanning, so the custom date/time
5141 format does not @emph{replace} the default format---instead it is put
5142 @emph{over} the default format using text properties. This has the
5143 following consequences:
5146 You cannot place the cursor onto a timestamp anymore, only before or
5149 The @kbd{S-@key{up}/@key{down}} keys can no longer be used to adjust
5150 each component of a timestamp. If the cursor is at the beginning of
5151 the stamp, @kbd{S-@key{up}/@key{down}} will change the stamp by one day,
5152 just like @kbd{S-@key{left}/@key{right}}. At the end of the stamp, the
5153 time will be changed by one minute.
5155 If the timestamp contains a range of clock times or a repeater, these
5156 will not be overlayed, but remain in the buffer as they were.
5158 When you delete a timestamp character-by-character, it will only
5159 disappear from the buffer after @emph{all} (invisible) characters
5160 belonging to the ISO timestamp have been removed.
5162 If the custom timestamp format is longer than the default and you are
5163 using dates in tables, table alignment will be messed up. If the custom
5164 format is shorter, things do work as expected.
5168 @node Deadlines and scheduling, Clocking work time, Creating timestamps, Dates and Times
5169 @section Deadlines and scheduling
5171 A timestamp may be preceded by special keywords to facilitate planning:
5175 @cindex DEADLINE keyword
5177 Meaning: the task (most likely a TODO item, though not necessarily) is supposed
5178 to be finished on that date.
5180 @vindex org-deadline-warning-days
5181 On the deadline date, the task will be listed in the agenda. In
5182 addition, the agenda for @emph{today} will carry a warning about the
5183 approaching or missed deadline, starting
5184 @code{org-deadline-warning-days} before the due date, and continuing
5185 until the entry is marked DONE. An example:
5188 *** TODO write article about the Earth for the Guide
5189 The editor in charge is [[bbdb:Ford Prefect]]
5190 DEADLINE: <2004-02-29 Sun>
5193 You can specify a different lead time for warnings for a specific
5194 deadlines using the following syntax. Here is an example with a warning
5195 period of 5 days @code{DEADLINE: <2004-02-29 Sun -5d>}.
5198 @cindex SCHEDULED keyword
5200 Meaning: you are planning to start working on that task on the given
5203 @vindex org-agenda-skip-scheduled-if-done
5204 The headline will be listed under the given date@footnote{It will still
5205 be listed on that date after it has been marked DONE. If you don't like
5206 this, set the variable @code{org-agenda-skip-scheduled-if-done}.}. In
5207 addition, a reminder that the scheduled date has passed will be present
5208 in the compilation for @emph{today}, until the entry is marked DONE.
5209 I.e. the task will automatically be forwarded until completed.
5212 *** TODO Call Trillian for a date on New Years Eve.
5213 SCHEDULED: <2004-12-25 Sat>
5217 @b{Important:} Scheduling an item in Org mode should @i{not} be
5218 understood in the same way that we understand @i{scheduling a meeting}.
5219 Setting a date for a meeting is just a simple appointment, you should
5220 mark this entry with a simple plain timestamp, to get this item shown
5221 on the date where it applies. This is a frequent misunderstanding by
5222 Org users. In Org mode, @i{scheduling} means setting a date when you
5223 want to start working on an action item.
5226 You may use timestamps with repeaters in scheduling and deadline
5227 entries. Org mode will issue early and late warnings based on the
5228 assumption that the timestamp represents the @i{nearest instance} of
5229 the repeater. However, the use of diary sexp entries like
5231 @code{<%%(diary-float t 42)>}
5233 in scheduling and deadline timestamps is limited. Org mode does not
5234 know enough about the internals of each sexp function to issue early and
5235 late warnings. However, it will show the item on each day where the
5239 * Inserting deadline/schedule:: Planning items
5240 * Repeated tasks:: Items that show up again and again
5243 @node Inserting deadline/schedule, Repeated tasks, Deadlines and scheduling, Deadlines and scheduling
5244 @subsection Inserting deadlines or schedules
5246 The following commands allow you to quickly insert a deadline or to schedule
5253 Insert @samp{DEADLINE} keyword along with a stamp. The insertion will happen
5254 in the line directly following the headline. When called with a prefix arg,
5255 an existing deadline will be removed from the entry. Depending on the
5256 variable @code{org-log-redeadline}@footnote{with corresponding
5257 @code{#+STARTUP} keywords @code{logredeadline}, @code{lognoteredeadline},
5258 and @code{nologredeadline}}, a note will be taken when changing an existing
5260 @c FIXME Any CLOSED timestamp will be removed.????????
5264 Insert @samp{SCHEDULED} keyword along with a stamp. The insertion will
5265 happen in the line directly following the headline. Any CLOSED timestamp
5266 will be removed. When called with a prefix argument, remove the scheduling
5267 date from the entry. Depending on the variable
5268 @code{org-log-reschedule}@footnote{with corresponding @code{#+STARTUP}
5269 keywords @code{logredeadline}, @code{lognoteredeadline}, and
5270 @code{nologredeadline}}, a note will be taken when changing an existing
5277 Mark the current entry for agenda action. After you have marked the entry
5278 like this, you can open the agenda or the calendar to find an appropriate
5279 date. With the cursor on the selected date, press @kbd{k s} or @kbd{k d} to
5280 schedule the marked item.
5283 @cindex sparse tree, for deadlines
5285 @vindex org-deadline-warning-days
5286 Create a sparse tree with all deadlines that are either past-due, or
5287 which will become due within @code{org-deadline-warning-days}.
5288 With @kbd{C-u} prefix, show all deadlines in the file. With a numeric
5289 prefix, check that many days. For example, @kbd{C-1 C-c / d} shows
5290 all deadlines due tomorrow.
5294 Sparse tree for deadlines and scheduled items before a given date.
5298 Sparse tree for deadlines and scheduled items after a given date.
5301 @node Repeated tasks, , Inserting deadline/schedule, Deadlines and scheduling
5302 @subsection Repeated tasks
5303 @cindex tasks, repeated
5304 @cindex repeated tasks
5306 Some tasks need to be repeated again and again. Org mode helps to
5307 organize such tasks using a so-called repeater in a DEADLINE, SCHEDULED,
5308 or plain timestamp. In the following example
5310 ** TODO Pay the rent
5311 DEADLINE: <2005-10-01 Sat +1m>
5314 the @code{+1m} is a repeater; the intended interpretation is that the task
5315 has a deadline on <2005-10-01> and repeats itself every (one) month starting
5316 from that time. If you need both a repeater and a special warning period in
5317 a deadline entry, the repeater should come first and the warning period last:
5318 @code{DEADLINE: <2005-10-01 Sat +1m -3d>}.
5320 Deadlines and scheduled items produce entries in the agenda when they
5321 are over-due, so it is important to be able to mark such an entry as
5322 completed once you have done so. When you mark a DEADLINE or a SCHEDULE
5323 with the TODO keyword DONE, it will no longer produce entries in the
5324 agenda. The problem with this is, however, that then also the
5325 @emph{next} instance of the repeated entry will not be active. Org mode
5326 deals with this in the following way: When you try to mark such an entry
5327 DONE (using @kbd{C-c C-t}), it will shift the base date of the repeating
5328 timestamp by the repeater interval, and immediately set the entry state
5329 back to TODO. In the example above, setting the state to DONE would
5330 actually switch the date like this:
5333 ** TODO Pay the rent
5334 DEADLINE: <2005-11-01 Tue +1m>
5337 @vindex org-log-repeat
5338 A timestamp@footnote{You can change this using the option
5339 @code{org-log-repeat}, or the @code{#+STARTUP} options @code{logrepeat},
5340 @code{lognoterepeat}, and @code{nologrepeat}. With @code{lognoterepeat}, you
5341 will also be prompted for a note.} will be added under the deadline, to keep
5342 a record that you actually acted on the previous instance of this deadline.
5344 As a consequence of shifting the base date, this entry will no longer be
5345 visible in the agenda when checking past dates, but all future instances
5348 With the @samp{+1m} cookie, the date shift will always be exactly one
5349 month. So if you have not paid the rent for three months, marking this
5350 entry DONE will still keep it as an overdue deadline. Depending on the
5351 task, this may not be the best way to handle it. For example, if you
5352 forgot to call you father for 3 weeks, it does not make sense to call
5353 him 3 times in a single day to make up for it. Finally, there are tasks
5354 like changing batteries which should always repeat a certain time
5355 @i{after} the last time you did it. For these tasks, Org mode has
5356 special repeaters markers with @samp{++} and @samp{.+}. For example:
5360 DEADLINE: <2008-02-10 Sun ++1w>
5361 Marking this DONE will shift the date by at least one week,
5362 but also by as many weeks as it takes to get this date into
5363 the future. However, it stays on a Sunday, even if you called
5364 and marked it done on Saturday.
5365 ** TODO Check the batteries in the smoke detectors
5366 DEADLINE: <2005-11-01 Tue .+1m>
5367 Marking this DONE will shift the date to one month after
5371 You may have both scheduling and deadline information for a specific
5372 task---just make sure that the repeater intervals on both are the same.
5374 An alternative to using a repeater is to create a number of copies of a task
5375 subtree, with dates shifted in each copy. The command @kbd{C-c C-x c} was
5376 created for this purpose, it is described in @ref{Structure editing}.
5379 @node Clocking work time, Resolving idle time, Deadlines and scheduling, Dates and Times
5380 @section Clocking work time
5382 Org mode allows you to clock the time you spend on specific tasks in a
5383 project. When you start working on an item, you can start the clock.
5384 When you stop working on that task, or when you mark the task done, the
5385 clock is stopped and the corresponding time interval is recorded. It
5386 also computes the total time spent on each subtree of a project. And it
5387 remembers a history or tasks recently clocked, to that you can jump quickly
5388 between a number of tasks absorbing your time.
5390 To save the clock history across Emacs sessions, use
5392 (setq org-clock-persist 'history)
5393 (org-clock-persistence-insinuate)
5395 When you clock into a new task after resuming Emacs, the incomplete
5396 clock@footnote{To resume the clock under the assumption that you have worked
5397 on this task while outside Emacs, use @code{(setq org-clock-persist t)}.}
5398 will be found (@pxref{Resolving idle time}) and you will be prompted about
5404 @vindex org-clock-into-drawer
5405 Start the clock on the current item (clock-in). This inserts the CLOCK
5406 keyword together with a timestamp. If this is not the first clocking of
5407 this item, the multiple CLOCK lines will be wrapped into a
5408 @code{:LOGBOOK:} drawer (see also the variable
5409 @code{org-clock-into-drawer}). When called with a @kbd{C-u} prefix argument,
5410 select the task from a list of recently clocked tasks. With two @kbd{C-u
5411 C-u} prefixes, clock into the task at point and mark it as the default task.
5412 The default task will always be available when selecting a clocking task,
5413 with letter @kbd{d}.@*
5414 @cindex property: CLOCK_MODELINE_TOTAL
5415 @cindex property: LAST_REPEAT
5416 @vindex org-clock-modeline-total
5417 While the clock is running, the current clocking time is shown in the mode
5418 line, along with the title of the task. The clock time shown will be all
5419 time ever clocked for this task and its children. If the task has an effort
5420 estimate (@pxref{Effort estimates}), the mode line displays the current
5421 clocking time against it@footnote{To add an effort estimate ``on the fly'',
5422 hook a function doing this to @code{org-clock-in-prepare-hook}.} If the task
5423 is a repeating one (@pxref{Repeated tasks}), only the time since the last
5424 reset of the task @footnote{as recorded by the @code{LAST_REPEAT} property}
5425 will be shown. More control over what time is shown can be exercised with
5426 the @code{CLOCK_MODELINE_TOTAL} property. It may have the values
5427 @code{current} to show only the current clocking instance, @code{today} to
5428 show all time clocked on this tasks today (see also the variable
5429 @code{org-extend-today-until}), @code{all} to include all time, or
5430 @code{auto} which is the default@footnote{See also the variable
5431 @code{org-clock-modeline-total}.}.@* Clicking with @kbd{mouse-1} onto the
5432 mode line entry will pop up a menu with clocking options.
5435 @vindex org-log-note-clock-out
5436 Stop the clock (clock-out). This inserts another timestamp at the same
5437 location where the clock was last started. It also directly computes
5438 the resulting time in inserts it after the time range as @samp{=>
5439 HH:MM}. See the variable @code{org-log-note-clock-out} for the
5440 possibility to record an additional note together with the clock-out
5441 timestamp@footnote{The corresponding in-buffer setting is:
5442 @code{#+STARTUP: lognoteclock-out}}.
5445 Update the effort estimate for the current clock task.
5448 @item C-c C-y @ @ @r{or}@ @ C-c C-c
5449 Recompute the time interval after changing one of the timestamps. This
5450 is only necessary if you edit the timestamps directly. If you change
5451 them with @kbd{S-@key{cursor}} keys, the update is automatic.
5454 Changing the TODO state of an item to DONE automatically stops the clock
5455 if it is running in this same item.
5458 Cancel the current clock. This is useful if a clock was started by
5459 mistake, or if you ended up working on something else.
5462 Jump to the entry that contains the currently running clock. With a
5463 @kbd{C-u} prefix arg, select the target task from a list of recently clocked
5467 @vindex org-remove-highlights-with-change
5468 Display time summaries for each subtree in the current buffer. This
5469 puts overlays at the end of each headline, showing the total time
5470 recorded under that heading, including the time of any subheadings. You
5471 can use visibility cycling to study the tree, but the overlays disappear
5472 when you change the buffer (see variable
5473 @code{org-remove-highlights-with-change}) or press @kbd{C-c C-c}.
5476 Insert a dynamic block (@pxref{Dynamic blocks}) containing a clock
5477 report as an Org-mode table into the current file. When the cursor is
5478 at an existing clock table, just update it. When called with a prefix
5479 argument, jump to the first clock report in the current document and
5481 @cindex #+BEGIN, clocktable
5483 #+BEGIN: clocktable :maxlevel 2 :emphasize nil :scope file
5487 If such a block already exists at point, its content is replaced by the
5488 new table. The @samp{BEGIN} line can specify options:
5490 :maxlevel @r{Maximum level depth to which times are listed in the table.}
5491 :emphasize @r{When @code{t}, emphasize level one and level two items.}
5492 :scope @r{The scope to consider. This can be any of the following:}
5493 nil @r{the current buffer or narrowed region}
5494 file @r{the full current buffer}
5495 subtree @r{the subtree where the clocktable is located}
5496 tree@var{N} @r{the surrounding level @var{N} tree, for example @code{tree3}}
5497 tree @r{the surrounding level 1 tree}
5498 agenda @r{all agenda files}
5499 ("file"..) @r{scan these files}
5500 file-with-archives @r{current file and its archives}
5501 agenda-with-archives @r{all agenda files, including archives}
5502 :block @r{The time block to consider. This block is specified either}
5503 @r{absolute, or relative to the current time and may be any of}
5505 2007-12-31 @r{New year eve 2007}
5506 2007-12 @r{December 2007}
5507 2007-W50 @r{ISO-week 50 in 2007}
5508 2007 @r{the year 2007}
5509 today, yesterday, today-@var{N} @r{a relative day}
5510 thisweek, lastweek, thisweek-@var{N} @r{a relative week}
5511 thismonth, lastmonth, thismonth-@var{N} @r{a relative month}
5512 thisyear, lastyear, thisyear-@var{N} @r{a relative year}
5513 @r{Use @kbd{S-@key{left}/@key{right}} keys to shift the time interval.}
5514 :tstart @r{A time string specifying when to start considering times.}
5515 :tend @r{A time string specifying when to stop considering times.}
5516 :step @r{@code{week} or @code{day}, to split the table into chunks.}
5517 @r{To use this, @code{:block} or @code{:tstart}, @code{:tend} are needed.}
5518 :link @r{Link the item headlines in the table to their origins.}
5519 :formula @r{Content of a @code{#+TBLFM} line to be added and evaluated.}
5520 @r{As a special case, @samp{:formula %} adds a column with % time.}
5521 @r{If you do not specify a formula here, any existing formula.}
5522 @r{below the clock table will survive updates and be evaluated.}
5523 :timestamp @r{A timestamp for the entry, when available. Look for SCHEDULED,}
5524 @r{DEADLINE, TIMESTAMP and TIMESTAMP_IA, in this order.}
5526 To get a clock summary of the current level 1 tree, for the current
5527 day, you could write
5529 #+BEGIN: clocktable :maxlevel 2 :block today :scope tree1 :link t
5533 and to use a specific time range you could write@footnote{Note that all
5534 parameters must be specified in a single line---the line is broken here
5535 only to fit it into the manual.}
5537 #+BEGIN: clocktable :tstart "<2006-08-10 Thu 10:00>"
5538 :tend "<2006-08-10 Thu 12:00>"
5541 A summary of the current subtree with % times would be
5543 #+BEGIN: clocktable :scope subtree :link t :formula %
5550 Update dynamic block at point. The cursor needs to be in the
5551 @code{#+BEGIN} line of the dynamic block.
5552 @kindex C-u C-c C-x C-u
5553 @item C-u C-c C-x C-u
5554 Update all dynamic blocks (@pxref{Dynamic blocks}). This is useful if
5555 you have several clock table blocks in a buffer.
5556 @kindex S-@key{left}
5557 @kindex S-@key{right}
5559 @itemx S-@key{right}
5560 Shift the current @code{:block} interval and update the table. The cursor
5561 needs to be in the @code{#+BEGIN: clocktable} line for this command. If
5562 @code{:block} is @code{today}, it will be shifted to @code{today-1} etc.
5565 The @kbd{l} key may be used in the timeline (@pxref{Timeline}) and in
5566 the agenda (@pxref{Weekly/daily agenda}) to show which tasks have been
5567 worked on or closed during a day.
5569 @node Resolving idle time, Effort estimates, Clocking work time, Dates and Times
5570 @section Resolving idle time
5571 @cindex resolve idle time
5573 @cindex idle, resolve, dangling
5574 If you clock in on a work item, and then walk away from your
5575 computer---perhaps to take a phone call---you often need to ``resolve'' the
5576 time you were away by either subtracting it from the current clock, or
5577 applying it to another one.
5579 @vindex org-clock-idle-time
5580 By customizing the variable @code{org-clock-idle-time} to some integer, such
5581 as 10 or 15, Emacs can alert you when you get back to your computer after
5582 being idle for that many minutes@footnote{On computers using Mac OS X,
5583 idleness is based on actual user idleness, not just Emacs' idle time. For
5584 X11, you can install a utility program @file{x11idle.c}, available in the
5585 UTILITIES directory of the Org git distribution, to get the same general
5586 treatment of idleness. On other systems, idle time refers to Emacs idle time
5587 only.}, and ask what you want to do with the idle time. There will be a
5588 question waiting for you when you get back, indicating how much idle time has
5589 passed (constantly updated with the current amount), as well as a set of
5590 choices to correct the discrepancy:
5594 To keep some or all of the minutes and stay clocked in, press @kbd{k}. Org
5595 will ask how many of the minutes to keep. Press @key{RET} to keep them all,
5596 effectively changing nothing, or enter a number to keep that many minutes.
5598 If you use the shift key and press @kbd{K}, it will keep however many minutes
5599 you request and then immediately clock out of that task. If you keep all of
5600 the minutes, this is the same as just clocking out of the current task.
5602 To keep none of the minutes, use @kbd{s} to subtract all the away time from
5603 the clock, and then check back in from the moment you returned.
5605 To keep none of the minutes and just clock out at the start of the away time,
5606 use the shift key and press @kbd{S}. Remember that using shift will always
5607 leave you clocked out, no matter which option you choose.
5609 To cancel the clock altogether, use @kbd{C}. Note that if instead of
5610 cancelling you subtract the away time, and the resulting clock amount is less
5611 than a minute, the clock will still be cancelled rather than clutter up the
5612 log with an empty entry.
5615 What if you subtracted those away minutes from the current clock, and now
5616 want to apply them to a new clock? Simply clock in to any task immediately
5617 after the subtraction. Org will notice that you have subtracted time ``on
5618 the books'', so to speak, and will ask if you want to apply those minutes to
5619 the next task you clock in on.
5621 There is one other instance when this clock resolution magic occurs. Say you
5622 were clocked in and hacking away, and suddenly your cat chased a mouse who
5623 scared a hamster that crashed into your UPS's power button! You suddenly
5624 lose all your buffers, but thanks to auto-save you still have your recent Org
5625 mode changes, including your last clock in.
5627 If you restart Emacs and clock into any task, Org will notice that you have a
5628 dangling clock which was never clocked out from your last session. Using
5629 that clock's starting time as the beginning of the unaccounted-for period,
5630 Org will ask how you want to resolve that time. The logic and behavior is
5631 identical to dealing with away time due to idleness, it's just happening due
5632 to a recovery event rather than a set amount of idle time.
5634 You can also check all the files visited by your Org agenda for dangling
5635 clocks at any time using @kbd{M-x org-resolve-clocks}.
5637 @node Effort estimates, Relative timer, Resolving idle time, Dates and Times
5638 @section Effort estimates
5639 @cindex effort estimates
5641 @cindex property, Effort
5642 @vindex org-effort-property
5643 If you want to plan your work in a very detailed way, or if you need to
5644 produce offers with quotations of the estimated work effort, you may want to
5645 assign effort estimates to entries. If you are also clocking your work, you
5646 may later want to compare the planned effort with the actual working time, a
5647 great way to improve planning estimates. Effort estimates are stored in a
5648 special property @samp{Effort}@footnote{You may change the property being
5649 used with the variable @code{org-effort-property}.}. You can set the effort
5650 for an entry with the following commands:
5655 Set the effort estimate for the current entry. With a numeric prefix
5656 argument, set it to the NTH allowed value (see below). This command is also
5657 accessible from the agenda with the @kbd{e} key.
5660 Modify the effort estimate of the item currently being clocked.
5663 Clearly the best way to work with effort estimates is through column view
5664 (@pxref{Column view}). You should start by setting up discrete values for
5665 effort estimates, and a @code{COLUMNS} format that displays these values
5666 together with clock sums (if you want to clock your time). For a specific
5670 #+PROPERTY: Effort_ALL 0 0:10 0:30 1:00 2:00 3:00 4:00 5:00 6:00 7:00 8:00
5671 #+COLUMNS: %40ITEM(Task) %17Effort(Estimated Effort)@{:@} %CLOCKSUM
5675 @vindex org-global-properties
5676 @vindex org-columns-default-format
5677 or, even better, you can set up these values globally by customizing the
5678 variables @code{org-global-properties} and @code{org-columns-default-format}.
5679 In particular if you want to use this setup also in the agenda, a global
5680 setup may be advised.
5682 The way to assign estimates to individual items is then to switch to column
5683 mode, and to use @kbd{S-@key{right}} and @kbd{S-@key{left}} to change the
5684 value. The values you enter will immediately be summed up in the hierarchy.
5685 In the column next to it, any clocked time will be displayed.
5687 @vindex org-agenda-columns-add-appointments-to-effort-sum
5688 If you switch to column view in the daily/weekly agenda, the effort column
5689 will summarize the estimated work effort for each day@footnote{Please note
5690 the pitfalls of summing hierarchical data in a flat list (@pxref{Agenda
5691 column view}).}, and you can use this to find space in your schedule. To get
5692 an overview of the entire part of the day that is committed, you can set the
5693 option @code{org-agenda-columns-add-appointments-to-effort-sum}. The
5694 appointments on a day that take place over a specified time interval will
5695 then also be added to the load estimate of the day.
5697 Effort estimates can be used in secondary agenda filtering that is triggered
5698 with the @kbd{/} key in the agenda (@pxref{Agenda commands}). If you have
5699 these estimates defined consistently, two or three key presses will narrow
5700 down the list to stuff that fits into an available time slot.
5702 @node Relative timer, , Effort estimates, Dates and Times
5703 @section Taking notes with a relative timer
5704 @cindex relative timer
5706 When taking notes during, for example, a meeting or a video viewing, it can
5707 be useful to have access to times relative to a starting time. Org provides
5708 such a relative timer and make it easy to create timed notes.
5713 Insert a relative time into the buffer. The first time you use this, the
5714 timer will be started. When called with a prefix argument, the timer is
5718 Insert a description list item with the current relative time. With a prefix
5719 argument, first reset the timer to 0.
5722 Once the timer list is started, you can also use @kbd{M-@key{RET}} to insert
5726 Pause the timer, or continue it if it is already paused.
5727 @c removed the sentence because it is redundant to the following item
5728 @kindex C-u C-c C-x ,
5730 Stop the timer. After this, you can only start a new timer, not continue the
5731 old one. This command also removes the timer from the mode line.
5734 Reset the timer without inserting anything into the buffer. By default, the
5735 timer is reset to 0. When called with a @kbd{C-u} prefix, reset the timer to
5736 specific starting offset. The user is prompted for the offset, with a
5737 default taken from a timer string at point, if any, So this can be used to
5738 restart taking notes after a break in the process. When called with a double
5739 prefix argument @kbd{C-c C-u}, change all timer strings in the active region
5740 by a certain amount. This can be used to fix timer strings if the timer was
5741 not started at exactly the right moment.
5744 @node Capture - Refile - Archive, Agenda Views, Dates and Times, Top
5745 @chapter Capture - Refile - Archive
5748 An important part of any organization system is the ability to quickly
5749 capture new ideas and tasks, and to associate reference material with them.
5750 Org uses the @file{remember.el} package to create tasks, and stores files
5751 related to a task (@i{attachments}) in a special directory. Once in the
5752 system, tasks and projects need to be moved around. Moving completed project
5753 trees to an archive file keeps the system compact and fast.
5756 * Remember:: Capture new tasks/ideas with little interruption
5757 * Attachments:: Add files to tasks.
5758 * RSS Feeds:: Getting input from RSS feeds
5759 * Protocols:: External (e.g. Browser) access to Emacs and Org
5760 * Refiling notes:: Moving a tree from one place to another
5761 * Archiving:: What to do with finished projects
5764 @node Remember, Attachments, Capture - Refile - Archive, Capture - Refile - Archive
5766 @cindex @file{remember.el}
5768 The Remember package by John Wiegley lets you store quick notes with little
5769 interruption of your work flow. It is an excellent way to add new notes and
5770 tasks to Org files. The @code{remember.el} package is part of Emacs 23, not
5771 Emacs 22. See @uref{http://www.emacswiki.org/cgi-bin/wiki/RememberMode} for
5774 Org significantly expands the possibilities of Remember: you may define
5775 templates for different note types, and associate target files and headlines
5776 with specific templates. It also allows you to select the location where a
5777 note should be stored interactively, on the fly.
5780 * Setting up Remember for Org:: Some code for .emacs to get things going
5781 * Remember templates:: Define the outline of different note types
5782 * Storing notes:: Directly get the note to where it belongs
5785 @node Setting up Remember for Org, Remember templates, Remember, Remember
5786 @subsection Setting up Remember for Org
5788 The following customization will tell Remember to use Org files as
5789 target, and to create annotations compatible with Org links.
5792 (org-remember-insinuate)
5793 (setq org-directory "~/path/to/my/orgfiles/")
5794 (setq org-default-notes-file (concat org-directory "/notes.org"))
5795 (define-key global-map "\C-cr" 'org-remember)
5799 The last line binds the command @code{org-remember} to a global
5800 key@footnote{Please select your own key, @kbd{C-c r} is only a
5801 suggestion.}. @code{org-remember} basically just calls Remember,
5802 but it makes a few things easier: if there is an active region, it will
5803 automatically copy the region into the Remember buffer. It also allows
5804 to jump to the buffer and location where Remember notes are being
5805 stored: just call @code{org-remember} with a prefix argument. If you
5806 use two prefix arguments, Org jumps to the location where the last
5807 remember note was stored.
5809 The Remember buffer will actually use @code{org-mode} as its major mode, so
5810 that all editing features of Org mode are available. In addition to this, a
5811 minor mode @code{org-remember-mode} is turned on, for the single purpose that
5812 you can use its keymap @code{org-remember-mode-map} to overwrite some of
5813 Org mode's key bindings.
5815 You can also call @code{org-remember} in a special way from the agenda,
5816 using the @kbd{k r} key combination. With this access, any timestamps
5817 inserted by the selected Remember template (see below) will default to
5818 the cursor date in the agenda, rather than to the current date.
5820 @node Remember templates, Storing notes, Setting up Remember for Org, Remember
5821 @subsection Remember templates
5822 @cindex templates, for Remember
5824 In combination with Org, you can use templates to generate
5825 different types of Remember notes. For example, if you would like
5826 to use one template to create general TODO entries, another one for
5827 journal entries, and a third one for collecting random ideas, you could
5831 (setq org-remember-templates
5832 '(("Todo" ?t "* TODO %?\n %i\n %a" "~/org/TODO.org" "Tasks")
5833 ("Journal" ?j "* %U %?\n\n %i\n %a" "~/org/JOURNAL.org")
5834 ("Idea" ?i "* %^@{Title@}\n %i\n %a" "~/org/JOURNAL.org" "New Ideas")))
5837 @vindex org-remember-default-headline
5838 @vindex org-directory
5839 @noindent In these entries, the first string is just a name, and the
5840 character specifies how to select the template. It is useful if the
5841 character is also the first letter of the name. The next string specifies
5842 the template. Two more (optional) strings give the file in which, and the
5843 headline under which, the new note should be stored. The file (if not
5844 present or @code{nil}) defaults to @code{org-default-notes-file}, the heading
5845 to @code{org-remember-default-headline}. If the file name is not an absolute
5846 path, it will be interpreted relative to @code{org-directory}.
5848 The heading can also be the symbols @code{top} or @code{bottom} to send notes
5849 as level 1 entries to the beginning or end of the file, respectively. It may
5850 also be the symbol @code{date-tree}. Then, a tree with year on level 1,
5851 month on level 2 and day on level three will be build in the file, and the
5852 entry will be filed into the tree under the current date@footnote{If the file
5853 contains an entry with a @code{DATE_TREE} property, the entire date tree will
5854 be build under that entry.}
5856 An optional sixth element specifies the contexts in which the user can select
5857 the template. This element can be a list of major modes or a function.
5858 @code{org-remember} will first check whether the function returns @code{t} or
5859 if we are in any of the listed major modes, and exclude templates for which
5860 this condition is not fulfilled. Templates that do not specify this element
5861 at all, or that use @code{nil} or @code{t} as a value will always be
5867 (setq org-remember-templates
5868 '(("Bug" ?b "* BUG %?\n %i\n %a" "~/org/BUGS.org" "Bugs" (emacs-lisp-mode))
5869 ("Journal" ?j "* %U %?\n\n %i\n %a" "~/org/JOURNAL.org" "X" my-check)
5870 ("Idea" ?i "* %^@{Title@}\n %i\n %a" "~/org/JOURNAL.org" "New Ideas")))
5874 The first template will only be available when invoking @code{org-remember}
5875 from an buffer in @code{emacs-lisp-mode}. The second template will only be
5876 available when the function @code{my-check} returns @code{t}. The third
5877 template will be proposed in any context.
5879 When you call @kbd{M-x org-remember} (or @kbd{M-x remember}) to remember
5880 something, Org will prompt for a key to select the template (if you have
5881 more than one template) and then prepare the buffer like
5884 [[file:@var{link to where you called remember}]]
5888 During expansion of the template, special @kbd{%}-escapes@footnote{If you
5889 need one of these sequences literally, escape the @kbd{%} with a backslash.}
5890 allow dynamic insertion of content:
5892 %^@{@var{prompt}@} @r{prompt the user for a string and replace this sequence with it.}
5893 @r{You may specify a default value and a completion table with}
5894 @r{%^@{prompt|default|completion2|completion3...@}}
5895 @r{The arrow keys access a prompt-specific history.}
5896 %a @r{annotation, normally the link created with @code{org-store-link}}
5897 %A @r{like @code{%a}, but prompt for the description part}
5898 %i @r{initial content, the region when remember is called with C-u.}
5899 @r{The entire text will be indented like @code{%i} itself.}
5900 %t @r{timestamp, date only}
5901 %T @r{timestamp with date and time}
5902 %u, %U @r{like the above, but inactive timestamps}
5903 %^t @r{like @code{%t}, but prompt for date. Similarly @code{%^T}, @code{%^u}, @code{%^U}}
5904 @r{You may define a prompt like @code{%^@{Birthday@}t}}
5905 %n @r{user name (taken from @code{user-full-name})}
5906 %c @r{Current kill ring head.}
5907 %x @r{Content of the X clipboard.}
5908 %^C @r{Interactive selection of which kill or clip to use.}
5909 %^L @r{Like @code{%^C}, but insert as link.}
5910 %^g @r{prompt for tags, with completion on tags in target file.}
5911 %k @r{title of currently clocked task}
5912 %K @r{link to currently clocked task}
5913 %^G @r{prompt for tags, with completion all tags in all agenda files.}
5914 %^@{@var{prop}@}p @r{Prompt the user for a value for property @var{prop}}
5915 %:keyword @r{specific information for certain link types, see below}
5916 %[@var{file}] @r{insert the contents of the file given by @var{file}}
5917 %(@var{sexp}) @r{evaluate Elisp @var{sexp} and replace with the result}
5918 %! @r{immediately store note after completing the template}
5919 @r{(skipping the @kbd{C-c C-c} that normally triggers storing)}
5920 %& @r{jump to target location immediately after storing note}
5924 For specific link types, the following keywords will be
5925 defined@footnote{If you define your own link types (@pxref{Adding
5926 hyperlink types}), any property you store with
5927 @code{org-store-link-props} can be accessed in remember templates in a
5930 @vindex org-from-is-user-regexp
5932 Link type | Available keywords
5933 -------------------+----------------------------------------------
5934 bbdb | %:name %:company
5935 bbdb | %::server %:port %:nick
5936 vm, wl, mh, rmail | %:type %:subject %:message-id
5937 | %:from %:fromname %:fromaddress
5938 | %:to %:toname %:toaddress
5939 | %:fromto @r{(either "to NAME" or "from NAME")@footnote{This will always be the other, not the user. See the variable @code{org-from-is-user-regexp}.}}
5940 gnus | %:group, @r{for messages also all email fields}
5942 info | %:file %:node
5947 To place the cursor after template expansion use:
5950 %? @r{After completing the template, position cursor here.}
5954 If you change your mind about which template to use, call
5955 @code{org-remember} in the remember buffer. You may then select a new
5956 template that will be filled with the previous context information.
5958 @node Storing notes, , Remember templates, Remember
5959 @subsection Storing notes
5961 @vindex org-remember-clock-out-on-exit
5962 When you are finished preparing a note with Remember, you have to press
5963 @kbd{C-c C-c} to file the note away. If you have started the clock in the
5964 Remember buffer, you will first be asked if you want to clock out
5965 now@footnote{To avoid this query, configure the variable
5966 @code{org-remember-clock-out-on-exit}.}. If you answer @kbd{n}, the clock
5967 will continue to run after the note was filed away.
5969 The handler will then store the note in the file and under the headline
5970 specified in the template, or it will use the default file and headline.
5971 The window configuration will be restored, sending you back to the working
5972 context before the call to Remember. To re-use the location found
5973 during the last call to Remember, exit the Remember buffer with
5974 @kbd{C-0 C-c C-c}, i.e. specify a zero prefix argument to @kbd{C-c C-c}.
5975 Another special case is @kbd{C-2 C-c C-c} which files the note as a child of
5976 the currently clocked item.
5978 @vindex org-remember-store-without-prompt
5979 If you want to store the note directly to a different place, use
5980 @kbd{C-1 C-c C-c} instead to exit Remember@footnote{Configure the
5981 variable @code{org-remember-store-without-prompt} to make this behavior
5982 the default.}. The handler will then first prompt for a target file---if
5983 you press @key{RET}, the value specified for the template is used.
5984 Then the command offers the headings tree of the selected file, with the
5985 cursor position at the default headline (if you specified one in the
5986 template). You can either immediately press @key{RET} to get the note
5987 placed there. Or you can use the following keys to find a different
5990 @key{TAB} @r{Cycle visibility.}
5991 @key{down} / @key{up} @r{Next/previous visible headline.}
5992 n / p @r{Next/previous visible headline.}
5993 f / b @r{Next/previous headline same level.}
5995 @c 0-9 @r{Digit argument.}
5998 Pressing @key{RET} or @key{left} or @key{right}
5999 then leads to the following result.
6001 @vindex org-reverse-note-order
6002 @multitable @columnfractions 0.2 0.15 0.65
6003 @item @b{Cursor position} @tab @b{Key} @tab @b{Note gets inserted}
6004 @item on headline @tab @key{RET} @tab as sublevel of the heading at cursor, first or last
6005 @item @tab @tab depending on @code{org-reverse-note-order}.
6006 @item @tab @key{left}/@key{right} @tab as same level, before/after current heading
6007 @item buffer-start @tab @key{RET} @tab as level 2 heading at end of file or level 1 at beginning
6008 @item @tab @tab depending on @code{org-reverse-note-order}.
6009 @item not on headline @tab @key{RET}
6010 @tab at cursor position, level taken from context.
6013 Before inserting the text into a tree, the function ensures that the text has
6014 a headline, i.e. a first line that starts with a @samp{*}. If not, a
6015 headline is constructed from the current date. If you have indented the text
6016 of the note below the headline, the indentation will be adapted if inserting
6017 the note into the tree requires demotion from level 1.
6020 @node Attachments, RSS Feeds, Remember, Capture - Refile - Archive
6021 @section Attachments
6024 @vindex org-attach-directory
6025 It is often useful to associate reference material with an outline node/task.
6026 Small chunks of plain text can simply be stored in the subtree of a project.
6027 Hyperlinks (@pxref{Hyperlinks}) can be used to establish associations with
6028 files that live elsewhere on your computer or in the cloud, like emails or
6029 source code files belonging to a project. Another method is @i{attachments},
6030 which are files located in a directory belonging to an outline node. Org
6031 uses directories named by the unique ID of each entry. These directories are
6032 located in the @file{data} directory which lives in the same directory where
6033 your Org file lives@footnote{If you move entries or Org files from one
6034 directory to another, you may want to configure @code{org-attach-directory}
6035 to contain an absolute path.}. If you initialize this directory with
6036 @code{git init}, Org will automatically commit changes when it sees them.
6037 The attachment system has been contributed to Org by John Wiegley.
6039 In cases where it seems better to do so, you can also attach a directory of your
6040 choice to an entry. You can also make children inherit the attachment
6041 directory from a parent, so that an entire subtree uses the same attached
6044 @noindent The following commands deal with attachments.
6050 The dispatcher for commands related to the attachment system. After these
6051 keys, a list of commands is displayed and you need to press an additional key
6052 to select a command:
6057 @vindex org-attach-method
6058 Select a file and move it into the task's attachment directory. The file
6059 will be copied, moved, or linked, depending on @code{org-attach-method}.
6060 Note that hard links are not supported on all systems.
6066 Attach a file using the copy/move/link method.
6067 Note that hard links are not supported on all systems.
6071 Create a new attachment as an Emacs buffer.
6075 Synchronize the current task with its attachment directory, in case you added
6076 attachments yourself.
6080 @vindex org-file-apps
6081 Open current task's attachment. If there are more than one, prompt for a
6082 file name first. Opening will follow the rules set by @code{org-file-apps}.
6083 For more details, see the information on following hyperlinks
6084 (@pxref{Handling links}).
6088 Also open the attachment, but force opening the file in Emacs.
6092 Open the current task's attachment directory.
6096 Also open the directory, but force using @command{dired} in Emacs.
6100 Select and delete a single attachment.
6104 Delete all of a task's attachments. A safer way is to open the directory in
6105 @command{dired} and delete from there.
6109 @cindex property, ATTACH_DIR
6110 Set a specific directory as the entry's attachment directory. This works by
6111 putting the directory path into the @code{ATTACH_DIR} property.
6115 @cindex property, ATTACH_DIR_INHERIT
6116 Set the @code{ATTACH_DIR_INHERIT} property, so that children will use the
6117 same directory for attachments as the parent does.
6121 @node RSS Feeds, Protocols, Attachments, Capture - Refile - Archive
6125 Org has the capability to add and change entries based on information found in
6126 RSS feeds. You could use this to make a task out of each new podcast in a
6127 podcast feed. Or you could use a phone-based note-creating service on the
6128 web to import tasks into Org. To access feeds, you need to configure the
6129 variable @code{org-feed-alist}. The docstring of this variable has detailed
6130 information. Here is just an example:
6133 (setq org-feed-alist
6134 '(("ReQall" "http://www.reqall.com/user/feeds/rss/a1b2c3....."
6135 "~/org/feeds.org" "ReQall Entries")
6138 will configure that new items from the feed provided by @file{reqall.com}
6139 will result in new entries in the file @file{~/org/feeds.org} under the
6140 heading @samp{ReQall Entries}, whenever the following command is used:
6145 Collect items from the feeds configured in @code{org-feed-alist} and act upon
6149 Prompt for a feed name and go to the inbox configured for this feed.
6152 Under the same headline, Org will create a drawer @samp{FEEDSTATUS} in which
6153 it will store information about the status of items in the feed, to avoid
6154 adding the same item several times. You should add @samp{FEEDSTATUS} to the
6155 list of drawers in that file:
6158 #+DRAWERS: LOGBOOK PROPERTIES FEEDSTATUS
6161 For more information, see @file{org-feed.el} and the docstring of
6162 @code{org-feed-alist}.
6164 @node Protocols, Refiling notes, RSS Feeds, Capture - Refile - Archive
6165 @section Protocols for external access
6166 @cindex protocols, for external access
6169 You can set up Org for handling protocol calls from outside applications that
6170 are passed to Emacs through the @file{emacsserver}. For example, you can
6171 configure bookmarks in your web browser to send a link to the current page to
6172 Org and create a note from it using Remember (@pxref{Remember}). Or you
6173 could create a bookmark that will tell Emacs to open the local source file of
6174 a remote website you are looking at with the browser. See
6175 @uref{http://orgmode.org/worg/org-contrib/org-protocol.php} for detailed
6176 documentation and setup instructions.
6178 @node Refiling notes, Archiving, Protocols, Capture - Refile - Archive
6179 @section Refiling notes
6180 @cindex refiling notes
6182 When reviewing the captured data, you may want to refile some of the entries
6183 into a different list, for example into a project. Cutting, finding the
6184 right location, and then pasting the note is cumbersome. To simplify this
6185 process, you can use the following special command:
6190 @vindex org-reverse-note-order
6191 @vindex org-refile-targets
6192 @vindex org-refile-use-outline-path
6193 @vindex org-outline-path-complete-in-steps
6194 @vindex org-refile-allow-creating-parent-nodes
6195 Refile the entry or region at point. This command offers possible locations
6196 for refiling the entry and lets you select one with completion. The item (or
6197 all items in the region) is filed below the target heading as a subitem.
6198 Depending on @code{org-reverse-note-order}, it will be either the first or
6200 By default, all level 1 headlines in the current buffer are considered to be
6201 targets, but you can have more complex definitions across a number of files.
6202 See the variable @code{org-refile-targets} for details. If you would like to
6203 select a location via a file-path-like completion along the outline path, see
6204 the variables @code{org-refile-use-outline-path} and
6205 @code{org-outline-path-complete-in-steps}. If you would like to be able to
6206 create new nodes as new parents for refiling on the fly, check the
6207 variable @code{org-refile-allow-creating-parent-nodes}.
6210 Use the refile interface to jump to a heading.
6211 @kindex C-u C-u C-c C-w
6212 @item C-u C-u C-c C-w
6213 Jump to the location where @code{org-refile} last moved a tree to.
6215 Refile as the child of the item currently being clocked.
6218 @node Archiving, , Refiling notes, Capture - Refile - Archive
6222 When a project represented by a (sub)tree is finished, you may want
6223 to move the tree out of the way and to stop it from contributing to the
6224 agenda. Archiving is important to keep your working files compact and global
6225 searches like the construction of agenda views fast.
6230 @vindex org-archive-default-command
6231 Archive the current entry using the command specified in the variable
6232 @code{org-archive-default-command}.
6236 * Moving subtrees:: Moving a tree to an archive file
6237 * Internal archiving:: Switch off a tree but keep i in the file
6240 @node Moving subtrees, Internal archiving, Archiving, Archiving
6241 @subsection Moving a tree to the archive file
6242 @cindex external archiving
6244 The most common archiving action is to move a project tree to another file,
6250 @item C-c C-x C-s@ @r{or short} @ C-c $
6251 @vindex org-archive-location
6252 Archive the subtree starting at the cursor position to the location
6253 given by @code{org-archive-location}.
6254 @kindex C-u C-c C-x C-s
6255 @item C-u C-c C-x C-s
6256 Check if any direct children of the current headline could be moved to
6257 the archive. To do this, each subtree is checked for open TODO entries.
6258 If none are found, the command offers to move it to the archive
6259 location. If the cursor is @emph{not} on a headline when this command
6260 is invoked, the level 1 trees will be checked.
6263 @cindex archive locations
6264 The default archive location is a file in the same directory as the
6265 current file, with the name derived by appending @file{_archive} to the
6266 current file name. For information and examples on how to change this,
6267 see the documentation string of the variable
6268 @code{org-archive-location}. There is also an in-buffer option for
6269 setting this variable, for example@footnote{For backward compatibility,
6270 the following also works: If there are several such lines in a file,
6271 each specifies the archive location for the text below it. The first
6272 such line also applies to any text before its definition. However,
6273 using this method is @emph{strongly} deprecated as it is incompatible
6274 with the outline structure of the document. The correct method for
6275 setting multiple archive locations in a buffer is using properties.}:
6279 #+ARCHIVE: %s_done::
6282 @cindex property, ARCHIVE
6284 If you would like to have a special ARCHIVE location for a single entry
6285 or a (sub)tree, give the entry an @code{:ARCHIVE:} property with the
6286 location as the value (@pxref{Properties and Columns}).
6288 @vindex org-archive-save-context-info
6289 When a subtree is moved, it receives a number of special properties that
6290 record context information like the file from where the entry came, its
6291 outline path the archiving time etc. Configure the variable
6292 @code{org-archive-save-context-info} to adjust the amount of information
6296 @node Internal archiving, , Moving subtrees, Archiving
6297 @subsection Internal archiving
6299 If you want to just switch off (for agenda views) certain subtrees without
6300 moving them to a different file, you can use the @code{ARCHIVE tag}.
6302 A headline that is marked with the ARCHIVE tag (@pxref{Tags}) stays at
6303 its location in the outline tree, but behaves in the following way:
6306 @vindex org-cycle-open-archived-trees
6307 It does not open when you attempt to do so with a visibility cycling
6308 command (@pxref{Visibility cycling}). You can force cycling archived
6309 subtrees with @kbd{C-@key{TAB}}, or by setting the option
6310 @code{org-cycle-open-archived-trees}. Also normal outline commands like
6311 @code{show-all} will open archived subtrees.
6313 @vindex org-sparse-tree-open-archived-trees
6314 During sparse tree construction (@pxref{Sparse trees}), matches in
6315 archived subtrees are not exposed, unless you configure the option
6316 @code{org-sparse-tree-open-archived-trees}.
6318 @vindex org-agenda-skip-archived-trees
6319 During agenda view construction (@pxref{Agenda Views}), the content of
6320 archived trees is ignored unless you configure the option
6321 @code{org-agenda-skip-archived-trees}, in which case these trees will always
6322 be included. In the agenda you can press @kbd{v a} to get archives
6323 temporarily included.
6325 @vindex org-export-with-archived-trees
6326 Archived trees are not exported (@pxref{Exporting}), only the headline
6327 is. Configure the details using the variable
6328 @code{org-export-with-archived-trees}.
6330 @vindex org-columns-skip-arrchived-trees
6331 Archived trees are excluded from column view unless the variable
6332 @code{org-columns-skip-arrchived-trees} is configured to @code{nil}.
6335 The following commands help managing the ARCHIVE tag:
6340 Toggle the ARCHIVE tag for the current headline. When the tag is set,
6341 the headline changes to a shadowed face, and the subtree below it is
6343 @kindex C-u C-c C-x a
6345 Check if any direct children of the current headline should be archived.
6346 To do this, each subtree is checked for open TODO entries. If none are
6347 found, the command offers to set the ARCHIVE tag for the child. If the
6348 cursor is @emph{not} on a headline when this command is invoked, the
6349 level 1 trees will be checked.
6352 Cycle a tree even if it is tagged with ARCHIVE.
6355 Move the current entry to the @emph{Archive Sibling}. This is a sibling of
6356 the entry with the heading @samp{Archive} and the tag @samp{ARCHIVE}. The
6357 entry becomes a child of that sibling and in this way retains a lot of its
6358 original context, including inherited tags and approximate position in the
6363 @node Agenda Views, Markup, Capture - Refile - Archive, Top
6364 @chapter Agenda Views
6365 @cindex agenda views
6367 Due to the way Org works, TODO items, time-stamped items, and
6368 tagged headlines can be scattered throughout a file or even a number of
6369 files. To get an overview of open action items, or of events that are
6370 important for a particular date, this information must be collected,
6371 sorted and displayed in an organized way.
6373 Org can select items based on various criteria and display them
6374 in a separate buffer. Seven different view types are provided:
6378 an @emph{agenda} that is like a calendar and shows information
6381 a @emph{TODO list} that covers all unfinished
6384 a @emph{match view}, showings headlines based on the tags, properties, and
6385 TODO state associated with them,
6387 a @emph{timeline view} that shows all events in a single Org file,
6388 in time-sorted view,
6390 a @emph{text search view} that shows all entries from multiple files
6391 that contain specified keywords,
6393 a @emph{stuck projects view} showing projects that currently don't move
6396 @emph{custom views} that are special searches and combinations of different
6401 The extracted information is displayed in a special @emph{agenda
6402 buffer}. This buffer is read-only, but provides commands to visit the
6403 corresponding locations in the original Org files, and even to
6404 edit these files remotely.
6406 @vindex org-agenda-window-setup
6407 @vindex org-agenda-restore-windows-after-quit
6408 Two variables control how the agenda buffer is displayed and whether the
6409 window configuration is restored when the agenda exits:
6410 @code{org-agenda-window-setup} and
6411 @code{org-agenda-restore-windows-after-quit}.
6414 * Agenda files:: Files being searched for agenda information
6415 * Agenda dispatcher:: Keyboard access to agenda views
6416 * Built-in agenda views:: What is available out of the box?
6417 * Presentation and sorting:: How agenda items are prepared for display
6418 * Agenda commands:: Remote editing of Org trees
6419 * Custom agenda views:: Defining special searches and views
6420 * Exporting Agenda Views:: Writing a view to a file
6421 * Agenda column view:: Using column view for collected entries
6424 @node Agenda files, Agenda dispatcher, Agenda Views, Agenda Views
6425 @section Agenda files
6426 @cindex agenda files
6427 @cindex files for agenda
6429 @vindex org-agenda-files
6430 The information to be shown is normally collected from all @emph{agenda
6431 files}, the files listed in the variable
6432 @code{org-agenda-files}@footnote{If the value of that variable is not a
6433 list, but a single file name, then the list of agenda files will be
6434 maintained in that external file.}. If a directory is part of this list,
6435 all files with the extension @file{.org} in this directory will be part
6438 Thus, even if you only work with a single Org file, that file should
6439 be put into the list@footnote{When using the dispatcher, pressing
6440 @kbd{<} before selecting a command will actually limit the command to
6441 the current file, and ignore @code{org-agenda-files} until the next
6442 dispatcher command.}. You can customize @code{org-agenda-files}, but
6443 the easiest way to maintain it is through the following commands
6445 @cindex files, adding to agenda list
6449 Add current file to the list of agenda files. The file is added to
6450 the front of the list. If it was already in the list, it is moved to
6451 the front. With a prefix argument, file is added/moved to the end.
6454 Remove current file from the list of agenda files.
6459 Cycle through agenda file list, visiting one file after the other.
6460 @kindex M-x org-iswitchb
6461 @item M-x org-iswitchb
6462 Command to use an @code{iswitchb}-like interface to switch to and between Org
6467 The Org menu contains the current list of files and can be used
6468 to visit any of them.
6470 If you would like to focus the agenda temporarily on a file not in
6471 this list, or on just one file in the list, or even on only a subtree in a
6472 file, then this can be done in different ways. For a single agenda command,
6473 you may press @kbd{<} once or several times in the dispatcher
6474 (@pxref{Agenda dispatcher}). To restrict the agenda scope for an
6475 extended period, use the following commands:
6480 Permanently restrict the agenda to the current subtree. When with a
6481 prefix argument, or with the cursor before the first headline in a file,
6482 the agenda scope is set to the entire file. This restriction remains in
6483 effect until removed with @kbd{C-c C-x >}, or by typing either @kbd{<}
6484 or @kbd{>} in the agenda dispatcher. If there is a window displaying an
6485 agenda view, the new restriction takes effect immediately.
6488 Remove the permanent restriction created by @kbd{C-c C-x <}.
6492 When working with @file{speedbar.el}, you can use the following commands in
6496 @item < @r{in the speedbar frame}
6497 Permanently restrict the agenda to the item---either an Org file or a subtree
6498 in such a file---at the cursor in the Speedbar frame.
6499 If there is a window displaying an agenda view, the new restriction takes
6502 @item > @r{in the speedbar frame}
6503 Lift the restriction.
6506 @node Agenda dispatcher, Built-in agenda views, Agenda files, Agenda Views
6507 @section The agenda dispatcher
6508 @cindex agenda dispatcher
6509 @cindex dispatching agenda commands
6510 The views are created through a dispatcher, which should be bound to a
6511 global key---for example @kbd{C-c a} (@pxref{Installation}). In the
6512 following we will assume that @kbd{C-c a} is indeed how the dispatcher
6513 is accessed and list keyboard access to commands accordingly. After
6514 pressing @kbd{C-c a}, an additional letter is required to execute a
6515 command. The dispatcher offers the following default commands:
6518 Create the calendar-like agenda (@pxref{Weekly/daily agenda}).
6520 Create a list of all TODO items (@pxref{Global TODO list}).
6522 Create a list of headlines matching a TAGS expression (@pxref{Matching
6523 tags and properties}).
6525 Create the timeline view for the current buffer (@pxref{Timeline}).
6527 Create a list of entries selected by a boolean expression of keywords
6528 and/or regular expressions that must or must not occur in the entry.
6530 @vindex org-agenda-text-search-extra-files
6531 Search for a regular expression in all agenda files and additionally in
6532 the files listed in @code{org-agenda-text-search-extra-files}. This
6533 uses the Emacs command @code{multi-occur}. A prefix argument can be
6534 used to specify the number of context lines for each match, default is
6537 Create a list of stuck projects (@pxref{Stuck projects}).
6539 Restrict an agenda command to the current buffer@footnote{For backward
6540 compatibility, you can also press @kbd{1} to restrict to the current
6541 buffer.}. After pressing @kbd{<}, you still need to press the character
6542 selecting the command.
6544 If there is an active region, restrict the following agenda command to
6545 the region. Otherwise, restrict it to the current subtree@footnote{For
6546 backward compatibility, you can also press @kbd{0} to restrict to the
6547 current region/subtree.}. After pressing @kbd{< <}, you still need to press the
6548 character selecting the command.
6551 You can also define custom commands that will be accessible through the
6552 dispatcher, just like the default commands. This includes the
6553 possibility to create extended agenda buffers that contain several
6554 blocks together, for example the weekly agenda, the global TODO list and
6555 a number of special tags matches. @xref{Custom agenda views}.
6557 @node Built-in agenda views, Presentation and sorting, Agenda dispatcher, Agenda Views
6558 @section The built-in agenda views
6560 In this section we describe the built-in views.
6563 * Weekly/daily agenda:: The calendar page with current tasks
6564 * Global TODO list:: All unfinished action items
6565 * Matching tags and properties:: Structured information with fine-tuned search
6566 * Timeline:: Time-sorted view for single file
6567 * Search view:: Find entries by searching for text
6568 * Stuck projects:: Find projects you need to review
6571 @node Weekly/daily agenda, Global TODO list, Built-in agenda views, Built-in agenda views
6572 @subsection The weekly/daily agenda
6574 @cindex weekly agenda
6575 @cindex daily agenda
6577 The purpose of the weekly/daily @emph{agenda} is to act like a page of a
6578 paper agenda, showing all the tasks for the current week or day.
6581 @cindex org-agenda, command
6584 @vindex org-agenda-ndays
6585 Compile an agenda for the current week from a list of Org files. The agenda
6586 shows the entries for each day. With a numeric prefix@footnote{For backward
6587 compatibility, the universal prefix @kbd{C-u} causes all TODO entries to be
6588 listed before the agenda. This feature is deprecated, use the dedicated TODO
6589 list, or a block agenda instead (@pxref{Block agenda}).} (like @kbd{C-u 2 1
6590 C-c a a}) you may set the number of days to be displayed (see also the
6591 variable @code{org-agenda-ndays})
6594 Remote editing from the agenda buffer means, for example, that you can
6595 change the dates of deadlines and appointments from the agenda buffer.
6596 The commands available in the Agenda buffer are listed in @ref{Agenda
6599 @subsubheading Calendar/Diary integration
6600 @cindex calendar integration
6601 @cindex diary integration
6603 Emacs contains the calendar and diary by Edward M. Reingold. The
6604 calendar displays a three-month calendar with holidays from different
6605 countries and cultures. The diary allows you to keep track of
6606 anniversaries, lunar phases, sunrise/set, recurrent appointments
6607 (weekly, monthly) and more. In this way, it is quite complementary to
6608 Org. It can be very useful to combine output from Org with
6611 In order to include entries from the Emacs diary into Org mode's
6612 agenda, you only need to customize the variable
6615 (setq org-agenda-include-diary t)
6618 @noindent After that, everything will happen automatically. All diary
6619 entries including holidays, anniversaries, etc., will be included in the
6620 agenda buffer created by Org mode. @key{SPC}, @key{TAB}, and
6621 @key{RET} can be used from the agenda buffer to jump to the diary
6622 file in order to edit existing diary entries. The @kbd{i} command to
6623 insert new entries for the current date works in the agenda buffer, as
6624 well as the commands @kbd{S}, @kbd{M}, and @kbd{C} to display
6625 Sunrise/Sunset times, show lunar phases and to convert to other
6626 calendars, respectively. @kbd{c} can be used to switch back and forth
6627 between calendar and agenda.
6629 If you are using the diary only for sexp entries and holidays, it is
6630 faster to not use the above setting, but instead to copy or even move
6631 the entries into an Org file. Org mode evaluates diary-style sexp
6632 entries, and does it faster because there is no overhead for first
6633 creating the diary display. Note that the sexp entries must start at
6634 the left margin, no whitespace is allowed before them. For example,
6635 the following segment of an Org file will be processed and entries
6636 will be made in the agenda:
6639 * Birthdays and similar stuff
6641 %%(org-calendar-holiday) ; special function for holiday names
6643 %%(diary-anniversary 5 14 1956)@footnote{Note that the order of the arguments (month, day, year) depends on the setting of @code{calendar-date-style}.} Arthur Dent is %d years old
6644 %%(diary-anniversary 10 2 1869) Mahatma Gandhi would be %d years old
6647 @subsubheading Anniversaries from BBDB
6648 @cindex BBDB, anniversaries
6649 @cindex anniversaries, from BBDB
6651 If you are using the Big Brothers Database to store your contacts, you will
6652 very likely prefer to store anniversaries in BBDB rather than in a
6653 separate Org or diary file. Org supports this and will show BBDB
6654 anniversaries as part of the agenda. All you need to do is to add the
6655 following to one your your agenda files:
6662 %%(org-bbdb-anniversaries)
6665 You can then go ahead and define anniversaries for a BBDB record. Basically,
6666 you need to press @kbd{C-o anniversary @key{RET}} with the cursor in a BBDB
6667 record and then add the date in the format @code{YYYY-MM-DD}, followed by a
6668 space and the class of the anniversary (@samp{birthday} or @samp{wedding}, or
6669 a format string). If you omit the class, it will default to @samp{birthday}.
6670 Here are a few examples, the header for the file @file{org-bbdb.el} contains
6671 more detailed information.
6676 2008-04-14 %s released version 6.01 of org-mode, %d years ago
6679 After a change to BBDB, or for the first agenda display during an Emacs
6680 session, the agenda display will suffer a short delay as Org updates its
6681 hash with anniversaries. However, from then on things will be very fast---much
6682 faster in fact than a long list of @samp{%%(diary-anniversary)} entries
6683 in an Org or Diary file.
6685 @subsubheading Appointment reminders
6686 @cindex @file{appt.el}
6687 @cindex appointment reminders
6689 Org can interact with Emacs appointments notification facility. To add all
6690 the appointments of your agenda files, use the command
6691 @code{org-agenda-to-appt}. This command also lets you filter through the
6692 list of your appointments and add only those belonging to a specific category
6693 or matching a regular expression. See the docstring for details.
6695 @node Global TODO list, Matching tags and properties, Weekly/daily agenda, Built-in agenda views
6696 @subsection The global TODO list
6697 @cindex global TODO list
6698 @cindex TODO list, global
6700 The global TODO list contains all unfinished TODO items formatted and
6701 collected into a single place.
6706 Show the global TODO list. This collects the TODO items from all
6707 agenda files (@pxref{Agenda Views}) into a single buffer. The buffer is in
6708 @code{agenda-mode}, so there are commands to examine and manipulate
6709 the TODO entries directly from that buffer (@pxref{Agenda commands}).
6712 @cindex TODO keyword matching
6713 @vindex org-todo-keywords
6714 Like the above, but allows selection of a specific TODO keyword. You
6715 can also do this by specifying a prefix argument to @kbd{C-c a t}. With
6716 a @kbd{C-u} prefix you are prompted for a keyword, and you may also
6717 specify several keywords by separating them with @samp{|} as the boolean OR
6718 operator. With a numeric prefix, the nth keyword in
6719 @code{org-todo-keywords} is selected.
6721 The @kbd{r} key in the agenda buffer regenerates it, and you can give
6722 a prefix argument to this command to change the selected TODO keyword,
6723 for example @kbd{3 r}. If you often need a search for a specific
6724 keyword, define a custom command for it (@pxref{Agenda dispatcher}).@*
6725 Matching specific TODO keywords can also be done as part of a tags
6726 search (@pxref{Tag searches}).
6729 Remote editing of TODO items means that you can change the state of a
6730 TODO entry with a single key press. The commands available in the
6731 TODO list are described in @ref{Agenda commands}.
6733 @cindex sublevels, inclusion into TODO list
6734 Normally the global TODO list simply shows all headlines with TODO
6735 keywords. This list can become very long. There are two ways to keep
6739 @vindex org-agenda-todo-ignore-scheduled
6740 @vindex org-agenda-todo-ignore-deadlines
6741 @vindex org-agenda-todo-ignore-with-date
6742 Some people view a TODO item that has been @emph{scheduled} for execution or
6743 have a @emph{deadline} (@pxref{Timestamps}) as no longer @emph{open}.
6744 Configure the variables @code{org-agenda-todo-ignore-scheduled},
6745 @code{org-agenda-todo-ignore-deadlines}, and/or
6746 @code{org-agenda-todo-ignore-with-date} to exclude such items from the
6749 @vindex org-agenda-todo-list-sublevels
6750 TODO items may have sublevels to break up the task into subtasks. In
6751 such cases it may be enough to list only the highest level TODO headline
6752 and omit the sublevels from the global list. Configure the variable
6753 @code{org-agenda-todo-list-sublevels} to get this behavior.
6756 @node Matching tags and properties, Timeline, Global TODO list, Built-in agenda views
6757 @subsection Matching tags and properties
6758 @cindex matching, of tags
6759 @cindex matching, of properties
6763 If headlines in the agenda files are marked with @emph{tags} (@pxref{Tags}),
6764 or have properties (@pxref{Properties and Columns}), you can select headlines
6765 based on this metadata and collect them into an agenda buffer. The match
6766 syntax described here also applies when creating sparse trees with @kbd{C-c /
6772 Produce a list of all headlines that match a given set of tags. The
6773 command prompts for a selection criterion, which is a boolean logic
6774 expression with tags, like @samp{+work+urgent-withboss} or
6775 @samp{work|home} (@pxref{Tags}). If you often need a specific search,
6776 define a custom command for it (@pxref{Agenda dispatcher}).
6779 @vindex org-tags-match-list-sublevels
6780 @vindex org-agenda-tags-todo-honor-ignore-options
6781 Like @kbd{C-c a m}, but only select headlines that are also TODO items and
6782 force checking subitems (see variable @code{org-tags-match-list-sublevels}).
6783 To exclude scheduled/deadline items, see the variable
6784 @code{org-agenda-tags-todo-honor-ignore-options}. Matching specific TODO
6785 keywords together with a tags match is also possible, see @ref{Tag searches}.
6788 The commands available in the tags list are described in @ref{Agenda
6791 @subsubheading Match syntax
6793 @cindex Boolean logic, for tag/property searches
6794 A search string can use Boolean operators @samp{&} for AND and @samp{|} for
6795 OR. @samp{&} binds more strongly than @samp{|}. Parentheses are currently
6796 not implemented. Each element in the search is either a tag, a regular
6797 expression matching tags, or an expression like @code{PROPERTY OPERATOR
6798 VALUE} with a comparison operator, accessing a property value. Each element
6799 may be preceded by @samp{-}, to select against it, and @samp{+} is syntactic
6800 sugar for positive selection. The AND operator @samp{&} is optional when
6801 @samp{+} or @samp{-} is present. Here are some examples, using only tags.
6805 Select headlines tagged @samp{:work:}, but discard those also tagged
6808 Selects lines tagged @samp{:work:} or @samp{:laptop:}.
6809 @item work|laptop+night
6810 Like before, but require the @samp{:laptop:} lines to be tagged also
6814 @cindex regular expressions, with tags search
6815 Instead of a tag, you may also specify a regular expression enclosed in curly
6816 braces. For example,
6817 @samp{work+@{^boss.*@}} matches headlines that contain the tag
6818 @samp{:work:} and any tag @i{starting} with @samp{boss}.
6820 @cindex TODO keyword matching, with tags search
6821 @cindex level, require for tags/property match
6822 @cindex category, require for tags/property match
6823 @vindex org-odd-levels-only
6824 You may also test for properties (@pxref{Properties and Columns}) at the same
6825 time as matching tags. The properties may be real properties, or special
6826 properties that represent other metadata (@pxref{Special properties}). For
6827 example, the ``property'' @code{TODO} represents the TODO keyword of the
6828 entry. Or, the ``property'' @code{LEVEL} represents the level of an entry.
6829 So a search @samp{+LEVEL=3+boss-TODO="DONE"} lists all level three headlines
6830 that have the tag @samp{boss} and are @emph{not} marked with the TODO keyword
6831 DONE. In buffers with @code{org-odd-levels-only} set, @samp{LEVEL} does not
6832 count the number of stars, but @samp{LEVEL=2} will correspond to 3 stars etc.
6834 Here are more examples:
6836 @item work+TODO="WAITING"
6837 Select @samp{:work:}-tagged TODO lines with the specific TODO
6838 keyword @samp{WAITING}.
6839 @item work+TODO="WAITING"|home+TODO="WAITING"
6840 Waiting tasks both at work and at home.
6843 When matching properties, a number of different operators can be used to test
6844 the value of a property. Here is a complex example:
6847 +work-boss+PRIORITY="A"+Coffee="unlimited"+Effort<2 \
6848 +With=@{Sarah\|Denny@}+SCHEDULED>="<2008-10-11>"
6852 The type of comparison will depend on how the comparison value is written:
6855 If the comparison value is a plain number, a numerical comparison is done,
6856 and the allowed operators are @samp{<}, @samp{=}, @samp{>}, @samp{<=},
6857 @samp{>=}, and @samp{<>}.
6859 If the comparison value is enclosed in double-quotes,
6860 a string comparison is done, and the same operators are allowed.
6862 If the comparison value is enclosed in double-quotes @emph{and} angular
6863 brackets (like @samp{DEADLINE<="<2008-12-24 18:30>"}), both values are
6864 assumed to be date/time specifications in the standard Org way, and the
6865 comparison will be done accordingly. Special values that will be recognized
6866 are @code{"<now>"} for now (including time), and @code{"<today>"}, and
6867 @code{"<tomorrow>"} for these days at 0:00 hours, i.e. without a time
6868 specification. Also strings like @code{"<+5d>"} or @code{"<-2m>"} with units
6869 @code{d}, @code{w}, @code{m}, and @code{y} for day, week, month, and year,
6870 respectively, can be used.
6872 If the comparison value is enclosed
6873 in curly braces, a regexp match is performed, with @samp{=} meaning that the
6874 regexp matches the property value, and @samp{<>} meaning that it does not
6878 So the search string in the example finds entries tagged @samp{:work:} but
6879 not @samp{:boss:}, which also have a priority value @samp{A}, a
6880 @samp{:Coffee:} property with the value @samp{unlimited}, an @samp{Effort}
6881 property that is numerically smaller than 2, a @samp{:With:} property that is
6882 matched by the regular expression @samp{Sarah\|Denny}, and that are scheduled
6883 on or after October 11, 2008.
6885 Accessing TODO, LEVEL, and CATEGORY during a search is fast. Accessing any
6886 other properties will slow down the search. However, once you have paid the
6887 price by accessing one property, testing additional properties is cheap
6890 You can configure Org mode to use property inheritance during a search, but
6891 beware that this can slow down searches considerably. See @ref{Property
6892 inheritance}, for details.
6894 For backward compatibility, and also for typing speed, there is also a
6895 different way to test TODO states in a search. For this, terminate the
6896 tags/property part of the search string (which may include several terms
6897 connected with @samp{|}) with a @samp{/} and then specify a Boolean
6898 expression just for TODO keywords. The syntax is then similar to that for
6899 tags, but should be applied with care: for example, a positive
6900 selection on several TODO keywords cannot meaningfully be combined with
6901 boolean AND. However, @emph{negative selection} combined with AND can be
6902 meaningful. To make sure that only lines are checked that actually have any
6903 TODO keyword (resulting in a speed-up), use @kbd{C-c a M}, or equivalently
6904 start the TODO part after the slash with @samp{!}. Examples:
6908 Same as @samp{work+TODO="WAITING"}
6909 @item work/!-WAITING-NEXT
6910 Select @samp{:work:}-tagged TODO lines that are neither @samp{WAITING}
6912 @item work/!+WAITING|+NEXT
6913 Select @samp{:work:}-tagged TODO lines that are either @samp{WAITING} or
6917 @node Timeline, Search view, Matching tags and properties, Built-in agenda views
6918 @subsection Timeline for a single file
6919 @cindex timeline, single file
6920 @cindex time-sorted view
6922 The timeline summarizes all time-stamped items from a single Org mode
6923 file in a @emph{time-sorted view}. The main purpose of this command is
6924 to give an overview over events in a project.
6929 Show a time-sorted view of the Org file, with all time-stamped items.
6930 When called with a @kbd{C-u} prefix, all unfinished TODO entries
6931 (scheduled or not) are also listed under the current date.
6935 The commands available in the timeline buffer are listed in
6936 @ref{Agenda commands}.
6938 @node Search view, Stuck projects, Timeline, Built-in agenda views
6939 @subsection Search view
6942 @cindex searching, for text
6944 This agenda view is a general text search facility for Org mode entries.
6945 It is particularly useful to find notes.
6950 This is a special search that lets you select entries by matching a substring
6951 or specific words using a boolean logic.
6953 For example, the search string @samp{computer equipment} will find entries
6954 that contain @samp{computer equipment} as a substring. If the two words are
6955 separated by more space or a line break, the search will still match.
6956 Search view can also search for specific keywords in the entry, using Boolean
6957 logic. The search string @samp{+computer +wifi -ethernet -@{8\.11[bg]@}}
6958 will search for note entries that contain the keywords @code{computer}
6959 and @code{wifi}, but not the keyword @code{ethernet}, and which are also
6960 not matched by the regular expression @code{8\.11[bg]}, meaning to
6961 exclude both 8.11b and 8.11g. The first @samp{+} is necessary to turn on
6962 word search, other @samp{+} characters are optional. For more details, see
6963 the docstring of the command @code{org-search-view}.
6965 @vindex org-agenda-text-search-extra-files
6966 Note that in addition to the agenda files, this command will also search
6967 the files listed in @code{org-agenda-text-search-extra-files}.
6969 @node Stuck projects, , Search view, Built-in agenda views
6970 @subsection Stuck projects
6972 If you are following a system like David Allen's GTD to organize your
6973 work, one of the ``duties'' you have is a regular review to make sure
6974 that all projects move along. A @emph{stuck} project is a project that
6975 has no defined next actions, so it will never show up in the TODO lists
6976 Org mode produces. During the review, you need to identify such
6977 projects and define next actions for them.
6982 List projects that are stuck.
6985 @vindex org-stuck-projects
6986 Customize the variable @code{org-stuck-projects} to define what a stuck
6987 project is and how to find it.
6990 You almost certainly will have to configure this view before it will
6991 work for you. The built-in default assumes that all your projects are
6992 level-2 headlines, and that a project is not stuck if it has at least
6993 one entry marked with a TODO keyword TODO or NEXT or NEXTACTION.
6995 Let's assume that you, in your own way of using Org mode, identify
6996 projects with a tag PROJECT, and that you use a TODO keyword MAYBE to
6997 indicate a project that should not be considered yet. Let's further
6998 assume that the TODO keyword DONE marks finished projects, and that NEXT
6999 and TODO indicate next actions. The tag @@SHOP indicates shopping and
7000 is a next action even without the NEXT tag. Finally, if the project
7001 contains the special word IGNORE anywhere, it should not be listed
7002 either. In this case you would start by identifying eligible projects
7003 with a tags/todo match@footnote{@xref{Tag searches}.}
7004 @samp{+PROJECT/-MAYBE-DONE}, and then check for TODO, NEXT, @@SHOP, and
7005 IGNORE in the subtree to identify projects that are not stuck. The
7006 correct customization for this is
7009 (setq org-stuck-projects
7010 '("+PROJECT/-MAYBE-DONE" ("NEXT" "TODO") ("@@SHOP")
7014 Note that if a project is identified as non-stuck, the subtree of this entry
7015 will still be searched for stuck projects.
7017 @node Presentation and sorting, Agenda commands, Built-in agenda views, Agenda Views
7018 @section Presentation and sorting
7019 @cindex presentation, of agenda items
7021 @vindex org-agenda-prefix-format
7022 Before displaying items in an agenda view, Org mode visually prepares
7023 the items and sorts them. Each item occupies a single line. The line
7024 starts with a @emph{prefix} that contains the @emph{category}
7025 (@pxref{Categories}) of the item and other important information. You can
7026 customize the prefix using the option @code{org-agenda-prefix-format}.
7027 The prefix is followed by a cleaned-up version of the outline headline
7028 associated with the item.
7031 * Categories:: Not all tasks are equal
7032 * Time-of-day specifications:: How the agenda knows the time
7033 * Sorting of agenda items:: The order of things
7036 @node Categories, Time-of-day specifications, Presentation and sorting, Presentation and sorting
7037 @subsection Categories
7040 The category is a broad label assigned to each agenda item. By default,
7041 the category is simply derived from the file name, but you can also
7042 specify it with a special line in the buffer, like this@footnote{For
7043 backward compatibility, the following also works: if there are several
7044 such lines in a file, each specifies the category for the text below it.
7045 The first category also applies to any text before the first CATEGORY
7046 line. However, using this method is @emph{strongly} deprecated as it is
7047 incompatible with the outline structure of the document. The correct
7048 method for setting multiple categories in a buffer is using a
7056 @cindex property, CATEGORY
7057 If you would like to have a special CATEGORY for a single entry or a
7058 (sub)tree, give the entry a @code{:CATEGORY:} property with the
7059 special category you want to apply as the value.
7062 The display in the agenda buffer looks best if the category is not
7063 longer than 10 characters.
7065 @node Time-of-day specifications, Sorting of agenda items, Categories, Presentation and sorting
7066 @subsection Time-of-day specifications
7067 @cindex time-of-day specification
7069 Org mode checks each agenda item for a time-of-day specification. The
7070 time can be part of the timestamp that triggered inclusion into the
7071 agenda, for example as in @w{@samp{<2005-05-10 Tue 19:00>}}. Time
7072 ranges can be specified with two timestamps, like
7074 @w{@samp{<2005-05-10 Tue 20:30>--<2005-05-10 Tue 22:15>}}.
7076 In the headline of the entry itself, a time(range) may also appear as
7077 plain text (like @samp{12:45} or a @samp{8:30-1pm}). If the agenda
7078 integrates the Emacs diary (@pxref{Weekly/daily agenda}), time
7079 specifications in diary entries are recognized as well.
7081 For agenda display, Org mode extracts the time and displays it in a
7082 standard 24 hour format as part of the prefix. The example times in
7083 the previous paragraphs would end up in the agenda like this:
7086 8:30-13:00 Arthur Dent lies in front of the bulldozer
7087 12:45...... Ford Prefect arrives and takes Arthur to the pub
7088 19:00...... The Vogon reads his poem
7089 20:30-22:15 Marvin escorts the Hitchhikers to the bridge
7093 If the agenda is in single-day mode, or for the display of today, the
7094 timed entries are embedded in a time grid, like
7097 8:00...... ------------------
7098 8:30-13:00 Arthur Dent lies in front of the bulldozer
7099 10:00...... ------------------
7100 12:00...... ------------------
7101 12:45...... Ford Prefect arrives and takes Arthur to the pub
7102 14:00...... ------------------
7103 16:00...... ------------------
7104 18:00...... ------------------
7105 19:00...... The Vogon reads his poem
7106 20:00...... ------------------
7107 20:30-22:15 Marvin escorts the Hitchhikers to the bridge
7110 @vindex org-agenda-use-time-grid
7111 @vindex org-agenda-time-grid
7112 The time grid can be turned on and off with the variable
7113 @code{org-agenda-use-time-grid}, and can be configured with
7114 @code{org-agenda-time-grid}.
7116 @node Sorting of agenda items, , Time-of-day specifications, Presentation and sorting
7117 @subsection Sorting of agenda items
7118 @cindex sorting, of agenda items
7119 @cindex priorities, of agenda items
7120 Before being inserted into a view, the items are sorted. How this is
7121 done depends on the type of view.
7124 @vindex org-agenda-files
7125 For the daily/weekly agenda, the items for each day are sorted. The
7126 default order is to first collect all items containing an explicit
7127 time-of-day specification. These entries will be shown at the beginning
7128 of the list, as a @emph{schedule} for the day. After that, items remain
7129 grouped in categories, in the sequence given by @code{org-agenda-files}.
7130 Within each category, items are sorted by priority (@pxref{Priorities}),
7131 which is composed of the base priority (2000 for priority @samp{A}, 1000
7132 for @samp{B}, and 0 for @samp{C}), plus additional increments for
7133 overdue scheduled or deadline items.
7135 For the TODO list, items remain in the order of categories, but within
7136 each category, sorting takes place according to priority
7137 (@pxref{Priorities}). The priority used for sorting derives from the
7138 priority cookie, with additions depending on how close an item is to its due
7141 For tags matches, items are not sorted at all, but just appear in the
7142 sequence in which they are found in the agenda files.
7145 @vindex org-agenda-sorting-strategy
7146 Sorting can be customized using the variable
7147 @code{org-agenda-sorting-strategy}, and may also include criteria based on
7148 the estimated effort of an entry (@pxref{Effort estimates}).
7150 @node Agenda commands, Custom agenda views, Presentation and sorting, Agenda Views
7151 @section Commands in the agenda buffer
7152 @cindex commands, in agenda buffer
7154 Entries in the agenda buffer are linked back to the Org file or diary
7155 file where they originate. You are not allowed to edit the agenda
7156 buffer itself, but commands are provided to show and jump to the
7157 original entry location, and to edit the Org files ``remotely'' from
7158 the agenda buffer. In this way, all information is stored only once,
7159 removing the risk that your agenda and note files may diverge.
7161 Some commands can be executed with mouse clicks on agenda lines. For
7162 the other commands, the cursor needs to be in the desired line.
7165 @tsubheading{Motion}
7166 @cindex motion commands in agenda
7169 Next line (same as @key{up} and @kbd{C-p}).
7172 Previous line (same as @key{down} and @kbd{C-n}).
7173 @tsubheading{View/Go to Org file}
7178 Display the original location of the item in another window.
7179 With prefix arg, make sure that the entire entry is made visible in the
7180 outline, not only the heading.
7184 Display original location and recenter that window.
7192 Go to the original location of the item in another window. Under Emacs
7193 22, @kbd{mouse-1} will also works for this.
7197 Go to the original location of the item and delete other windows.
7201 @vindex org-agenda-start-with-follow-mode
7202 Toggle Follow mode. In Follow mode, as you move the cursor through
7203 the agenda buffer, the other window always shows the corresponding
7204 location in the Org file. The initial setting for this mode in new
7205 agenda buffers can be set with the variable
7206 @code{org-agenda-start-with-follow-mode}.
7210 Display the entire subtree of the current item in an indirect buffer. With a
7211 numeric prefix argument N, go up to level N and then take that tree. If N is
7212 negative, go up that many levels. With a @kbd{C-u} prefix, do not remove the
7213 previously used indirect buffer.
7217 Follow a link in the entry. This will offer a selection of any links in the
7218 text belonging to the referenced Org node. If there is only one link, it
7219 will be followed without a selection prompt.
7221 @tsubheading{Change display}
7222 @cindex display changing, in agenda
7225 Delete other windows.
7233 @item v d @ @r{or short} @ d
7234 @itemx v w @ @r{or short} @ w
7237 Switch to day/week/month/year view. When switching to day or week view,
7238 this setting becomes the default for subsequent agenda commands. Since
7239 month and year views are slow to create, they do not become the default.
7240 A numeric prefix argument may be used to jump directly to a specific day
7241 of the year, ISO week, month, or year, respectively. For example,
7242 @kbd{32 d} jumps to February 1st, @kbd{9 w} to ISO week number 9. When
7243 setting day, week, or month view, a year may be encoded in the prefix
7244 argument as well. For example, @kbd{200712 w} will jump to week 12 in
7245 2007. If such a year specification has only one or two digits, it will
7246 be mapped to the interval 1938-2037.
7250 @vindex org-agenda-ndays
7251 Go forward in time to display the following @code{org-agenda-ndays} days.
7252 For example, if the display covers a week, switch to the following week.
7253 With prefix arg, go forward that many times @code{org-agenda-ndays} days.
7257 Go backward in time to display earlier dates.
7265 Prompt for a date and go there.
7269 Toggle the inclusion of diary entries. See @ref{Weekly/daily agenda}.
7274 @item v l @ @r{or short} @ l
7275 @vindex org-log-done
7276 @vindex org-agenda-log-mode-items
7277 Toggle Logbook mode. In Logbook mode, entries that were marked DONE while
7278 logging was on (variable @code{org-log-done}) are shown in the agenda, as are
7279 entries that have been clocked on that day. You can configure the entry
7280 types that should be included in log mode using the variable
7281 @code{org-agenda-log-mode-items}. When called with a @kbd{C-u} prefix, show
7282 all possible logbook entries, including state changes. When called with two
7283 prefix args @kbd{C-u C-u}, show only logging information, nothing else.
7284 @kbd{v L} is equivalent to @kbd{C-u v l}.
7288 @item v [ @ @r{or short} @ [
7289 Include inactive timestamps into the current view. Only for weekly/daily
7290 agenda and timeline views.
7296 Toggle Archives mode. In Archives mode, trees that are marked
7297 @code{ARCHIVED} are also scanned when producing the agenda. When you use the
7298 capital @kbd{A}, even all archive files are included. To exit archives mode,
7299 press @kbd{v a} again.
7303 @item v R @ @r{or short} @ R
7304 @vindex org-agenda-start-with-clockreport-mode
7305 Toggle Clockreport mode. In Clockreport mode, the daily/weekly agenda will
7306 always show a table with the clocked times for the timespan and file scope
7307 covered by the current agenda view. The initial setting for this mode in new
7308 agenda buffers can be set with the variable
7309 @code{org-agenda-start-with-clockreport-mode}.
7313 @item v E @ @r{or short} @ E
7314 @vindex org-agenda-start-with-entry-text-mode
7315 @vindex org-agenda-entry-text-maxlines
7316 Toggle entry text mode. In entry text mode, a number of lines from the Org
7317 outline node referenced by an agenda line will be displayed below the line.
7318 The maximum number of lines is given by the variable
7319 @code{org-agenda-entry-text-maxlines}. Calling this command with a numeric
7320 prefix argument will temporarily modify that number to the prefix value.
7324 @vindex org-agenda-use-time-grid
7325 @vindex org-agenda-time-grid
7326 Toggle the time grid on and off. See also the variables
7327 @code{org-agenda-use-time-grid} and @code{org-agenda-time-grid}.
7331 Recreate the agenda buffer, for example to reflect the changes after
7332 modification of the timestamps of items with @kbd{S-@key{left}} and
7333 @kbd{S-@key{right}}. When the buffer is the global TODO list, a prefix
7334 argument is interpreted to create a selective list for a specific TODO
7344 Save all Org buffers in the current Emacs session, and also the locations of
7349 @vindex org-columns-default-format
7350 Invoke column view (@pxref{Column view}) in the agenda buffer. The column
7351 view format is taken from the entry at point, or (if there is no entry at
7352 point), from the first entry in the agenda view. So whatever the format for
7353 that entry would be in the original buffer (taken from a property, from a
7354 @code{#+COLUMNS} line, or from the default variable
7355 @code{org-columns-default-format}), will be used in the agenda.
7359 Remove the restriction lock on the agenda, if it is currently restricted to a
7360 file or subtree (@pxref{Agenda files}).
7362 @tsubheading{Secondary filtering and query editing}
7363 @cindex filtering, by tag and effort, in agenda
7364 @cindex tag filtering, in agenda
7365 @cindex effort filtering, in agenda
7366 @cindex query editing, in agenda
7370 @vindex org-agenda-filter-preset
7371 Filter the current agenda view with respect to a tag and/or effort estimates.
7372 The difference between this and a custom agenda command is that filtering is
7373 very fast, so that you can switch quickly between different filters without
7374 having to recreate the agenda@footnote{Custom commands can preset a filter by
7375 binding the variable @code{org-agenda-filter-preset} as an option. This
7376 filter will then be applied to the view and persist as a basic filter through
7377 refreshes and more secondary filtering.}
7379 You will be prompted for a tag selection letter, SPC will mean any tag at
7380 all. Pressing @key{TAB} at that prompt will offer use completion to select a
7381 tag (including any tags that do not have a selection character). The command
7382 then hides all entries that do not contain or inherit this tag. When called
7383 with prefix arg, remove the entries that @emph{do} have the tag. A second
7384 @kbd{/} at the prompt will turn off the filter and unhide any hidden entries.
7385 If the first key you press is either @kbd{+} or @kbd{-}, the previous filter
7386 will be narrowed by requiring or forbidding the selected additional tag.
7387 Instead of pressing @kbd{+} or @kbd{-} after @kbd{/}, you can also
7388 immediately use the @kbd{\} command.
7390 @vindex org-sort-agenda-noeffort-is-high
7391 In order to filter for effort estimates, you should set-up allowed
7392 efforts globally, for example
7394 (setq org-global-properties
7395 '(("Effort_ALL". "0 0:10 0:30 1:00 2:00 3:00 4:00")))
7397 You can then filter for an effort by first typing an operator, one of
7398 @kbd{<}, @kbd{>}, and @kbd{=}, and then the one-digit index of an effort
7399 estimate in your array of allowed values, where @kbd{0} means the 10th value.
7400 The filter will then restrict to entries with effort smaller-or-equal, equal,
7401 or larger-or-equal than the selected value. If the digits 0-9 are not used
7402 as fast access keys to tags, you can also simply press the index digit
7403 directly without an operator. In this case, @kbd{<} will be assumed. For
7404 application of the operator, entries without a defined effort will be treated
7405 according to the value of @code{org-sort-agenda-noeffort-is-high}. To filter
7406 for tasks without effort definition, press @kbd{?} as the operator.
7408 Org also supports automatic, context-aware tag filtering. If the variable
7409 @code{org-agenda-auto-exclude-function} is set to a user-defined function,
7410 that function can decide which tags should be excluded from the agenda
7411 automatically. Once this is set, the @kbd{/} command then accepts @kbd{RET}
7412 as a sub-option key and runs the auto exclusion logic. For example, let's
7413 say you use a @code{Net} tag to identify tasks which need network access, an
7414 @code{Errand} tag for errands in town, and a @code{Call} tag for making phone
7415 calls. You could auto-exclude these tags based on the availability of the
7416 Internet, and outside of business hours, with something like this:
7420 (defun org-my-auto-exclude-function (tag)
7422 ((string= tag "Net")
7423 (/= 0 (call-process "/sbin/ping" nil nil nil
7424 "-c1" "-q" "-t1" "mail.gnu.org")))
7425 ((or (string= tag "Errand") (string= tag "Call"))
7426 (let ((hour (nth 2 (decode-time))))
7427 (or (< hour 8) (> hour 21)))))
7430 (setq org-agenda-auto-exclude-function 'org-my-auto-exclude-function)
7436 Narrow the current agenda filter by an additional condition. When called with
7437 prefix arg, remove the entries that @emph{do} have the tag, or that do match
7438 the effort criterion. You can achieve the same effect by pressing @kbd{+} or
7439 @kbd{-} as the first key after the @kbd{/} command.
7447 @item @r{in} search view
7448 add new search words (@kbd{[} and @kbd{]}) or new regular expressions
7449 (@kbd{@{} and @kbd{@}}) to the query string. The opening bracket/brace will
7450 add a positive search term prefixed by @samp{+}, indicating that this search
7451 term @i{must} occur/match in the entry. The closing bracket/brace will add a
7452 negative search term which @i{must not} occur/match in the entry for it to be
7457 @tsubheading{Remote editing}
7458 @cindex remote editing, from agenda
7463 @cindex undoing remote-editing events
7464 @cindex remote editing, undo
7467 Undo a change due to a remote editing command. The change is undone
7468 both in the agenda buffer and in the remote buffer.
7472 Change the TODO state of the item, both in the agenda and in the
7475 @kindex C-S-@key{right}
7476 @kindex C-S-@key{left}
7477 @item C-S-@key{right}@r{/}@key{left}
7478 Switch to the next/previous set of TODO keywords.
7482 @vindex org-agenda-confirm-kill
7483 Delete the current agenda item along with the entire subtree belonging
7484 to it in the original Org file. If the text to be deleted remotely
7485 is longer than one line, the kill needs to be confirmed by the user. See
7486 variable @code{org-agenda-confirm-kill}.
7490 Refile the entry at point.
7494 @item C-c C-x C-a @ @r{or short} @ a
7495 @vindex org-archive-default-command
7496 Archive the subtree corresponding to the entry at point using the default
7497 archiving command set in @code{org-archive-default-command}. When using the
7498 @code{a} key, confirmation will be required.
7502 Toggle the ARCHIVE tag for the current headline.
7506 Move the subtree corresponding to the current entry to its @emph{archive
7511 @item C-c C-x C-s @ @r{or short} @ $
7512 Archive the subtree corresponding to the current headline. This means the
7513 entry will be moved to the configured archive location, most likely a
7518 @vindex org-agenda-show-inherited-tags
7519 Show all tags associated with the current item. This is useful if you have
7520 turned off @code{org-agenda-show-inherited-tags}, but still want to see all
7521 tags of a headline occasionally.
7525 Set tags for the current headline. If there is an active region in the
7526 agenda, change a tag for all headings in the region.
7530 Set the priority for the current item. Org mode prompts for the
7531 priority character. If you reply with @key{SPC}, the priority cookie
7532 is removed from the entry.
7536 Display weighted priority of current item.
7542 Increase the priority of the current item. The priority is changed in
7543 the original buffer, but the agenda is not resorted. Use the @kbd{r}
7547 @kindex S-@key{down}
7550 Decrease the priority of the current item.
7554 @vindex org-log-into-drawer
7555 Add a note to the entry. This note will be recorded, and then files to the
7556 same location where state change notes are put. Depending on
7557 @code{org-log-into-drawer}, this maybe inside a drawer.
7561 Dispatcher for all command related to attachments.
7565 Schedule this item, with prefix arg remove the scheduling timestamp
7569 Set a deadline for this item, with prefix arg remove the deadline.
7573 Agenda actions, to set dates for selected items to the cursor date.
7574 This command also works in the calendar! The command prompts for an
7577 m @r{Mark the entry at point for action. You can also make entries}
7578 @r{in Org files with @kbd{C-c C-x C-k}.}
7579 d @r{Set the deadline of the marked entry to the date at point.}
7580 s @r{Schedule the marked entry at the date at point.}
7581 r @r{Call @code{org-remember} with the cursor date as default date.}
7584 Press @kbd{r} afterward to refresh the agenda and see the effect of the
7587 @kindex S-@key{right}
7589 Change the timestamp associated with the current line by one day into the
7590 future. With a numeric prefix argument, change it by that many days. For
7591 example, @kbd{3 6 5 S-@key{right}} will change it by a year. With a
7592 @kbd{C-u} prefix, change the time by one hour. If you immediately repeat the
7593 command, it will continue to change hours even without the prefix arg. With
7594 a double @kbd{C-u C-u} prefix, do the same for changing minutes. The stamp
7595 is changed in the original Org file, but the change is not directly reflected
7596 in the agenda buffer. Use @kbd{r} or @kbd{g} to update the buffer.
7598 @kindex S-@key{left}
7600 Change the timestamp associated with the current line by one day
7605 Change the timestamp associated with the current line. The key @kbd{>} has
7606 been chosen, because it is the same as @kbd{S-.} on my keyboard.
7610 Start the clock on the current item. If a clock is running already, it
7615 Stop the previously started clock.
7619 Cancel the currently running clock.
7623 Jump to the running clock in another window.
7625 @tsubheading{Bulk remote editing selected entries}
7626 @cindex remote editing, bulk, from agenda
7630 Mark the entry at point for bulk action.
7634 Unmark entry for bulk action.
7638 Unmark all marked entries for bulk action.
7642 Bulk action: act on all marked entries in the agenda. This will prompt for
7643 another key to select the action to be applied. The prefix arg to @kbd{B}
7644 will be passed through to the @kbd{s} and @kbd{d} commands, to bulk-remove
7645 these special timestamps.
7647 r @r{Prompt for a single refile target and move all entries. The entries}
7648 @r{will no longer be in the agenda, refresh (@kbd{g}) to bring them back.}
7649 $ @r{Archive all selected entries.}
7650 A @r{Archive entries by moving them to their respective archive siblings.}
7651 t @r{Change TODO state. This prompts for a single TODO keyword and}
7652 @r{changes the state of all selected entries, bypassing blocking and}
7653 @r{suppressing logging notes (but not time stamps).}
7654 + @r{Add a tag to all selected entries.}
7655 - @r{Remove a tag from all selected entries.}
7656 s @r{Schedule all items to a new date. To shift existing schedule dates}
7657 @r{by a fixed number of days, use something starting with double plus}
7658 @r{at the prompt, for example @samp{++8d} or @samp{++2w}.}
7659 d @r{Set deadline to a specific date.}
7663 @tsubheading{Calendar commands}
7664 @cindex calendar commands, from agenda
7667 Open the Emacs calendar and move to the date at the agenda cursor.
7670 When in the calendar, compute and show the Org mode agenda for the
7673 @cindex diary entries, creating from agenda
7676 @vindex org-agenda-diary-file
7677 Insert a new entry into the diary, using the date at the cursor and (for
7678 block entries) the date at the mark. This will add to the Emacs diary
7679 file@footnote{This file is parsed for the agenda when
7680 @code{org-agenda-include-diary} is set.}, in a way similar to the @kbd{i}
7681 command in the calendar. The diary file will pop up in another window, where
7682 you can add the entry.
7684 If you configure @code{org-agenda-diary-file} to point to an Org-mode file,
7685 Org will create entries (in org-mode syntax) in that file instead. Most
7686 entries will be stored in a date-based outline tree that will later make it
7687 easy to archive appointments from previous months/years. The tree will be
7688 build under an entry with a @code{DATE_TREE} property, or else with years as
7689 top-level entries. Emacs will prompt you for the entry text - if you specify
7690 it, the entry will be created in @code{org-agenda-diary-file} without further
7691 interaction. If you directly press @key{RET} at the prompt without typing
7692 text, the target file will be shown in another window for you to finish the
7693 entry there. See also the @kbd{k r} command.
7697 Show the phases of the moon for the three months around current date.
7701 Show sunrise and sunset times. The geographical location must be set
7702 with calendar variables, see the documentation for the Emacs calendar.
7706 Convert the date at cursor into many other cultural and historic
7711 Show holidays for three months around the cursor date.
7713 @item M-x org-export-icalendar-combine-agenda-files
7714 Export a single iCalendar file containing entries from all agenda files.
7715 This is a globally available command, and also available in the agenda menu.
7717 @tsubheading{Exporting to a file}
7720 @cindex exporting agenda views
7721 @cindex agenda views, exporting
7722 @vindex org-agenda-exporter-settings
7723 Write the agenda view to a file. Depending on the extension of the selected
7724 file name, the view will be exported as HTML (extension @file{.html} or
7725 @file{.htm}), Postscript (extension @file{.ps}), PDF (extension @file{.pdf}),
7726 and plain text (any other extension). When called with a @kbd{C-u} prefix
7727 argument, immediately open the newly created file. Use the variable
7728 @code{org-agenda-exporter-settings} to set options for @file{ps-print} and
7729 for @file{htmlize} to be used during export.
7731 @tsubheading{Quit and Exit}
7734 Quit agenda, remove the agenda buffer.
7737 @cindex agenda files, removing buffers
7739 Exit agenda, remove the agenda buffer and all buffers loaded by Emacs
7740 for the compilation of the agenda. Buffers created by the user to
7741 visit Org files will not be removed.
7745 @node Custom agenda views, Exporting Agenda Views, Agenda commands, Agenda Views
7746 @section Custom agenda views
7747 @cindex custom agenda views
7748 @cindex agenda views, custom
7750 Custom agenda commands serve two purposes: to store and quickly access
7751 frequently used TODO and tags searches, and to create special composite
7752 agenda buffers. Custom agenda commands will be accessible through the
7753 dispatcher (@pxref{Agenda dispatcher}), just like the default commands.
7756 * Storing searches:: Type once, use often
7757 * Block agenda:: All the stuff you need in a single buffer
7758 * Setting Options:: Changing the rules
7761 @node Storing searches, Block agenda, Custom agenda views, Custom agenda views
7762 @subsection Storing searches
7764 The first application of custom searches is the definition of keyboard
7765 shortcuts for frequently used searches, either creating an agenda
7766 buffer, or a sparse tree (the latter covering of course only the current
7769 @vindex org-agenda-custom-commands
7770 Custom commands are configured in the variable
7771 @code{org-agenda-custom-commands}. You can customize this variable, for
7772 example by pressing @kbd{C-c a C}. You can also directly set it with
7773 Emacs Lisp in @file{.emacs}. The following example contains all valid
7778 (setq org-agenda-custom-commands
7779 '(("w" todo "WAITING")
7780 ("W" todo-tree "WAITING")
7781 ("u" tags "+boss-urgent")
7782 ("v" tags-todo "+boss-urgent")
7783 ("U" tags-tree "+boss-urgent")
7784 ("f" occur-tree "\\<FIXME\\>")
7785 ("h" . "HOME+Name tags searches") ; description for "h" prefix
7786 ("hl" tags "+home+Lisa")
7787 ("hp" tags "+home+Peter")
7788 ("hk" tags "+home+Kim")))
7793 The initial string in each entry defines the keys you have to press
7794 after the dispatcher command @kbd{C-c a} in order to access the command.
7795 Usually this will be just a single character, but if you have many
7796 similar commands, you can also define two-letter combinations where the
7797 first character is the same in several combinations and serves as a
7798 prefix key@footnote{You can provide a description for a prefix key by
7799 inserting a cons cell with the prefix and the description.}. The second
7800 parameter is the search type, followed by the string or regular
7801 expression to be used for the matching. The example above will
7806 as a global search for TODO entries with @samp{WAITING} as the TODO
7809 as the same search, but only in the current buffer and displaying the
7810 results as a sparse tree
7812 as a global tags search for headlines marked @samp{:boss:} but not
7815 as the same search as @kbd{C-c a u}, but limiting the search to
7816 headlines that are also TODO items
7818 as the same search as @kbd{C-c a u}, but only in the current buffer and
7819 displaying the result as a sparse tree
7821 to create a sparse tree (again: current buffer only) with all entries
7822 containing the word @samp{FIXME}
7824 as a prefix command for a HOME tags search where you have to press an
7825 additional key (@kbd{l}, @kbd{p} or @kbd{k}) to select a name (Lisa,
7826 Peter, or Kim) as additional tag to match.
7829 @node Block agenda, Setting Options, Storing searches, Custom agenda views
7830 @subsection Block agenda
7831 @cindex block agenda
7832 @cindex agenda, with block views
7834 Another possibility is the construction of agenda views that comprise
7835 the results of @emph{several} commands, each of which creates a block in
7836 the agenda buffer. The available commands include @code{agenda} for the
7837 daily or weekly agenda (as created with @kbd{C-c a a}), @code{alltodo}
7838 for the global TODO list (as constructed with @kbd{C-c a t}), and the
7839 matching commands discussed above: @code{todo}, @code{tags}, and
7840 @code{tags-todo}. Here are two examples:
7844 (setq org-agenda-custom-commands
7845 '(("h" "Agenda and Home-related tasks"
7849 ("o" "Agenda and Office-related tasks"
7857 This will define @kbd{C-c a h} to create a multi-block view for stuff
7858 you need to attend to at home. The resulting agenda buffer will contain
7859 your agenda for the current week, all TODO items that carry the tag
7860 @samp{home}, and also all lines tagged with @samp{garden}. Finally the
7861 command @kbd{C-c a o} provides a similar view for office tasks.
7863 @node Setting Options, , Block agenda, Custom agenda views
7864 @subsection Setting options for custom commands
7865 @cindex options, for custom agenda views
7867 @vindex org-agenda-custom-commands
7868 Org mode contains a number of variables regulating agenda construction
7869 and display. The global variables define the behavior for all agenda
7870 commands, including the custom commands. However, if you want to change
7871 some settings just for a single custom view, you can do so. Setting
7872 options requires inserting a list of variable names and values at the
7873 right spot in @code{org-agenda-custom-commands}. For example:
7877 (setq org-agenda-custom-commands
7878 '(("w" todo "WAITING"
7879 ((org-agenda-sorting-strategy '(priority-down))
7880 (org-agenda-prefix-format " Mixed: ")))
7881 ("U" tags-tree "+boss-urgent"
7882 ((org-show-following-heading nil)
7883 (org-show-hierarchy-above nil)))
7885 ((org-agenda-files '("~org/notes.org"))
7886 (org-agenda-text-search-extra-files nil)))))
7891 Now the @kbd{C-c a w} command will sort the collected entries only by
7892 priority, and the prefix format is modified to just say @samp{ Mixed: }
7893 instead of giving the category of the entry. The sparse tags tree of
7894 @kbd{C-c a U} will now turn out ultra-compact, because neither the
7895 headline hierarchy above the match, nor the headline following the match
7896 will be shown. The command @kbd{C-c a N} will do a text search limited
7897 to only a single file.
7899 @vindex org-agenda-custom-commands
7900 For command sets creating a block agenda,
7901 @code{org-agenda-custom-commands} has two separate spots for setting
7902 options. You can add options that should be valid for just a single
7903 command in the set, and options that should be valid for all commands in
7904 the set. The former are just added to the command entry, the latter
7905 must come after the list of command entries. Going back to the block
7906 agenda example (@pxref{Block agenda}), let's change the sorting strategy
7907 for the @kbd{C-c a h} commands to @code{priority-down}, but let's sort
7908 the results for GARDEN tags query in the opposite order,
7909 @code{priority-up}. This would look like this:
7913 (setq org-agenda-custom-commands
7914 '(("h" "Agenda and Home-related tasks"
7918 ((org-agenda-sorting-strategy '(priority-up)))))
7919 ((org-agenda-sorting-strategy '(priority-down))))
7920 ("o" "Agenda and Office-related tasks"
7927 As you see, the values and parentheses setting is a little complex.
7928 When in doubt, use the customize interface to set this variable---it
7929 fully supports its structure. Just one caveat: when setting options in
7930 this interface, the @emph{values} are just Lisp expressions. So if the
7931 value is a string, you need to add the double-quotes around the value
7935 @node Exporting Agenda Views, Agenda column view, Custom agenda views, Agenda Views
7936 @section Exporting Agenda Views
7937 @cindex agenda views, exporting
7939 If you are away from your computer, it can be very useful to have a printed
7940 version of some agenda views to carry around. Org mode can export custom
7941 agenda views as plain text, HTML@footnote{You need to install Hrvoje Niksic's
7942 @file{htmlize.el}.}, Postscript, PDF@footnote{To create PDF output, the
7943 ghostscript @file{ps2pdf} utility must be installed on the system. Selecting
7944 a PDF file with also create the postscript file.}, and iCalendar files. If
7945 you want to do this only occasionally, use the command
7950 @cindex exporting agenda views
7951 @cindex agenda views, exporting
7952 @vindex org-agenda-exporter-settings
7953 Write the agenda view to a file. Depending on the extension of the selected
7954 file name, the view will be exported as HTML (extension @file{.html} or
7955 @file{.htm}), Postscript (extension @file{.ps}), iCalendar (extension
7956 @file{.ics}), or plain text (any other extension). Use the variable
7957 @code{org-agenda-exporter-settings} to set options for @file{ps-print} and
7958 for @file{htmlize} to be used during export, for example
7960 @vindex org-agenda-add-entry-text-maxlines
7961 @vindex htmlize-output-type
7962 @vindex ps-number-of-columns
7963 @vindex ps-landscape-mode
7965 (setq org-agenda-exporter-settings
7966 '((ps-number-of-columns 2)
7967 (ps-landscape-mode t)
7968 (org-agenda-add-entry-text-maxlines 5)
7969 (htmlize-output-type 'css)))
7973 If you need to export certain agenda views frequently, you can associate
7974 any custom agenda command with a list of output file names
7975 @footnote{If you want to store standard views like the weekly agenda
7976 or the global TODO list as well, you need to define custom commands for
7977 them in order to be able to specify file names.}. Here is an example
7978 that first defines custom commands for the agenda and the global
7979 TODO list, together with a number of files to which to export them.
7980 Then we define two block agenda commands and specify file names for them
7981 as well. File names can be relative to the current working directory,
7986 (setq org-agenda-custom-commands
7987 '(("X" agenda "" nil ("agenda.html" "agenda.ps"))
7988 ("Y" alltodo "" nil ("todo.html" "todo.txt" "todo.ps"))
7989 ("h" "Agenda and Home-related tasks"
7994 ("~/views/home.html"))
7995 ("o" "Agenda and Office-related tasks"
8000 ("~/views/office.ps" "~/calendars/office.ics"))))
8004 The extension of the file name determines the type of export. If it is
8005 @file{.html}, Org mode will use the @file{htmlize.el} package to convert
8006 the buffer to HTML and save it to this file name. If the extension is
8007 @file{.ps}, @code{ps-print-buffer-with-faces} is used to produce
8008 Postscript output. If the extension is @file{.ics}, iCalendar export is
8009 run export over all files that were used to construct the agenda, and
8010 limit the export to entries listed in the agenda. Any other
8011 extension produces a plain ASCII file.
8013 The export files are @emph{not} created when you use one of those
8014 commands interactively because this might use too much overhead.
8015 Instead, there is a special command to produce @emph{all} specified
8021 Export all agenda views that have export file names associated with
8025 You can use the options section of the custom agenda commands to also
8026 set options for the export commands. For example:
8029 (setq org-agenda-custom-commands
8031 ((ps-number-of-columns 2)
8032 (ps-landscape-mode t)
8033 (org-agenda-prefix-format " [ ] ")
8034 (org-agenda-with-colors nil)
8035 (org-agenda-remove-tags t))
8040 This command sets two options for the Postscript exporter, to make it
8041 print in two columns in landscape format---the resulting page can be cut
8042 in two and then used in a paper agenda. The remaining settings modify
8043 the agenda prefix to omit category and scheduling information, and
8044 instead include a checkbox to check off items. We also remove the tags
8045 to make the lines compact, and we don't want to use colors for the
8046 black-and-white printer. Settings specified in
8047 @code{org-agenda-exporter-settings} will also apply, but the settings
8048 in @code{org-agenda-custom-commands} take precedence.
8051 From the command line you may also use
8053 emacs -f org-batch-store-agenda-views -kill
8056 or, if you need to modify some parameters@footnote{Quoting depends on the
8057 system you use, please check the FAQ for examples.}
8059 emacs -eval '(org-batch-store-agenda-views \
8060 org-agenda-ndays 30 \
8061 org-agenda-start-day "2007-11-01" \
8062 org-agenda-include-diary nil \
8063 org-agenda-files (quote ("~/org/project.org")))' \
8067 which will create the agenda views restricted to the file
8068 @file{~/org/project.org}, without diary entries and with a 30-day
8071 You can also extract agenda information in a way that allows further
8072 processing by other programs. See @ref{Extracting agenda information}, for
8076 @node Agenda column view, , Exporting Agenda Views, Agenda Views
8077 @section Using column view in the agenda
8078 @cindex column view, in agenda
8079 @cindex agenda, column view
8081 Column view (@pxref{Column view}) is normally used to view and edit
8082 properties embedded in the hierarchical structure of an Org file. It can be
8083 quite useful to use column view also from the agenda, where entries are
8084 collected by certain criteria.
8089 Turn on column view in the agenda.
8092 To understand how to use this properly, it is important to realize that the
8093 entries in the agenda are no longer in their proper outline environment.
8094 This causes the following issues:
8098 @vindex org-columns-default-format
8099 @vindex org-overriding-columns-format
8100 Org needs to make a decision which @code{COLUMNS} format to use. Since the
8101 entries in the agenda are collected from different files, and different files
8102 may have different @code{COLUMNS} formats, this is a non-trivial problem.
8103 Org first checks if the variable @code{org-overriding-columns-format} is
8104 currently set, and if so, takes the format from there. Otherwise it takes
8105 the format associated with the first item in the agenda, or, if that item
8106 does not have a specific format (defined in a property, or in its file), it
8107 uses @code{org-columns-default-format}.
8109 @cindex property, special, CLOCKSUM
8110 If any of the columns has a summary type defined (@pxref{Column attributes}),
8111 turning on column view in the agenda will visit all relevant agenda files and
8112 make sure that the computations of this property are up to date. This is
8113 also true for the special @code{CLOCKSUM} property. Org will then sum the
8114 values displayed in the agenda. In the daily/weekly agenda, the sums will
8115 cover a single day, in all other views they cover the entire block. It is
8116 vital to realize that the agenda may show the same entry @emph{twice} (for
8117 example as scheduled and as a deadline), and it may show two entries from the
8118 same hierarchy (for example a @emph{parent} and its @emph{child}). In these
8119 cases, the summation in the agenda will lead to incorrect results because
8120 some values will count double.
8122 When the column view in the agenda shows the @code{CLOCKSUM}, that is always
8123 the entire clocked time for this item. So even in the daily/weekly agenda,
8124 the clocksum listed in column view may originate from times outside the
8125 current view. This has the advantage that you can compare these values with
8126 a column listing the planned total effort for a task---one of the major
8127 applications for column view in the agenda. If you want information about
8128 clocked time in the displayed period use clock table mode (press @kbd{R} in
8133 @node Markup, Exporting, Agenda Views, Top
8134 @chapter Markup for rich export
8136 When exporting Org-mode documents, the exporter tries to reflect the
8137 structure of the document as accurately as possible in the backend. Since
8138 export targets like HTML, La@TeX{}, or DocBook allow much richer formatting,
8139 Org mode has rules on how to prepare text for rich export. This section
8140 summarizes the markup rules used in an Org-mode buffer.
8143 * Structural markup elements:: The basic structure as seen by the exporter
8144 * Images and tables:: Tables and Images will be included
8145 * Literal examples:: Source code examples with special formatting
8146 * Include files:: Include additional files into a document
8147 * Macro replacement:: Use macros to create complex output
8148 * Embedded LaTeX:: LaTeX can be freely used inside Org documents
8151 @node Structural markup elements, Images and tables, Markup, Markup
8152 @section Structural markup elements
8155 * Document title:: Where the title is taken from
8156 * Headings and sections:: The document structure as seen by the exporter
8157 * Table of contents:: The if and where of the table of contents
8158 * Initial text:: Text before the first heading?
8160 * Paragraphs:: Paragraphs
8161 * Footnote markup:: Footnotes
8162 * Emphasis and monospace:: Bold, italic, etc.
8163 * Horizontal rules:: Make a line
8164 * Comment lines:: What will *not* be exported
8167 @node Document title, Headings and sections, Structural markup elements, Structural markup elements
8168 @subheading Document title
8169 @cindex document title, markup rules
8172 The title of the exported document is taken from the special line
8176 #+TITLE: This is the title of the document
8180 If this line does not exist, the title is derived from the first non-empty,
8181 non-comment line in the buffer. If no such line exists, or if you have
8182 turned off exporting of the text before the first headline (see below), the
8183 title will be the file name without extension.
8185 @cindex property, EXPORT_TITLE
8186 If you are exporting only a subtree by marking is as the region, the heading
8187 of the subtree will become the title of the document. If the subtree has a
8188 property @code{EXPORT_TITLE}, that will take precedence.
8190 @node Headings and sections, Table of contents, Document title, Structural markup elements
8191 @subheading Headings and sections
8192 @cindex headings and sections, markup rules
8194 @vindex org-export-headline-levels
8195 The outline structure of the document as described in @ref{Document
8196 Structure}, forms the basis for defining sections of the exported document.
8197 However, since the outline structure is also used for (for example) lists of
8198 tasks, only the first three outline levels will be used as headings. Deeper
8199 levels will become itemized lists. You can change the location of this
8200 switch globally by setting the variable @code{org-export-headline-levels}, or on a
8201 per-file basis with a line
8208 @node Table of contents, Initial text, Headings and sections, Structural markup elements
8209 @subheading Table of contents
8210 @cindex table of contents, markup rules
8212 @vindex org-export-with-toc
8213 The table of contents is normally inserted directly before the first headline
8214 of the file. If you would like to get it to a different location, insert the
8215 string @code{[TABLE-OF-CONTENTS]} on a line by itself at the desired
8216 location. The depth of the table of contents is by default the same as the
8217 number of headline levels, but you can choose a smaller number, or turn off
8218 the table of contents entirely, by configuring the variable
8219 @code{org-export-with-toc}, or on a per-file basis with a line like
8222 #+OPTIONS: toc:2 (only to two levels in TOC)
8223 #+OPTIONS: toc:nil (no TOC at all)
8226 @node Initial text, Lists, Table of contents, Structural markup elements
8227 @subheading Text before the first headline
8228 @cindex text before first headline, markup rules
8231 Org mode normally exports the text before the first headline, and even uses
8232 the first line as the document title. The text will be fully marked up. If
8233 you need to include literal HTML, La@TeX{}, or DocBook code, use the special
8234 constructs described below in the sections for the individual exporters.
8236 @vindex org-export-skip-text-before-1st-heading
8237 Some people like to use the space before the first headline for setup and
8238 internal links and therefore would like to control the exported text before
8239 the first headline in a different way. You can do so by setting the variable
8240 @code{org-export-skip-text-before-1st-heading} to @code{t}. On a per-file
8241 basis, you can get the same effect with @samp{#+OPTIONS: skip:t}.
8244 If you still want to have some text before the first headline, use the
8245 @code{#+TEXT} construct:
8249 #+TEXT: This text will go before the *first* headline.
8250 #+TEXT: [TABLE-OF-CONTENTS]
8251 #+TEXT: This goes between the table of contents and the first headline
8254 @node Lists, Paragraphs, Initial text, Structural markup elements
8256 @cindex lists, markup rules
8258 Plain lists as described in @ref{Plain lists}, are translated to the backend's
8259 syntax for such lists. Most backends support unordered, ordered, and
8262 @node Paragraphs, Footnote markup, Lists, Structural markup elements
8263 @subheading Paragraphs, line breaks, and quoting
8264 @cindex paragraphs, markup rules
8266 Paragraphs are separated by at least one empty line. If you need to enforce
8267 a line break within a paragraph, use @samp{\\} at the end of a line.
8269 To keep the line breaks in a region, but otherwise use normal formatting, you
8270 can use this construct, which can also be used to format poetry.
8272 @cindex #+BEGIN_VERSE
8275 Great clouds overhead
8276 Tiny black birds rise and fall
8283 When quoting a passage from another document, it is customary to format this
8284 as a paragraph that is indented on both the left and the right margin. You
8285 can include quotations in Org-mode documents like this:
8287 @cindex #+BEGIN_QUOTE
8290 Everything should be made as simple as possible,
8291 but not any simpler -- Albert Einstein
8295 If you would like to center some text, do it like this:
8296 @cindex #+BEGIN_CENTER
8299 Everything should be made as simple as possible, \\
8305 @node Footnote markup, Emphasis and monospace, Paragraphs, Structural markup elements
8306 @subheading Footnote markup
8307 @cindex footnotes, markup rules
8308 @cindex @file{footnote.el}
8310 Footnotes defined in the way described in @ref{Footnotes}, will be exported by
8311 all backends. Org allows multiple references to the same note, and
8312 different backends support this to varying degrees.
8314 @node Emphasis and monospace, Horizontal rules, Footnote markup, Structural markup elements
8315 @subheading Emphasis and monospace
8317 @cindex underlined text, markup rules
8318 @cindex bold text, markup rules
8319 @cindex italic text, markup rules
8320 @cindex verbatim text, markup rules
8321 @cindex code text, markup rules
8322 @cindex strike-through text, markup rules
8323 You can make words @b{*bold*}, @i{/italic/}, _underlined_, @code{=code=}
8324 and @code{~verbatim~}, and, if you must, @samp{+strike-through+}. Text
8325 in the code and verbatim string is not processed for Org-mode specific
8326 syntax, it is exported verbatim.
8328 @node Horizontal rules, Comment lines, Emphasis and monospace, Structural markup elements
8329 @subheading Horizontal rules
8330 @cindex horizontal rules, markup rules
8331 A line consisting of only dashes, and at least 5 of them, will be
8332 exported as a horizontal line (@samp{<hr/>} in HTML).
8334 @node Comment lines, , Horizontal rules, Structural markup elements
8335 @subheading Comment lines
8336 @cindex comment lines
8337 @cindex exporting, not
8338 @cindex #+BEGIN_COMMENT
8340 Lines starting with @samp{#} in column zero are treated as comments and will
8341 never be exported. If you want an indented line to be treated as a comment,
8342 start it with @samp{#+ }. Also entire subtrees starting with the word
8343 @samp{COMMENT} will never be exported. Finally, regions surrounded by
8344 @samp{#+BEGIN_COMMENT} ... @samp{#+END_COMMENT} will not be exported.
8349 Toggle the COMMENT keyword at the beginning of an entry.
8353 @node Images and tables, Literal examples, Structural markup elements, Markup
8354 @section Images and Tables
8356 @cindex tables, markup rules
8359 Both the native Org mode tables (@pxref{Tables}) and tables formatted with
8360 the @file{table.el} package will be exported properly. For Org mode tables,
8361 the lines before the first horizontal separator line will become table header
8362 lines. You can use the following lines somewhere before the table to assign
8363 a caption and a label for cross references:
8366 #+CAPTION: This is the caption for the next table (or link)
8367 #+LABEL: tbl:basic-data
8372 @cindex inlined images, markup rules
8373 Some backends (HTML, La@TeX{}, and DocBook) allow you to directly include
8374 images into the exported document. Org does this, if a link to an image
8375 files does not have a description part, for example @code{[[./img/a.jpg]]}.
8376 If you wish to define a caption for the image and maybe a label for internal
8377 cross references, you sure that the link is on a line by itself precede it
8381 #+CAPTION: This is the caption for the next figure link (or table)
8382 #+LABEL: fig:SED-HR4049
8386 You may also define additional attributes for the figure. As this is
8387 backend-specific, see the sections about the individual backends for more
8391 @node Literal examples, Include files, Images and tables, Markup
8392 @section Literal examples
8393 @cindex literal examples, markup rules
8394 @cindex code line references, markup rules
8396 You can include literal examples that should not be subjected to
8397 markup. Such examples will be typeset in monospace, so this is well suited
8398 for source code and similar examples.
8399 @cindex #+BEGIN_EXAMPLE
8403 Some example from a text file.
8407 Note that such blocks may be @i{indented} in order to align nicely with
8408 indented text and in particular with plain list structure (@pxref{Plain
8409 lists}). For simplicity when using small examples, you can also start the
8410 example lines with a colon followed by a space. There may also be additional
8411 whitespace before the colon:
8415 : Some example from a text file.
8418 @cindex formatting source code, markup rules
8419 If the example is source code from a programming language, or any other text
8420 that can be marked up by font-lock in Emacs, you can ask for the example to
8421 look like the fontified Emacs buffer@footnote{Currently this works for the
8422 HTML backend, and requires the @file{htmlize.el} package version 1.34 or
8423 later. It also works for LaTeX with the listings package, if you turn on the
8424 option @code{org-export-latex-listings} and make sure that the listings
8425 package is included by the LaTeX header.}. This is done with the @samp{src}
8426 block, where you also need to specify the name of the major mode that should
8427 be used to fontify the example:
8431 #+BEGIN_SRC emacs-lisp
8432 (defun org-xor (a b)
8438 Both in @code{example} and in @code{src} snippets, you can add a @code{-n}
8439 switch to the end of the @code{BEGIN} line, to get the lines of the example
8440 numbered. If you use a @code{+n} switch, the numbering from the previous
8441 numbered snippet will be continued in the current one. In literal examples,
8442 Org will interpret strings like @samp{(ref:name)} as labels, and use them as
8443 targets for special hyperlinks like @code{[[(name)]]} (i.e. the reference name
8444 enclosed in single parenthesis). In HTML, hovering the mouse over such a
8445 link will remote-highlight the corresponding code line, which is kind of
8448 You can also add a @code{-r} switch which @i{removes} the labels from the
8449 source code@footnote{Adding @code{-k} to @code{-n -r} will @i{keep} the
8450 labels in the source code while using line numbers for the links, which might
8451 be useful to explain those in an org-mode example code.}. With the @code{-n}
8452 switch, links to these references will be labeled by the line numbers from
8453 the code listing, otherwise links will use the labels with no parentheses.
8457 #+BEGIN_SRC emacs-lisp -n -r
8458 (save-excursion (ref:sc)
8459 (goto-char (point-min)) (ref:jump)
8461 In line [[(sc)]] we remember the current position. [[(jump)][Line (jump)]]
8465 @vindex org-coderef-label-format
8466 If the syntax for the label format conflicts with the language syntax, use a
8467 @code{-l} switch to change the format, for example @samp{#+BEGIN_SRC pascal
8468 -n -r -l "((%s))"}. See also the variable @code{org-coderef-label-format}.
8470 HTML export also allows examples to be published as text areas, @xref{Text
8471 areas in HTML export}.
8476 Edit the source code example at point in its native mode. This works by
8477 switching to a temporary buffer with the source code. You need to exit by
8478 pressing @kbd{C-c '} again@footnote{Upon exit, lines starting with @samp{*}
8479 or @samp{#} will get a comma prepended, to keep them from being interpreted
8480 by Org as outline nodes or special comments. These commas will be striped
8481 for editing with @kbd{C-c '}, and also for export.}, the edited version will
8482 then replace the old version in the Org buffer. Fixed-width regions
8483 (where each line starts with a colon followed by a space) will be edited
8484 using @code{artist-mode}@footnote{You may select a different-mode with the
8485 variable @code{org-edit-fixed-width-region-mode}.} to allow creating ASCII
8486 drawings easily. Using this command in an empty line will create a new
8490 Calling @code{org-store-link} while editing a source code example in a
8491 temporary buffer created with @kbd{C-c '} will prompt for a label, make sure
8492 that it is unique in the current buffer, and insert it with the proper
8493 formatting like @samp{(ref:label)} at the end of the current line. Then the
8494 label is stored as a link @samp{(label)}, for retrieval with @kbd{C-c C-l}.
8498 @node Include files, Macro replacement, Literal examples, Markup
8499 @section Include files
8500 @cindex include files, markup rules
8502 During export, you can include the content of another file. For example, to
8503 include your @file{.emacs} file, you could use:
8507 #+INCLUDE: "~/.emacs" src emacs-lisp
8510 The optional second and third parameter are the markup (e.g. @samp{quote},
8511 @samp{example}, or @samp{src}), and, if the markup is @samp{src}, the
8512 language for formatting the contents. The markup is optional, if it is not
8513 given, the text will be assumed to be in Org mode format and will be
8514 processed normally. The include line will also allow additional keyword
8515 parameters @code{:prefix1} and @code{:prefix} to specify prefixes for the
8516 first line and for each following line, as well as any options accepted by
8517 the selected markup. For example, to include a file as an item, use
8520 #+INCLUDE: "~/snippets/xx" :prefix1 " + " :prefix " "
8526 Visit the include file at point.
8530 @node Macro replacement, Embedded LaTeX, Include files, Markup
8531 @section Macro replacement
8532 @cindex macro replacement, during export
8535 You can define text snippets with
8538 #+MACRO: name replacement text $1, $2 are arguments
8541 @noindent which can be referenced anywhere in the document (even in
8542 code examples) with @code{@{@{@{name(arg1,arg2)@}@}@}}. In addition to
8543 defined macros, @code{@{@{@{title@}@}@}}, @code{@{@{@{author@}@}@}}, etc.,
8544 will reference information set by the @code{#+TITLE:}, @code{#+AUTHOR:}, and
8545 similar lines. Also, @code{@{@{@{date(@var{FORMAT})@}@}@}} and
8546 @code{@{@{@{modification-time(@var{FORMAT})@}@}@}} refer to current date time
8547 and to the modification time of the file being exported, respectively.
8548 @var{FORMAT} should be a format string understood by
8549 @code{format-time-string}.
8551 Macro expansion takes place during export, and some people use it to
8552 construct complex HTML code.
8555 @node Embedded LaTeX, , Macro replacement, Markup
8556 @section Embedded La@TeX{}
8557 @cindex @TeX{} interpretation
8558 @cindex La@TeX{} interpretation
8560 Plain ASCII is normally sufficient for almost all note taking. One
8561 exception, however, are scientific notes which need to be able to contain
8562 mathematical symbols and the occasional formula. La@TeX{}@footnote{La@TeX{}
8563 is a macro system based on Donald E. Knuth's @TeX{} system. Many of the
8564 features described here as ``La@TeX{}'' are really from @TeX{}, but for
8565 simplicity I am blurring this distinction.} is widely used to typeset
8566 scientific documents. Org mode supports embedding La@TeX{} code into its
8567 files, because many academics are used to reading La@TeX{} source code, and
8568 because it can be readily processed into images for HTML production.
8570 It is not necessary to mark La@TeX{} macros and code in any special way.
8571 If you observe a few conventions, Org mode knows how to find it and what
8575 * Special symbols:: Greek letters and other symbols
8576 * Subscripts and superscripts:: Simple syntax for raising/lowering text
8577 * LaTeX fragments:: Complex formulas made easy
8578 * Previewing LaTeX fragments:: What will this snippet look like?
8579 * CDLaTeX mode:: Speed up entering of formulas
8582 @node Special symbols, Subscripts and superscripts, Embedded LaTeX, Embedded LaTeX
8583 @subsection Special symbols
8584 @cindex math symbols
8585 @cindex special symbols
8586 @cindex @TeX{} macros
8587 @cindex La@TeX{} fragments, markup rules
8588 @cindex HTML entities
8589 @cindex La@TeX{} entities
8591 You can use La@TeX{} macros to insert special symbols like @samp{\alpha} to
8592 indicate the Greek letter, or @samp{\to} to indicate an arrow. Completion
8593 for these macros is available, just type @samp{\} and maybe a few letters,
8594 and press @kbd{M-@key{TAB}} to see possible completions. Unlike La@TeX{}
8595 code, Org mode allows these macros to be present without surrounding math
8596 delimiters, for example:
8599 Angles are written as Greek letters \alpha, \beta and \gamma.
8602 @vindex org-html-entities
8603 During export, these symbols will be transformed into the native format of
8604 the exporter backend. Strings like @code{\alpha} will be exported as
8605 @code{α} in the HTML output, and as @code{$\alpha$} in the La@TeX{}
8606 output. Similarly, @code{\nbsp} will become @code{ } in HTML and
8607 @code{~} in La@TeX{}. If you need such a symbol inside a word, terminate it
8608 like this: @samp{\Aacute@{@}stor}.
8610 A large number of entities is provided, with names taken from both HTML and
8611 La@TeX{}, see the variable @code{org-html-entities} for the complete list.
8612 @samp{\-} is treated as a shy hyphen, and @samp{--}, @samp{---}, and
8613 @samp{...} are all converted into special commands creating hyphens of
8614 different lengths or a compact set of dots.
8616 @node Subscripts and superscripts, LaTeX fragments, Special symbols, Embedded LaTeX
8617 @subsection Subscripts and superscripts
8621 Just like in La@TeX{}, @samp{^} and @samp{_} are used to indicate super-
8622 and subscripts. Again, these can be used without embedding them in
8623 math-mode delimiters. To increase the readability of ASCII text, it is
8624 not necessary (but OK) to surround multi-character sub- and superscripts
8625 with curly braces. For example
8628 The mass if the sun is M_sun = 1.989 x 10^30 kg. The radius of
8629 the sun is R_@{sun@} = 6.96 x 10^8 m.
8632 @vindex org-export-with-sub-superscripts
8633 To avoid interpretation as raised or lowered text, you can quote @samp{^} and
8634 @samp{_} with a backslash: @samp{\^} and @samp{\_}. If you write a text
8635 where the underscore is often used in a different context, Org's convention
8636 to always interpret these as subscripts can get in your way. Configure the
8637 variable @code{org-export-with-sub-superscripts} to globally change this
8638 convention, or use, on a per-file basis:
8645 @node LaTeX fragments, Previewing LaTeX fragments, Subscripts and superscripts, Embedded LaTeX
8646 @subsection La@TeX{} fragments
8647 @cindex La@TeX{} fragments
8649 @vindex org-format-latex-header
8650 With symbols, sub- and superscripts, HTML is pretty much at its end when
8651 it comes to representing mathematical formulas@footnote{Yes, there is
8652 MathML, but that is not yet fully supported by many browsers, and there
8653 is no decent converter for turning La@TeX{} or ASCII representations of
8654 formulas into MathML. So for the time being, converting formulas into
8655 images seems the way to go.}. More complex expressions need a dedicated
8656 formula processor. To this end, Org mode can contain arbitrary La@TeX{}
8657 fragments. It provides commands to preview the typeset result of these
8658 fragments, and upon export to HTML, all fragments will be converted to
8659 images and inlined into the HTML document@footnote{The La@TeX{} export
8660 will not use images for displaying La@TeX{} fragments but include these
8661 fragments directly into the La@TeX{} code.}. For this to work you
8662 need to be on a system with a working La@TeX{} installation. You also
8663 need the @file{dvipng} program, available at
8664 @url{http://sourceforge.net/projects/dvipng/}. The La@TeX{} header that
8665 will be used when processing a fragment can be configured with the
8666 variable @code{org-format-latex-header}.
8668 La@TeX{} fragments don't need any special marking at all. The following
8669 snippets will be identified as La@TeX{} source code:
8672 Environments of any kind. The only requirement is that the
8673 @code{\begin} statement appears on a new line, preceded by only
8676 Text within the usual La@TeX{} math delimiters. To avoid conflicts with
8677 currency specifications, single @samp{$} characters are only recognized as
8678 math delimiters if the enclosed text contains at most two line breaks, is
8679 directly attached to the @samp{$} characters with no whitespace in between,
8680 and if the closing @samp{$} is followed by whitespace, punctuation or a dash.
8681 For the other delimiters, there is no such restriction, so when in doubt, use
8682 @samp{\(...\)} as inline math delimiters.
8685 @noindent For example:
8688 \begin@{equation@} % arbitrary environments,
8689 x=\sqrt@{b@} % even tables, figures
8690 \end@{equation@} % etc
8692 If $a^2=b$ and \( b=2 \), then the solution must be
8693 either $$ a=+\sqrt@{2@} $$ or \[ a=-\sqrt@{2@} \].
8697 @vindex org-format-latex-options
8698 If you need any of the delimiter ASCII sequences for other purposes, you
8699 can configure the option @code{org-format-latex-options} to deselect the
8700 ones you do not wish to have interpreted by the La@TeX{} converter.
8702 @node Previewing LaTeX fragments, CDLaTeX mode, LaTeX fragments, Embedded LaTeX
8703 @subsection Previewing LaTeX fragments
8704 @cindex LaTeX fragments, preview
8706 La@TeX{} fragments can be processed to produce preview images of the
8707 typeset expressions:
8712 Produce a preview image of the La@TeX{} fragment at point and overlay it
8713 over the source code. If there is no fragment at point, process all
8714 fragments in the current entry (between two headlines). When called
8715 with a prefix argument, process the entire subtree. When called with
8716 two prefix arguments, or when the cursor is before the first headline,
8717 process the entire buffer.
8720 Remove the overlay preview images.
8723 @vindex org-format-latex-options
8724 You can customize the variable @code{org-format-latex-options} to influence
8725 some aspects of the preview. In particular, the @code{:scale} (and for HTML
8726 export, @code{:html-scale}) property can be used to adjust the size of the
8729 During HTML export (@pxref{HTML export}), all La@TeX{} fragments are
8730 converted into images and inlined into the document if the following
8734 (setq org-export-with-LaTeX-fragments t)
8737 @node CDLaTeX mode, , Previewing LaTeX fragments, Embedded LaTeX
8738 @subsection Using CDLa@TeX{} to enter math
8741 CDLa@TeX{} mode is a minor mode that is normally used in combination with a
8742 major La@TeX{} mode like AUC@TeX{} in order to speed-up insertion of
8743 environments and math templates. Inside Org mode, you can make use of
8744 some of the features of CDLa@TeX{} mode. You need to install
8745 @file{cdlatex.el} and @file{texmathp.el} (the latter comes also with
8746 AUC@TeX{}) from @url{http://www.astro.uva.nl/~dominik/Tools/cdlatex}.
8747 Don't use CDLa@TeX{} mode itself under Org mode, but use the light
8748 version @code{org-cdlatex-mode} that comes as part of Org mode. Turn it
8749 on for the current buffer with @code{M-x org-cdlatex-mode}, or for all
8753 (add-hook 'org-mode-hook 'turn-on-org-cdlatex)
8756 When this mode is enabled, the following features are present (for more
8757 details see the documentation of CDLa@TeX{} mode):
8761 Environment templates can be inserted with @kbd{C-c @{}.
8764 The @key{TAB} key will do template expansion if the cursor is inside a
8765 La@TeX{} fragment@footnote{Org mode has a method to test if the cursor is
8766 inside such a fragment, see the documentation of the function
8767 @code{org-inside-LaTeX-fragment-p}.}. For example, @key{TAB} will
8768 expand @code{fr} to @code{\frac@{@}@{@}} and position the cursor
8769 correctly inside the first brace. Another @key{TAB} will get you into
8770 the second brace. Even outside fragments, @key{TAB} will expand
8771 environment abbreviations at the beginning of a line. For example, if
8772 you write @samp{equ} at the beginning of a line and press @key{TAB},
8773 this abbreviation will be expanded to an @code{equation} environment.
8774 To get a list of all abbreviations, type @kbd{M-x cdlatex-command-help}.
8778 @vindex cdlatex-simplify-sub-super-scripts
8779 Pressing @kbd{_} and @kbd{^} inside a La@TeX{} fragment will insert these
8780 characters together with a pair of braces. If you use @key{TAB} to move
8781 out of the braces, and if the braces surround only a single character or
8782 macro, they are removed again (depending on the variable
8783 @code{cdlatex-simplify-sub-super-scripts}).
8786 Pressing the backquote @kbd{`} followed by a character inserts math
8787 macros, also outside La@TeX{} fragments. If you wait more than 1.5 seconds
8788 after the backquote, a help window will pop up.
8791 Pressing the single-quote @kbd{'} followed by another character modifies
8792 the symbol before point with an accent or a font. If you wait more than
8793 1.5 seconds after the backquote, a help window will pop up. Character
8794 modification will work only inside La@TeX{} fragments, outside the quote
8798 @node Exporting, Publishing, Markup, Top
8802 Org-mode documents can be exported into a variety of other formats. For
8803 printing and sharing of notes, ASCII export produces a readable and simple
8804 version of an Org file. HTML export allows you to publish a notes file on
8805 the web, while the XOXO format provides a solid base for exchange with a
8806 broad range of other applications. La@TeX{} export lets you use Org mode and
8807 its structured editing functions to easily create La@TeX{} files. DocBook
8808 export makes it possible to convert Org files to many other formats using
8809 DocBook tools. To incorporate entries with associated times like deadlines
8810 or appointments into a desktop calendar program like iCal, Org mode can also
8811 produce extracts in the iCalendar format. Currently Org mode only supports
8812 export, not import of these different formats.
8814 Org supports export of selected regions when @code{transient-mark-mode} is
8815 enabled (default in Emacs 23).
8818 * Selective export:: Using tags to select and exclude trees
8819 * Export options:: Per-file export settings
8820 * The export dispatcher:: How to access exporter commands
8821 * ASCII export:: Exporting to plain ASCII
8822 * HTML export:: Exporting to HTML
8823 * LaTeX and PDF export:: Exporting to La@TeX{}, and processing to PDF
8824 * DocBook export:: Exporting to DocBook
8825 * Freemind export:: Exporting to Freemind mind maps
8826 * XOXO export:: Exporting to XOXO
8827 * iCalendar export:: Exporting in iCalendar format
8830 @node Selective export, Export options, Exporting, Exporting
8831 @section Selective export
8832 @cindex export, selective by tags
8834 @vindex org-export-select-tags
8835 @vindex org-export-exclude-tags
8836 You may use tags to select the parts of a document that should be exported,
8837 or to exclude parts from export. This behavior is governed by two variables:
8838 @code{org-export-select-tags} and @code{org-export-exclude-tags}.
8840 Org first checks if any of the @emph{select} tags is present in the buffer.
8841 If yes, all trees that do not carry one of these tags will be excluded. If a
8842 selected tree is a subtree, the heading hierarchy above it will also be
8843 selected for export, but not the text below those headings.
8846 If none of the select tags is found, the whole buffer will be selected for
8850 Finally, all subtrees that are marked by any of the @emph{exclude} tags will
8851 be removed from the export buffer.
8853 @node Export options, The export dispatcher, Selective export, Exporting
8854 @section Export options
8855 @cindex options, for export
8857 @cindex completion, of option keywords
8858 The exporter recognizes special lines in the buffer which provide
8859 additional information. These lines may be put anywhere in the file.
8860 The whole set of lines can be inserted into the buffer with @kbd{C-c
8861 C-e t}. For individual lines, a good way to make sure the keyword is
8862 correct is to type @samp{#+} and then use @kbd{M-@key{TAB}} completion
8863 (@pxref{Completion}). For a summary of other in-buffer settings not
8864 specifically related to export, see @ref{In-buffer settings}.
8865 In particular, note that you can place commonly-used (export) options in
8866 a separate file which can be included using @code{#+SETUPFILE}.
8871 Insert template with export options, see example below.
8878 @cindex #+DESCRIPTION
8886 @cindex #+EXPORT_SELECT_TAGS
8887 @cindex #+EXPORT_EXCLUDE_TAGS
8888 @cindex #+LATEX_HEADER
8889 @vindex user-full-name
8890 @vindex user-mail-address
8891 @vindex org-export-default-language
8893 #+TITLE: the title to be shown (default is the buffer name)
8894 #+AUTHOR: the author (default taken from @code{user-full-name})
8895 #+DATE: a date, fixed, of a format string for @code{format-time-string}
8896 #+EMAIL: his/her email address (default from @code{user-mail-address})
8897 #+DESCRIPTION: the page description, e.g. for the XHTML meta tag
8898 #+KEYWORDS: the page keywords, e.g. for the XHTML meta tag
8899 #+LANGUAGE: language for HTML, e.g. @samp{en} (@code{org-export-default-language})
8900 #+TEXT: Some descriptive text to be inserted at the beginning.
8901 #+TEXT: Several lines may be given.
8902 #+OPTIONS: H:2 num:t toc:t \n:nil @@:t ::t |:t ^:t f:t TeX:t ...
8903 #+BIND: lisp-var lisp-val, e.g.: org-export-latex-low-levels itemize
8904 @r{You need to confirm using these, or configure @code{org-export-allow-BIND}}
8905 #+LINK_UP: the ``up'' link of an exported page
8906 #+LINK_HOME: the ``home'' link of an exported page
8907 #+LATEX_HEADER: extra line(s) for the LaTeX header, like \usepackage@{xyz@}
8908 #+EXPORT_SELECT_TAGS: Tags that select a tree for export
8909 #+EXPORT_EXCLUDE_TAGS: Tags that exclude a tree from export
8913 The OPTIONS line is a compact@footnote{If you want to configure many options
8914 this way, you can use several OPTIONS lines.} form to specify export settings. Here
8916 @cindex headline levels
8917 @cindex section-numbers
8918 @cindex table of contents
8919 @cindex line-break preservation
8920 @cindex quoted HTML tags
8921 @cindex fixed-width sections
8923 @cindex @TeX{}-like syntax for sub- and superscripts
8925 @cindex special strings
8926 @cindex emphasized text
8927 @cindex @TeX{} macros
8928 @cindex La@TeX{} fragments
8929 @cindex author info, in export
8930 @cindex time info, in export
8932 H: @r{set the number of headline levels for export}
8933 num: @r{turn on/off section-numbers}
8934 toc: @r{turn on/off table of contents, or set level limit (integer)}
8935 \n: @r{turn on/off line-break-preservation (DOES NOT WORK)}
8936 @@: @r{turn on/off quoted HTML tags}
8937 :: @r{turn on/off fixed-width sections}
8938 |: @r{turn on/off tables}
8939 ^: @r{turn on/off @TeX{}-like syntax for sub- and superscripts. If}
8940 @r{you write "^:@{@}", @code{a_@{b@}} will be interpreted, but}
8941 @r{the simple @code{a_b} will be left as it is.}
8942 -: @r{turn on/off conversion of special strings.}
8943 f: @r{turn on/off footnotes like this[1].}
8944 todo: @r{turn on/off inclusion of TODO keywords into exported text}
8945 pri: @r{turn on/off priority cookies}
8946 tags: @r{turn on/off inclusion of tags, may also be @code{not-in-toc}}
8947 <: @r{turn on/off inclusion of any time/date stamps like DEADLINES}
8948 *: @r{turn on/off emphasized text (bold, italic, underlined)}
8949 TeX: @r{turn on/off simple @TeX{} macros in plain text}
8950 LaTeX: @r{turn on/off La@TeX{} fragments}
8951 skip: @r{turn on/off skipping the text before the first heading}
8952 author: @r{turn on/off inclusion of author name/email into exported file}
8953 creator: @r{turn on/off inclusion of creator info into exported file}
8954 timestamp: @r{turn on/off inclusion creation time into exported file}
8955 d: @r{turn on/off inclusion of drawers}
8958 These options take effect in both the HTML and La@TeX{} export, except
8959 for @code{TeX} and @code{LaTeX}, which are respectively @code{t} and
8960 @code{nil} for the La@TeX{} export.
8962 When exporting only a single subtree by selecting it with @kbd{C-c @@} before
8963 calling an export command, the subtree can overrule some of the file's export
8964 settings with properties @code{EXPORT_FILE_NAME}, @code{EXPORT_TITLE},
8965 @code{EXPORT_TEXT}, @code{EXPORT_AUTHOR}, @code{EXPORT_DATE}, and
8966 @code{EXPORT_OPTIONS}.
8968 @node The export dispatcher, ASCII export, Export options, Exporting
8969 @section The export dispatcher
8970 @cindex dispatcher, for export commands
8972 All export commands can be reached using the export dispatcher, which is a
8973 prefix key that prompts for an additional key specifying the command.
8974 Normally the entire file is exported, but if there is an active region that
8975 contains one outline tree, the first heading is used as document title and
8976 the subtrees are exported.
8981 @vindex org-export-run-in-background
8982 Dispatcher for export and publishing commands. Displays a help-window
8983 listing the additional key(s) needed to launch an export or publishing
8984 command. The prefix arg is passed through to the exporter. A double prefix
8985 @kbd{C-u C-u} causes most commands to be executed in the background, in a
8986 separate Emacs process@footnote{To make this behavior the default, customize
8987 the variable @code{org-export-run-in-background}.}.
8990 Like @kbd{C-c C-e}, but only export the text that is currently visible
8991 (i.e. not hidden by outline visibility).
8992 @kindex C-u C-u C-c C-e
8993 @item C-u C-u C-c C-e
8994 @vindex org-export-run-in-background
8995 Call an the exporter, but reverse the setting of
8996 @code{org-export-run-in-background}, i.e. request background processing if
8997 not set, or force processing in the current Emacs process if set.
9000 @node ASCII export, HTML export, The export dispatcher, Exporting
9001 @section ASCII export
9002 @cindex ASCII export
9004 ASCII export produces a simple and very readable version of an Org-mode
9007 @cindex region, active
9008 @cindex active region
9009 @cindex transient-mark-mode
9013 @cindex property, EXPORT_FILE_NAME
9014 Export as ASCII file. For an Org file, @file{myfile.org}, the ASCII file
9015 will be @file{myfile.txt}. The file will be overwritten without
9016 warning. If there is an active region@footnote{This requires
9017 @code{transient-mark-mode} be turned on.}, only the region will be
9018 exported. If the selected region is a single tree@footnote{To select the
9019 current subtree, use @kbd{C-c @@}.}, the tree head will
9020 become the document title. If the tree head entry has or inherits an
9021 @code{EXPORT_FILE_NAME} property, that name will be used for the
9025 Export to a temporary buffer, do not create a file.
9028 Export only the visible part of the document.
9031 @cindex headline levels, for exporting
9032 In the exported version, the first 3 outline levels will become
9033 headlines, defining a general document structure. Additional levels
9034 will be exported as itemized lists. If you want that transition to occur
9035 at a different level, specify it with a prefix argument. For example,
9042 creates only top level headlines and does the rest as items. When
9043 headlines are converted to items, the indentation of the text following
9044 the headline is changed to fit nicely under the item. This is done with
9045 the assumption that the first body line indicates the base indentation of
9046 the body text. Any indentation larger than this is adjusted to preserve
9047 the layout relative to the first line. Should there be lines with less
9048 indentation than the first, these are left alone.
9050 @vindex org-export-ascii-links-to-notes
9051 Links will be exported in a footnote-like style, with the descriptive part in
9052 the text and the link in a note before the next heading. See the variable
9053 @code{org-export-ascii-links-to-notes} for details and other options.
9055 @node HTML export, LaTeX and PDF export, ASCII export, Exporting
9056 @section HTML export
9059 Org mode contains an HTML (XHTML 1.0 strict) exporter with extensive
9060 HTML formatting, in ways similar to John Gruber's @emph{markdown}
9061 language, but with additional support for tables.
9064 * HTML Export commands:: How to invoke HTML export
9065 * Quoting HTML tags:: Using direct HTML in Org mode
9066 * Links in HTML export:: How links will be interpreted and formatted
9067 * Tables in HTML export:: How to modify the formatting of tables
9068 * Images in HTML export:: How to insert figures into HTML output
9069 * Text areas in HTML export:: An alternative way to show an example
9070 * CSS support:: Changing the appearance of the output
9071 * Javascript support:: Info and Folding in a web browser
9074 @node HTML Export commands, Quoting HTML tags, HTML export, HTML export
9075 @subsection HTML export commands
9077 @cindex region, active
9078 @cindex active region
9079 @cindex transient-mark-mode
9083 @cindex property, EXPORT_FILE_NAME
9084 Export as HTML file @file{myfile.html}. For an Org file @file{myfile.org},
9085 the ASCII file will be @file{myfile.html}. The file will be overwritten
9086 without warning. If there is an active region@footnote{This requires
9087 @code{transient-mark-mode} be turned on.}, only the region will be
9088 exported. If the selected region is a single tree@footnote{To select the
9089 current subtree, use @kbd{C-c @@}.}, the tree head will become the document
9090 title. If the tree head entry has, or inherits, an @code{EXPORT_FILE_NAME}
9091 property, that name will be used for the export.
9094 Export as HTML file and immediately open it with a browser.
9097 Export to a temporary buffer, do not create a file.
9100 Export the active region to a temporary buffer. With a prefix argument, do
9101 not produce the file header and footer, but just the plain HTML section for
9102 the region. This is good for cut-and-paste operations.
9111 Export only the visible part of the document.
9112 @item M-x org-export-region-as-html
9113 Convert the region to HTML under the assumption that it was Org-mode
9114 syntax before. This is a global command that can be invoked in any
9116 @item M-x org-replace-region-by-HTML
9117 Replace the active region (assumed to be in Org-mode syntax) by HTML
9121 @cindex headline levels, for exporting
9122 In the exported version, the first 3 outline levels will become headlines,
9123 defining a general document structure. Additional levels will be exported as
9124 itemized lists. If you want that transition to occur at a different level,
9125 specify it with a numeric prefix argument. For example,
9132 creates two levels of headings and does the rest as items.
9134 @node Quoting HTML tags, Links in HTML export, HTML Export commands, HTML export
9135 @subsection Quoting HTML tags
9137 Plain @samp{<} and @samp{>} are always transformed to @samp{<} and
9138 @samp{>} in HTML export. If you want to include simple HTML tags
9139 which should be interpreted as such, mark them with @samp{@@} as in
9140 @samp{@@<b>bold text@@</b>}. Note that this really works only for
9141 simple tags. For more extensive HTML that should be copied verbatim to
9142 the exported file use either
9145 @cindex #+BEGIN_HTML
9147 #+HTML: Literal HTML code for export
9151 @cindex #+BEGIN_HTML
9155 All lines between these markers are exported literally
9160 @node Links in HTML export, Tables in HTML export, Quoting HTML tags, HTML export
9161 @subsection Links in HTML export
9163 @cindex links, in HTML export
9164 @cindex internal links, in HTML export
9165 @cindex external links, in HTML export
9166 Internal links (@pxref{Internal links}) will continue to work in HTML. This
9167 includes automatic links created by radio targets (@pxref{Radio
9168 targets}). Links to external files will still work if the target file is on
9169 the same @i{relative} path as the published Org file. Links to other
9170 @file{.org} files will be translated into HTML links under the assumption
9171 that an HTML version also exists of the linked file, at the same relative
9172 path. @samp{id:} links can then be used to jump to specific entries across
9173 files. For information related to linking files while publishing them to a
9174 publishing directory see @ref{Publishing links}.
9176 If you want to specify attributes for links, you can do so using a special
9177 @code{#+ATTR_HTML} line to define attributes that will be added to the
9178 @code{<a>} or @code{<img>} tags. Here is an example that sets @code{title}
9179 and @code{style} attributes for a link:
9183 #+ATTR_HTML: title="The Org-mode homepage" style="color:red;"
9184 [[http://orgmode.org]]
9187 @node Tables in HTML export, Images in HTML export, Links in HTML export, HTML export
9189 @cindex tables, in HTML
9190 @vindex org-export-html-table-tag
9192 Org-mode tables are exported to HTML using the table tag defined in
9193 @code{org-export-html-table-tag}. The default setting makes tables without
9194 cell borders and frame. If you would like to change this for individual
9195 tables, place somthing like the following before the table:
9200 #+CAPTION: This is a table with lines around and between cells
9201 #+ATTR_HTML: border="2" rules="all" frame="all"
9204 @node Images in HTML export, Text areas in HTML export, Tables in HTML export, HTML export
9205 @subsection Images in HTML export
9207 @cindex images, inline in HTML
9208 @cindex inlining images in HTML
9209 @vindex org-export-html-inline-images
9210 HTML export can inline images given as links in the Org file, and
9211 it can make an image the clickable part of a link. By
9212 default@footnote{But see the variable
9213 @code{org-export-html-inline-images}.}, images are inlined if a link does
9214 not have a description. So @samp{[[file:myimg.jpg]]} will be inlined,
9215 while @samp{[[file:myimg.jpg][the image]]} will just produce a link
9216 @samp{the image} that points to the image. If the description part
9217 itself is a @code{file:} link or a @code{http:} URL pointing to an
9218 image, this image will be inlined and activated so that clicking on the
9219 image will activate the link. For example, to include a thumbnail that
9220 will link to a high resolution version of the image, you could use:
9223 [[file:highres.jpg][file:thumb.jpg]]
9226 If you need to add attributes to an inlines image, use a @code{#+ATTR_HTML}.
9227 In the example below we specify the @code{alt} and @code{title} attributes to
9228 support text viewers and accessibility, and align it to the right.
9233 #+CAPTION: A black cat stalking a spider
9234 #+ATTR_HTML: alt="cat/spider image" title="Action!" align="right"
9239 and you could use @code{http} addresses just as well.
9241 @node Text areas in HTML export, CSS support, Images in HTML export, HTML export
9242 @subsection Text areas in HTML export
9244 @cindex text areas, in HTML
9245 An alternative way to publish literal code examples in HTML is to use text
9246 areas, where the example can even be edited before pasting it into an
9247 application. It is triggered by a @code{-t} switch at an @code{example} or
9248 @code{src} block. Using this switch disables any options for syntax and
9249 label highlighting, and line numbering, which may be present. You may also
9250 use @code{-h} and @code{-w} switches to specify the height and width of the
9251 text area, which default to the number of lines in the example, and 80,
9252 respectively. For example
9255 #+BEGIN_EXAMPLE -t -w 40
9256 (defun org-xor (a b)
9263 @node CSS support, Javascript support, Text areas in HTML export, HTML export
9264 @subsection CSS support
9265 @cindex CSS, for HTML export
9266 @cindex HTML export, CSS
9268 @vindex org-export-html-todo-kwd-class-prefix
9269 @vindex org-export-html-tag-class-prefix
9270 You can also give style information for the exported file. The HTML exporter
9271 assigns the following special CSS classes@footnote{If the classes on TODO
9272 keywords and tags lead to conflicts, use the variables
9273 @code{org-export-html-todo-kwd-class-prefix} and
9274 @code{org-export-html-tag-class-prefix} to make them unique.} to appropriate
9275 parts of the document---your style specifications may change these, in
9276 addition to any of the standard classes like for headlines, tables, etc.
9278 p.author @r{author information, including email}
9279 p.date @r{publishing date}
9280 p.creator @r{creator info, about org-mode version}
9281 .title @r{document title}
9282 .todo @r{TODO keywords, all not-done states}
9283 .done @r{the DONE keywords, all stated the count as done}
9284 .WAITING @r{each TODO keyword also uses a class named after itself}
9285 .timestamp @r{timestamp}
9286 .timestamp-kwd @r{keyword associated with a timestamp, like SCHEDULED}
9287 .timestamp-wrapper @r{span around keyword plus timestamp}
9288 .tag @r{tag in a headline}
9289 ._HOME @r{each tag uses itself as a class, "@@" replaced by "_"}
9290 .target @r{target for links}
9291 .linenr @r{the line number in a code example}
9292 .code-highlighted @r{for highlighting referenced code lines}
9293 div.outline-N @r{div for outline level N (headline plus text))}
9294 div.outline-text-N @r{extra div for text at outline level N}
9295 .section-number-N @r{section number in headlines, different for each level}
9296 div.figure @r{how to format an inlined image}
9297 pre.src @r{formatted source code}
9298 pre.example @r{normal example}
9299 p.verse @r{verse paragraph}
9300 div.footnotes @r{footnote section headline}
9301 p.footnote @r{footnote definition paragraph, containing a footnote}
9302 .footref @r{a footnote reference number (always a <sup>)}
9303 .footnum @r{footnote number in footnote definition (always <sup>)}
9306 @vindex org-export-html-style-default
9307 @vindex org-export-html-style-include-default
9308 @vindex org-export-html-style
9309 @vindex org-export-html-extra
9310 @vindex org-export-html-style-default
9311 Each exported file contains a compact default style that defines these
9312 classes in a basic way@footnote{This style is defined in the constant
9313 @code{org-export-html-style-default}, which you should not modify. To turn
9314 inclusion of these defaults off, customize
9315 @code{org-export-html-style-include-default}}. You may overwrite these
9316 settings, or add to them by using the variables @code{org-export-html-style}
9317 (for Org-wide settings) and @code{org-export-html-style-extra} (for more
9318 granular settings, like file-local settings). To set the latter variable
9319 individually for each file, you can use
9323 #+STYLE: <link rel="stylesheet" type="text/css" href="stylesheet.css" />
9327 For longer style definitions, you can use several such lines. You could also
9328 directly write a @code{<style>} @code{</style>} section in this way, without
9329 referring to an external file.
9331 @c FIXME: More about header and footer styles
9332 @c FIXME: Talk about links and targets.
9334 @node Javascript support, , CSS support, HTML export
9335 @subsection Javascript supported display of web pages
9337 @cindex Rose, Sebastian
9338 Sebastian Rose has written a JavaScript program especially designed to
9339 enhance the web viewing experience of HTML files created with Org. This
9340 program allows you to view large files in two different ways. The first one
9341 is an @emph{Info}-like mode where each section is displayed separately and
9342 navigation can be done with the @kbd{n} and @kbd{p} keys (and some other keys
9343 as well, press @kbd{?} for an overview of the available keys). The second
9344 view type is a @emph{folding} view much like Org provides inside Emacs. The
9345 script is available at @url{http://orgmode.org/org-info.js} and you can find
9346 the documentation for it at @url{http://orgmode.org/worg/code/org-info-js/}.
9347 We host the script at our site, but if you use it a lot, you might
9348 not want to be dependent on @url{orgmode.org} and prefer to install a local
9349 copy on your own web server.
9351 To use the script, you need to make sure that the @file{org-jsinfo.el} module
9352 gets loaded. It should be loaded by default, but you can try @kbd{M-x
9353 customize-variable @key{RET} org-modules @key{RET}} to convince yourself that
9354 this is indeed the case. All it then takes to make use of the program is
9355 adding a single line to the Org file:
9357 @cindex #+INFOJS_OPT
9359 #+INFOJS_OPT: view:info toc:nil
9363 If this line is found, the HTML header will automatically contain the code
9364 needed to invoke the script. Using the line above, you can set the following
9368 path: @r{The path to the script. The default is to grab the script from}
9369 @r{@url{http://orgmode.org/org-info.js}, but you might want to have}
9370 @r{a local copy and use a path like @samp{../scripts/org-info.js}.}
9371 view: @r{Initial view when website is first shown. Possible values are:}
9372 info @r{Info-like interface with one section per page.}
9373 overview @r{Folding interface, initially showing only top-level.}
9374 content @r{Folding interface, starting with all headlines visible.}
9375 showall @r{Folding interface, all headlines and text visible.}
9376 sdepth: @r{Maximum headline level that will still become an independent}
9377 @r{section for info and folding modes. The default is taken from}
9378 @r{@code{org-export-headline-levels} (= the @code{H} switch in @code{#+OPTIONS}).}
9379 @r{If this is smaller than in @code{org-export-headline-levels}, each}
9380 @r{info/folding section can still contain child headlines.}
9381 toc: @r{Should the table of content @emph{initially} be visible?}
9382 @r{Even when @code{nil}, you can always get to the "toc" with @kbd{i}.}
9383 tdepth: @r{The depth of the table of contents. The defaults are taken from}
9384 @r{the variables @code{org-export-headline-levels} and @code{org-export-with-toc}.}
9385 ftoc: @r{Does the css of the page specify a fixed position for the "toc"?}
9386 @r{If yes, the toc will never be displayed as a section.}
9387 ltoc: @r{Should there be short contents (children) in each section?}
9388 @r{Make this @code{above} if the section should be above initial text.}
9389 mouse: @r{Headings are highlighted when the mouse is over them. Should be}
9390 @r{@samp{underline} (default) or a background color like @samp{#cccccc}.}
9391 buttons: @r{Should view-toggle buttons be everywhere? When @code{nil} (the}
9392 @r{default), only one such button will be present.}
9395 @vindex org-infojs-options
9396 @vindex org-export-html-use-infojs
9397 You can choose default values for these options by customizing the variable
9398 @code{org-infojs-options}. If you always want to apply the script to your
9399 pages, configure the variable @code{org-export-html-use-infojs}.
9401 @node LaTeX and PDF export, DocBook export, HTML export, Exporting
9402 @section La@TeX{} and PDF export
9403 @cindex La@TeX{} export
9405 @cindex Guerry, Bastien
9407 Org mode contains a La@TeX{} exporter written by Bastien Guerry. With
9408 further processing, this backend is also used to produce PDF output. Since
9409 the La@TeX{} output uses @file{hyperref} to implement links and cross
9410 references, the PDF output file will be fully linked.
9413 * LaTeX/PDF export commands:: Which key invokes which commands
9414 * Quoting LaTeX code:: Incorporating literal La@TeX{} code
9415 * Sectioning structure:: Changing sectioning in La@TeX{} output
9416 * Tables in LaTeX export:: Options for exporting tables to La@TeX{}
9417 * Images in LaTeX export:: How to insert figures into La@TeX{} output
9418 * Beamer class export:: Turning the file into a presentation
9421 @node LaTeX/PDF export commands, Quoting LaTeX code, LaTeX and PDF export, LaTeX and PDF export
9422 @subsection La@TeX{} export commands
9424 @cindex region, active
9425 @cindex active region
9426 @cindex transient-mark-mode
9430 @cindex property EXPORT_FILE_NAME
9431 Export as La@TeX{} file @file{myfile.tex}. For an Org file
9432 @file{myfile.org}, the ASCII file will be @file{myfile.tex}. The file will
9433 be overwritten without warning. If there is an active region@footnote{This
9434 requires @code{transient-mark-mode} be turned on.}, only the region will be
9435 exported. If the selected region is a single tree@footnote{To select the
9436 current subtree, use @kbd{C-c @@}.}, the tree head will become the document
9437 title. If the tree head entry has or inherits an @code{EXPORT_FILE_NAME}
9438 property, that name will be used for the export.
9441 Export to a temporary buffer, do not create a file.
9446 Export only the visible part of the document.
9447 @item M-x org-export-region-as-latex
9448 Convert the region to La@TeX{} under the assumption that it was Org mode
9449 syntax before. This is a global command that can be invoked in any
9451 @item M-x org-replace-region-by-latex
9452 Replace the active region (assumed to be in Org mode syntax) by La@TeX{}
9456 Export as La@TeX{} and then process to PDF.
9459 Export as La@TeX{} and then process to PDF, then open the resulting PDF file.
9462 @cindex headline levels, for exporting
9463 @vindex org-latex-low-levels
9464 In the exported version, the first 3 outline levels will become
9465 headlines, defining a general document structure. Additional levels
9466 will be exported as description lists. The exporter can ignore them or
9467 convert them to a custom string depending on
9468 @code{org-latex-low-levels}.
9470 If you want that transition to occur at a different level, specify it
9471 with a numeric prefix argument. For example,
9478 creates two levels of headings and does the rest as items.
9480 @node Quoting LaTeX code, Sectioning structure, LaTeX/PDF export commands, LaTeX and PDF export
9481 @subsection Quoting La@TeX{} code
9483 Embedded La@TeX{} as described in @ref{Embedded LaTeX}, will be correctly
9484 inserted into the La@TeX{} file. This includes simple macros like
9485 @samp{\ref@{LABEL@}} to create a cross reference to a figure. Furthermore,
9486 you can add special code that should only be present in La@TeX{} export with
9487 the following constructs:
9490 @cindex #+BEGIN_LaTeX
9492 #+LaTeX: Literal LaTeX code for export
9496 @cindex #+BEGIN_LaTeX
9500 All lines between these markers are exported literally
9504 @node Sectioning structure, Tables in LaTeX export, Quoting LaTeX code, LaTeX and PDF export
9505 @subsection Sectioning structure
9506 @cindex La@TeX{} class
9507 @cindex La@TeX{} sectioning structure
9509 By default, the La@TeX{} output uses the class @code{article}.
9511 @vindex org-export-latex-default-class
9512 @vindex org-export-latex-classes
9513 @cindex #+LATEX_HEADER
9514 @cindex #+LATEX_CLASS
9515 @cindex #+LATEX_CLASS_OPTIONS
9516 @cindex property, LATEX_CLASS
9517 @cindex property, LATEX_CLASS_OPTIONS
9518 You can change this globally by setting a different value for
9519 @code{org-export-latex-default-class} or locally by adding an option like
9520 @code{#+LaTeX_CLASS: myclass} in your file, or with a @code{:LaTeX_CLASS:}
9521 property that applies when exporting a region containing only this (sub)tree.
9522 The class should be listed in @code{org-export-latex-classes}, where you can
9523 also define the sectioning structure for each class, as well as defining
9524 additional classes. In a similar way, @code{#+LaTeX_CLASS_OPTIONS} or a
9525 @code{LaTeX_CLASS_OPTIONS} property can specify the options for the
9526 @code{\documentclass} macro. You can also use @code{#+LATEX_HEADER:
9527 \usepackage@{xyz@}} to add lines to the header.
9529 @node Tables in LaTeX export, Images in LaTeX export, Sectioning structure, LaTeX and PDF export
9530 @subsection Tables in La@TeX{} export
9531 @cindex tables, in La@TeX{} export
9533 For La@TeX{} export of a table, you can specify a label and a caption
9534 (@pxref{Images and tables}). You can also use the @code{ATTR_LaTeX} line to
9535 request a longtable environment for the table, so that it may span several
9536 pages. Finally, you can set the alignment string:
9540 @cindex #+ATTR_LaTeX
9542 #+CAPTION: A long table
9544 #+ATTR_LaTeX: longtable align=l|lp@{3cm@}r|l
9550 @node Images in LaTeX export, Beamer class export, Tables in LaTeX export, LaTeX and PDF export
9551 @subsection Images in La@TeX{} export
9552 @cindex images, inline in La@TeX{}
9553 @cindex inlining images in La@TeX{}
9555 Images that are linked to without a description part in the link, like
9556 @samp{[[file:img.jpg]]} or @samp{[[./img.jpg]]} will be inserted into the PDF
9557 output file resulting from La@TeX{} processing. Org will use an
9558 @code{\includegraphics} macro to insert the image. If you have specified a
9559 caption and/or a label as described in @ref{Images and tables}, the figure
9560 will be wrapped into a @code{figure} environment and thus become a floating
9561 element. You can use an @code{#+ATTR_LaTeX:} line to specify the various
9562 options that can be used in the optional argument of the
9563 @code{\includegraphics} macro. To modify the placement option of the
9564 @code{figure} environment, add something like @samp{placement=[h!]} to the
9567 If you'd like to let text flow around the image, add the word @samp{wrap} to
9568 the @code{#+ATTR_LaTeX:} line, which will make the figure occupy the left
9569 half of the page. To fine-tune, the @code{placement} field will be the
9570 set of additional arguments needed by the @code{wrapfigure} environment.
9571 Note that if you change the size of the image, you need to use compatible
9572 settings for @code{\includegraphics} and @code{wrapfigure}.
9576 @cindex #+ATTR_LaTeX
9578 #+CAPTION: The black-body emission of the disk around HR 4049
9579 #+LABEL: fig:SED-HR4049
9580 #+ATTR_LaTeX: width=5cm,angle=90
9581 [[./img/sed-hr4049.pdf]]
9583 #+ATTR_LaTeX: width=0.38\textwidth wrap placement=@{r@}@{0.4\textwidth@}
9587 If you need references to a label created in this way, write
9588 @samp{\ref@{fig:SED-HR4049@}} just like in La@TeX{}.
9590 @node Beamer class export, , Images in LaTeX export, LaTeX and PDF export
9591 @subsection Beamer class export
9593 The LaTeX class @file{beamer} allows to produce high quality presentations
9594 using LaTeX and pdf processing. Org-mode has special support for turning an
9595 Org-mode file or tree into a @file{beamer} presentation.
9597 When the LaTeX class for the current buffer (as set with @code{#+LaTeX_CLASS:
9598 beamer}) or subtree (set with a @code{LaTeX_CLASS} property) is
9599 @code{beamer}, a special export mode will turn the file or tree into a beamer
9600 presentation. Any tree with not-to-deep level nesting should in principle be
9601 exportable as a beamer presentation. By default, the top-level entries (or
9602 the first level below the selected subtree heading) will be turned into
9603 frames, and the outline structure below this level will become itemize lists.
9604 You can also configure the variable @code{org-beamer-frame-level} to a
9605 different level - then the hierarchy above frames will produce the sectioning
9606 structure of the presentation.
9608 A template for useful in-buffer settings or properties can be inserted into
9609 the buffer with @kbd{M-x org-beamer-settings-template}. Among other things,
9610 this will install a column view format which is very handy for editing
9611 special properties used by beamer.
9613 You can influence the structure of the presentation using the following
9618 The environment that should be used to format this entry. Valid environments
9619 are defined in the constant @code{org-beamer-environments-default}, and you
9620 can define more in @code{org-beamer-environments-extra}. If this property is
9621 set, the entry will also get a @code{:B_environment:} tag to make this
9622 visible. This tag has no semantic meaning, it is only a visual aid.
9623 @item BEAMER_envargs
9624 The beamer-special arguments that should be used for the environment, like
9625 @code{[t]} or @code{[<+->]} of @code{<2-3>}. If the @code{BEAMER_col}
9626 property is also set, something like @code{C[t]} can be added here as well to
9627 set an options argument for the implied @code{columns} environment.
9628 @code{c[t]} will set an option for the implied @code{column} environment.
9630 The width of a column that should start with this entry. If this property is
9631 set, the entry will also get a @code{:BMCOL:} property to make this visible.
9632 Also this tag is only a visual aid. When his is a plain number, it will be
9633 interpreted as a fraction of @code{\textwidth}. Otherwise it will be assumed
9634 that you have specified the units, like @samp{3cm}. The first such property
9635 in a frame will start a @code{columns} environment to surround the columns.
9636 This environment is closed when an entry has a @code{BEAMER_col} property
9637 with value 0 or 1, or automatically at the end of the frame.
9639 Additional commands that should be inserted after the environment has been
9640 opened. For example, when creating a frame, this can be used to specify
9644 Frames will automatically receive a @code{fragile} option if they contain
9645 source code that uses the verbatim environment. Special @file{beamer}
9646 specific code can be inserted using @code{#+BEAMER:} and
9647 @code{#+BEGIN_beamer...#+end_beamer} constructs, similar to other export
9648 backends, but with the difference that @code{#+LaTeX:} stuff will be included
9649 in the presentation as well.
9651 Outline nodes with @code{BEAMER_env} property value @samp{note} or
9652 @samp{noteNH} will be formatted as beamer notes, i,e, they will be wrapped
9653 into @code{\note@{...@}}. The former will include the heading as part of the
9654 note text, the latter will ignore the heading of that node. To simplify note
9655 generation, it is actually enough to mark the note with a @emph{tag} (either
9656 @code{:B_note:} or @code{:B_noteNH:}) instead of creating the
9657 @code{BEAMER_env} property.
9659 You can turn on a special minor mode @code{org-beamer-mode} for editing
9669 In @code{org-beamer-mode}, this key offers fast selection of a beamer
9670 environment or the @code{BEAMER_col} property.
9673 Column view provides a great way to set the environment of a node and other
9674 important parameters. Make sure you are using a COLUMN format that is geared
9675 toward this special purpose. The command @kbd{M-x
9676 org-beamer-settings-template} does define such a format.
9678 Here is a simple example Org document that is intended for beamer export.
9681 #+LaTeX_CLASS: beamer
9682 #+TITLE: Example Presentation
9683 #+AUTHOR: Carsten Dominik
9684 #+LaTeX_CLASS_OPTIONS: [presentation]
9685 #+BEAMER_FRAME_LEVEL: 2
9686 #+BEAMER_HEADER_EXTRA: \usetheme@{Madrid@}\usecolortheme@{default@}
9687 #+COLUMNS: %35ITEM %10BEAMER_env(Env) %10BEAMER_envargs(Args) %4BEAMER_col(Col) %8BEAMER_extra(Ex)
9689 * This is the first structural section
9691 ** Frame 1 \\ with a subtitle
9692 *** Thanks to Eric Fraga :BMCOL:B_block:
9695 :BEAMER_envargs: C[t]
9698 for the first viable beamer setup in Org
9699 *** Thanks to everyone else :BMCOL:B_block:
9703 :BEAMER_envargs: <2->
9705 for contributing to the discussion
9706 **** This will be formatted as a beamer note :B_note:
9707 ** Frame 2 \\ where we will not use columns
9708 *** Request :B_block:
9709 Please test this stuff!
9712 For more information, see the documentation on Worg.
9714 @node DocBook export, Freemind export, LaTeX and PDF export, Exporting
9715 @section DocBook export
9716 @cindex DocBook export
9720 Org contains a DocBook exporter written by Baoqiu Cui. Once an Org file is
9721 exported to DocBook format, it can be further processed to produce other
9722 formats, including PDF, HTML, man pages, etc., using many available DocBook
9723 tools and stylesheets.
9725 Currently DocBook exporter only supports DocBook V5.0.
9728 * DocBook export commands:: How to invoke DocBook export
9729 * Quoting DocBook code:: Incorporating DocBook code in Org files
9730 * Recursive sections:: Recursive sections in DocBook
9731 * Tables in DocBook export:: Tables are exported as HTML tables
9732 * Images in DocBook export:: How to insert figures into DocBook output
9733 * Special characters:: How to handle special characters
9736 @node DocBook export commands, Quoting DocBook code, DocBook export, DocBook export
9737 @subsection DocBook export commands
9739 @cindex region, active
9740 @cindex active region
9741 @cindex transient-mark-mode
9745 @cindex property EXPORT_FILE_NAME
9746 Export as DocBook file. For an Org file, @file{myfile.org}, the DocBook XML
9747 file will be @file{myfile.xml}. The file will be overwritten without
9748 warning. If there is an active region@footnote{This requires
9749 @code{transient-mark-mode} to be turned on}, only the region will be
9750 exported. If the selected region is a single tree@footnote{To select the
9751 current subtree, use @kbd{C-c @@}.}, the tree head will become the document
9752 title. If the tree head entry has, or inherits, an @code{EXPORT_FILE_NAME}
9753 property, that name will be used for the export.
9756 Export as DocBook file, process to PDF, then open the resulting PDF file.
9758 @vindex org-export-docbook-xslt-proc-command
9759 @vindex org-export-docbook-xsl-fo-proc-command
9760 Note that, in order to produce PDF output based on exported DocBook file, you
9761 need to have XSLT processor and XSL-FO processor software installed on your
9762 system. Check variables @code{org-export-docbook-xslt-proc-command} and
9763 @code{org-export-docbook-xsl-fo-proc-command}.
9767 Export only the visible part of the document.
9770 @node Quoting DocBook code, Recursive sections, DocBook export commands, DocBook export
9771 @subsection Quoting DocBook code
9773 You can quote DocBook code in Org files and copy it verbatim into exported
9774 DocBook file with the following constructs:
9777 @cindex #+BEGIN_DOCBOOK
9779 #+DOCBOOK: Literal DocBook code for export
9783 @cindex #+BEGIN_DOCBOOK
9787 All lines between these markers are exported by DocBook exporter
9792 For example, you can use the following lines to include a DocBook warning
9793 admonition. As to what this warning says, you should pay attention to the
9794 document context when quoting DocBook code in Org files. You may make
9795 exported DocBook XML files invalid by not quoting DocBook code correctly.
9800 <para>You should know what you are doing when quoting DocBook XML code
9801 in your Org file. Invalid DocBook XML file may be generated by
9802 DocBook exporter if you are not careful!</para>
9807 @node Recursive sections, Tables in DocBook export, Quoting DocBook code, DocBook export
9808 @subsection Recursive sections
9809 @cindex DocBook recursive sections
9811 DocBook exporter exports Org files as articles using the @code{article}
9812 element in DocBook. Recursive sections, i.e. @code{section} elements, are
9813 used in exported articles. Top level headlines in Org files are exported as
9814 top level sections, and lower level headlines are exported as nested
9815 sections. The entire structure of Org files will be exported completely, no
9816 matter how many nested levels of headlines there are.
9818 Using recursive sections makes it easy to port and reuse exported DocBook
9819 code in other DocBook document types like @code{book} or @code{set}.
9821 @node Tables in DocBook export, Images in DocBook export, Recursive sections, DocBook export
9822 @subsection Tables in DocBook export
9823 @cindex tables, in DocBook export
9825 Tables in Org files are exported as HTML tables, which have been supported since
9828 If a table does not have a caption, an informal table is generated using the
9829 @code{informaltable} element; otherwise, a formal table will be generated
9830 using the @code{table} element.
9832 @node Images in DocBook export, Special characters, Tables in DocBook export, DocBook export
9833 @subsection Images in DocBook export
9834 @cindex images, inline in DocBook
9835 @cindex inlining images in DocBook
9837 Images that are linked to without a description part in the link, like
9838 @samp{[[file:img.jpg]]} or @samp{[[./img.jpg]]}, will be exported to DocBook
9839 using @code{mediaobject} elements. Each @code{mediaobject} element contains
9840 an @code{imageobject} that wraps an @code{imagedata} element. If you have
9841 specified a caption for an image as described in @ref{Images and tables}, a
9842 @code{caption} element will be added in @code{mediaobject}. If a label is
9843 also specified, it will be exported as an @code{xml:id} attribute of the
9844 @code{mediaobject} element.
9846 @vindex org-export-docbook-default-image-attributes
9847 Image attributes supported by the @code{imagedata} element, like @code{align}
9848 or @code{width}, can be specified in two ways: you can either customize
9849 variable @code{org-export-docbook-default-image-attributes} or use the
9850 @code{#+ATTR_DOCBOOK:} line. Attributes specified in variable
9851 @code{org-export-docbook-default-image-attributes} are applied to all inline
9852 images in the Org file to be exported (unless they are overwritten by image
9853 attributes specified in @code{#+ATTR_DOCBOOK:} lines).
9855 The @code{#+ATTR_DOCBOOK:} line can be used to specify additional image
9856 attributes or overwrite default image attributes for individual images. If
9857 the same attribute appears in both the @code{#+ATTR_DOCBOOK:} line and
9858 variable @code{org-export-docbook-default-image-attributes}, the former
9859 overwrites the latter. Here is an example about how image attributes can be
9864 @cindex #+ATTR_DOCBOOK
9866 #+CAPTION: The logo of Org mode
9867 #+LABEL: unicorn-svg
9868 #+ATTR_DOCBOOK: scalefit="1" width="100%" depth="100%"
9869 [[./img/org-mode-unicorn.svg]]
9872 @vindex org-export-docbook-inline-image-extensions
9873 By default, DocBook exporter recognizes the following image file types:
9874 @file{jpeg}, @file{jpg}, @file{png}, @file{gif}, and @file{svg}. You can
9875 customize variable @code{org-export-docbook-inline-image-extensions} to add
9876 more types to this list as long as DocBook supports them.
9878 @node Special characters, , Images in DocBook export, DocBook export
9879 @subsection Special characters in DocBook export
9880 @cindex Special characters in DocBook export
9882 @vindex org-export-docbook-doctype
9883 @vindex org-html-entities
9884 Special characters that are written in @TeX{}-like syntax, such as @code{\alpha},
9885 @code{\Gamma}, and @code{\Zeta}, are supported by DocBook exporter. These
9886 characters are rewritten to XML entities, like @code{α},
9887 @code{Γ}, and @code{Ζ}, based on the list saved in variable
9888 @code{org-html-entities}. As long as the generated DocBook file includes the
9889 corresponding entities, these special characters are recognized.
9891 You can customize variable @code{org-export-docbook-doctype} to include the
9892 entities you need. For example, you can set variable
9893 @code{org-export-docbook-doctype} to the following value to recognize all
9894 special characters included in XHTML entities:
9897 "<!DOCTYPE article [
9898 <!ENTITY % xhtml1-symbol PUBLIC
9899 \"-//W3C//ENTITIES Symbol for HTML//EN//XML\"
9900 \"http://www.w3.org/2003/entities/2007/xhtml1-symbol.ent\"
9907 @node Freemind export, XOXO export, DocBook export, Exporting
9908 @section Freemind export
9909 @cindex Freemind export
9912 The freemind exporter was written by Lennart Borgman.
9917 Export as Freemind mind map @file{myfile.mm}.
9920 @node XOXO export, iCalendar export, Freemind export, Exporting
9921 @section XOXO export
9924 Org mode contains an exporter that produces XOXO-style output.
9925 Currently, this exporter only handles the general outline structure and
9926 does not interpret any additional Org-mode features.
9931 Export as XOXO file @file{myfile.html}.
9934 Export only the visible part of the document.
9937 @node iCalendar export, , XOXO export, Exporting
9938 @section iCalendar export
9939 @cindex iCalendar export
9941 @vindex org-icalendar-include-todo
9942 @vindex org-icalendar-use-deadline
9943 @vindex org-icalendar-use-scheduled
9944 @vindex org-icalendar-categories
9945 Some people use Org mode for keeping track of projects, but still prefer a
9946 standard calendar application for anniversaries and appointments. In this
9947 case it can be useful to show deadlines and other time-stamped items in Org
9948 files in the calendar application. Org mode can export calendar information
9949 in the standard iCalendar format. If you also want to have TODO entries
9950 included in the export, configure the variable
9951 @code{org-icalendar-include-todo}. Plain timestamps are exported as VEVENT,
9952 and TODO items as VTODO. It will also create events from deadlines that are
9953 in non-TODO items. Deadlines and scheduling dates in TODO items will be used
9954 to set the start and due dates for the TODO entry@footnote{See the variables
9955 @code{org-icalendar-use-deadline} and @code{org-icalendar-use-scheduled}.}.
9956 As categories, it will use the tags locally defined in the heading, and the
9957 file/tree category@footnote{To add inherited tags or the TODO state,
9958 configure the variable @code{org-icalendar-categories}.}.
9960 @vindex org-icalendar-store-UID
9961 @cindex property, ID
9962 The iCalendar standard requires each entry to have a globally unique
9963 identifier (UID). Org creates these identifiers during export. If you set
9964 the variable @code{org-icalendar-store-UID}, the UID will be stored in the
9965 @code{:ID:} property of the entry and re-used next time you report this
9966 entry. Since a single entry can give rise to multiple iCalendar entries (as
9967 a timestamp, a deadline, a scheduled item, and as a TODO item), Org adds
9968 prefixes to the UID, depending on what triggered the inclusion of the entry.
9969 In this way the UID remains unique, but a synchronization program can still
9970 figure out from which entry all the different instances originate.
9975 Create iCalendar entries for the current file and store them in the same
9976 directory, using a file extension @file{.ics}.
9979 @vindex org-agenda-files
9980 Like @kbd{C-c C-e i}, but do this for all files in
9981 @code{org-agenda-files}. For each of these files, a separate iCalendar
9982 file will be written.
9985 @vindex org-combined-agenda-icalendar-file
9986 Create a single large iCalendar file from all files in
9987 @code{org-agenda-files} and write it to the file given by
9988 @code{org-combined-agenda-icalendar-file}.
9991 @vindex org-use-property-inheritance
9992 @vindex org-icalendar-include-body
9993 @cindex property, SUMMARY
9994 @cindex property, DESCRIPTION
9995 @cindex property, LOCATION
9996 The export will honor SUMMARY, DESCRIPTION and LOCATION@footnote{The LOCATION
9997 property can be inherited from higher in the hierarchy if you configure
9998 @code{org-use-property-inheritance} accordingly.} properties if the selected
9999 entries have them. If not, the summary will be derived from the headline,
10000 and the description from the body (limited to
10001 @code{org-icalendar-include-body} characters).
10003 How this calendar is best read and updated, depends on the application
10004 you are using. The FAQ covers this issue.
10006 @node Publishing, Miscellaneous, Exporting, Top
10007 @chapter Publishing
10009 @cindex O'Toole, David
10011 Org includes a publishing management system that allows you to configure
10012 automatic HTML conversion of @emph{projects} composed of interlinked org
10013 files. You can also configure Org to automatically upload your exported HTML
10014 pages and related attachments, such as images and source code files, to a web
10017 You can also use Org to convert files into PDF, or even combine HTML and PDF
10018 conversion so that files are available in both formats on the server.
10020 Publishing has been contributed to Org by David O'Toole.
10023 * Configuration:: Defining projects
10024 * Uploading files:: How to get files up on the server
10025 * Sample configuration:: Example projects
10026 * Triggering publication:: Publication commands
10029 @node Configuration, Uploading files, Publishing, Publishing
10030 @section Configuration
10032 Publishing needs significant configuration to specify files, destination
10033 and many other properties of a project.
10036 * Project alist:: The central configuration variable
10037 * Sources and destinations:: From here to there
10038 * Selecting files:: What files are part of the project?
10039 * Publishing action:: Setting the function doing the publishing
10040 * Publishing options:: Tweaking HTML export
10041 * Publishing links:: Which links keep working after publishing?
10042 * Project page index:: Publishing a list of project files
10045 @node Project alist, Sources and destinations, Configuration, Configuration
10046 @subsection The variable @code{org-publish-project-alist}
10047 @cindex org-publish-project-alist
10048 @cindex projects, for publishing
10050 @vindex org-publish-project-alist
10051 Publishing is configured almost entirely through setting the value of one
10052 variable, called @code{org-publish-project-alist}. Each element of the list
10053 configures one project, and may be in one of the two following forms:
10056 ("project-name" :property value :property value ...)
10058 ("project-name" :components ("project-name" "project-name" ...))
10062 In both cases, projects are configured by specifying property values. A
10063 project defines the set of files that will be published, as well as the
10064 publishing configuration to use when publishing those files. When a project
10065 takes the second form listed above, the individual members of the
10066 @code{:components} property are taken to be sub-projects, which group
10067 together files requiring different publishing options. When you publish such
10068 a ``meta-project'', all the components will also be published, in the
10071 @node Sources and destinations, Selecting files, Project alist, Configuration
10072 @subsection Sources and destinations for files
10073 @cindex directories, for publishing
10075 Most properties are optional, but some should always be set. In
10076 particular, Org needs to know where to look for source files,
10077 and where to put published files.
10079 @multitable @columnfractions 0.3 0.7
10080 @item @code{:base-directory}
10081 @tab Directory containing publishing source files
10082 @item @code{:publishing-directory}
10083 @tab Directory where output files will be published. You can directly
10084 publish to a webserver using a file name syntax appropriate for
10085 the Emacs @file{tramp} package. Or you can publish to a local directory and
10086 use external tools to upload your website (@pxref{Uploading files}).
10087 @item @code{:preparation-function}
10088 @tab Function called before starting the publishing process, for example, to
10089 run @code{make} for updating files to be published.
10090 @item @code{:completion-function}
10091 @tab Function called after finishing the publishing process, for example, to
10092 change permissions of the resulting files.
10096 @node Selecting files, Publishing action, Sources and destinations, Configuration
10097 @subsection Selecting files
10098 @cindex files, selecting for publishing
10100 By default, all files with extension @file{.org} in the base directory
10101 are considered part of the project. This can be modified by setting the
10103 @multitable @columnfractions 0.25 0.75
10104 @item @code{:base-extension}
10105 @tab Extension (without the dot!) of source files. This actually is a
10106 regular expression. Set this to the symbol @code{any} if you want to get all
10107 files in @code{:base-directory}, even without extension.
10109 @item @code{:exclude}
10110 @tab Regular expression to match file names that should not be
10111 published, even though they have been selected on the basis of their
10114 @item @code{:include}
10115 @tab List of files to be included regardless of @code{:base-extension}
10116 and @code{:exclude}.
10119 @node Publishing action, Publishing options, Selecting files, Configuration
10120 @subsection Publishing action
10121 @cindex action, for publishing
10123 Publishing means that a file is copied to the destination directory and
10124 possibly transformed in the process. The default transformation is to export
10125 Org files as HTML files, and this is done by the function
10126 @code{org-publish-org-to-html} which calls the HTML exporter (@pxref{HTML
10127 export}). But you also can publish your content as PDF files using
10128 @code{org-publish-org-to-pdf}. If you want to publish the Org file itself,
10129 but with @i{archived}, @i{commented}, and @i{tag-excluded} trees removed, use
10130 @code{org-publish-org-to-org} and set the parameters @code{:plain-source}
10131 and/or @code{:htmlized-source}. This will produce @file{file.org} and
10132 @file{file.org.html} in the publishing
10133 directory@footnote{@file{file-source.org} and @file{file-source.org.html} if
10134 source and publishing directories are equal. Note that with this kind of
10135 setup, you need to add @code{:exclude "-source\\.org"} to the project
10136 definition in @code{org-publish-project-alist} to avoid that the published
10137 source files will be considered as new org files the next time the project is
10138 published.}. Other files like images only
10139 need to be copied to the publishing destination, for this you may use
10140 @code{org-publish-attachment}. For non-Org files, you always need to
10141 specify the publishing function:
10143 @multitable @columnfractions 0.3 0.7
10144 @item @code{:publishing-function}
10145 @tab Function executing the publication of a file. This may also be a
10146 list of functions, which will all be called in turn.
10147 @item @code{:plain-source}
10148 @tab Non-nil means, publish plain source.
10149 @item @code{:htmlized-source}
10150 @tab Non-nil means, publish htmlized source.
10153 The function must accept two arguments: a property list containing at least a
10154 @code{:publishing-directory} property, and the name of the file to be
10155 published. It should take the specified file, make the necessary
10156 transformation (if any) and place the result into the destination folder.
10158 @node Publishing options, Publishing links, Publishing action, Configuration
10159 @subsection Options for the HTML/La@TeX{} exporters
10160 @cindex options, for publishing
10162 The property list can be used to set many export options for the HTML
10163 and La@TeX{} exporters. In most cases, these properties correspond to user
10164 variables in Org. The table below lists these properties along
10165 with the variable they belong to. See the documentation string for the
10166 respective variable for details.
10168 @vindex org-export-html-link-up
10169 @vindex org-export-html-link-home
10170 @vindex org-export-default-language
10171 @vindex org-display-custom-times
10172 @vindex org-export-headline-levels
10173 @vindex org-export-with-section-numbers
10174 @vindex org-export-section-number-format
10175 @vindex org-export-with-toc
10176 @vindex org-export-preserve-breaks
10177 @vindex org-export-with-archived-trees
10178 @vindex org-export-with-emphasize
10179 @vindex org-export-with-sub-superscripts
10180 @vindex org-export-with-special-strings
10181 @vindex org-export-with-footnotes
10182 @vindex org-export-with-drawers
10183 @vindex org-export-with-tags
10184 @vindex org-export-with-todo-keywords
10185 @vindex org-export-with-priority
10186 @vindex org-export-with-TeX-macros
10187 @vindex org-export-with-LaTeX-fragments
10188 @vindex org-export-skip-text-before-1st-heading
10189 @vindex org-export-with-fixed-width
10190 @vindex org-export-with-timestamps
10191 @vindex org-export-author-info
10192 @vindex org-export-creator-info
10193 @vindex org-export-with-tables
10194 @vindex org-export-highlight-first-table-line
10195 @vindex org-export-html-style-include-default
10196 @vindex org-export-html-style
10197 @vindex org-export-html-style-extra
10198 @vindex org-export-html-link-org-files-as-html
10199 @vindex org-export-html-inline-images
10200 @vindex org-export-html-extension
10201 @vindex org-export-html-table-tag
10202 @vindex org-export-html-expand
10203 @vindex org-export-html-with-timestamp
10204 @vindex org-export-publishing-directory
10205 @vindex org-export-html-preamble
10206 @vindex org-export-html-postamble
10207 @vindex org-export-html-auto-preamble
10208 @vindex org-export-html-auto-postamble
10209 @vindex user-full-name
10210 @vindex user-mail-address
10211 @vindex org-export-select-tags
10212 @vindex org-export-exclude-tags
10214 @multitable @columnfractions 0.32 0.68
10215 @item @code{:link-up} @tab @code{org-export-html-link-up}
10216 @item @code{:link-home} @tab @code{org-export-html-link-home}
10217 @item @code{:language} @tab @code{org-export-default-language}
10218 @item @code{:customtime} @tab @code{org-display-custom-times}
10219 @item @code{:headline-levels} @tab @code{org-export-headline-levels}
10220 @item @code{:section-numbers} @tab @code{org-export-with-section-numbers}
10221 @item @code{:section-number-format} @tab @code{org-export-section-number-format}
10222 @item @code{:table-of-contents} @tab @code{org-export-with-toc}
10223 @item @code{:preserve-breaks} @tab @code{org-export-preserve-breaks}
10224 @item @code{:archived-trees} @tab @code{org-export-with-archived-trees}
10225 @item @code{:emphasize} @tab @code{org-export-with-emphasize}
10226 @item @code{:sub-superscript} @tab @code{org-export-with-sub-superscripts}
10227 @item @code{:special-strings} @tab @code{org-export-with-special-strings}
10228 @item @code{:footnotes} @tab @code{org-export-with-footnotes}
10229 @item @code{:drawers} @tab @code{org-export-with-drawers}
10230 @item @code{:tags} @tab @code{org-export-with-tags}
10231 @item @code{:todo-keywords} @tab @code{org-export-with-todo-keywords}
10232 @item @code{:priority} @tab @code{org-export-with-priority}
10233 @item @code{:TeX-macros} @tab @code{org-export-with-TeX-macros}
10234 @item @code{:LaTeX-fragments} @tab @code{org-export-with-LaTeX-fragments}
10235 @item @code{:latex-listings} @tab @code{org-export-latex-listings}
10236 @item @code{:skip-before-1st-heading} @tab @code{org-export-skip-text-before-1st-heading}
10237 @item @code{:fixed-width} @tab @code{org-export-with-fixed-width}
10238 @item @code{:timestamps} @tab @code{org-export-with-timestamps}
10239 @item @code{:author-info} @tab @code{org-export-author-info}
10240 @item @code{:creator-info} @tab @code{org-export-creator-info}
10241 @item @code{:tables} @tab @code{org-export-with-tables}
10242 @item @code{:table-auto-headline} @tab @code{org-export-highlight-first-table-line}
10243 @item @code{:style-include-default} @tab @code{org-export-html-style-include-default}
10244 @item @code{:style} @tab @code{org-export-html-style}
10245 @item @code{:style-extra} @tab @code{org-export-html-style-extra}
10246 @item @code{:convert-org-links} @tab @code{org-export-html-link-org-files-as-html}
10247 @item @code{:inline-images} @tab @code{org-export-html-inline-images}
10248 @item @code{:html-extension} @tab @code{org-export-html-extension}
10249 @item @code{:xml-declaration} @tab @code{org-export-html-xml-declaration}
10250 @item @code{:html-table-tag} @tab @code{org-export-html-table-tag}
10251 @item @code{:expand-quoted-html} @tab @code{org-export-html-expand}
10252 @item @code{:timestamp} @tab @code{org-export-html-with-timestamp}
10253 @item @code{:publishing-directory} @tab @code{org-export-publishing-directory}
10254 @item @code{:preamble} @tab @code{org-export-html-preamble}
10255 @item @code{:postamble} @tab @code{org-export-html-postamble}
10256 @item @code{:auto-preamble} @tab @code{org-export-html-auto-preamble}
10257 @item @code{:auto-postamble} @tab @code{org-export-html-auto-postamble}
10258 @item @code{:author} @tab @code{user-full-name}
10259 @item @code{:email} @tab @code{user-mail-address} : @code{addr;addr;..}
10260 @item @code{:select-tags} @tab @code{org-export-select-tags}
10261 @item @code{:exclude-tags} @tab @code{org-export-exclude-tags}
10262 @item @code{:latex-image-options} @tab @code{org-export-latex-image-default-option}
10265 Most of the @code{org-export-with-*} variables have the same effect in
10266 both HTML and La@TeX{} exporters, except for @code{:TeX-macros} and
10267 @code{:LaTeX-fragments}, respectively @code{nil} and @code{t} in the
10270 @vindex org-publish-project-alist
10271 When a property is given a value in @code{org-publish-project-alist},
10272 its setting overrides the value of the corresponding user variable (if
10273 any) during publishing. Options set within a file (@pxref{Export
10274 options}), however, override everything.
10276 @node Publishing links, Project page index, Publishing options, Configuration
10277 @subsection Links between published files
10278 @cindex links, publishing
10280 To create a link from one Org file to another, you would use
10281 something like @samp{[[file:foo.org][The foo]]} or simply
10282 @samp{file:foo.org.} (@pxref{Hyperlinks}). When published, this link
10283 becomes a link to @file{foo.html}. In this way, you can interlink the
10284 pages of your "org web" project and the links will work as expected when
10285 you publish them to HTML. If you also publish the Org source file and want
10286 to link to that, use an @code{http:} link instead of a @code{file:} link,
10287 because @code{file:} links are converted to link to the corresponding
10290 You may also link to related files, such as images. Provided you are careful
10291 with relative file names, and provided you have also configured Org to upload
10292 the related files, these links will work too. See @ref{Complex example}, for
10293 an example of this usage.
10295 Sometimes an Org file to be published may contain links that are
10296 only valid in your production environment, but not in the publishing
10297 location. In this case, use the property
10299 @multitable @columnfractions 0.4 0.6
10300 @item @code{:link-validation-function}
10301 @tab Function to validate links
10305 to define a function for checking link validity. This function must
10306 accept two arguments, the file name and a directory relative to which
10307 the file name is interpreted in the production environment. If this
10308 function returns @code{nil}, then the HTML generator will only insert a
10309 description into the HTML file, but no link. One option for this
10310 function is @code{org-publish-validate-link} which checks if the given
10311 file is part of any project in @code{org-publish-project-alist}.
10313 @node Project page index, , Publishing links, Configuration
10314 @subsection Project page index
10315 @cindex index, of published pages
10317 The following properties may be used to control publishing of an
10318 index of files or a summary page for a given project.
10320 @multitable @columnfractions 0.25 0.75
10321 @item @code{:auto-index}
10322 @tab When non-nil, publish an index during @code{org-publish-current-project}
10323 or @code{org-publish-all}.
10325 @item @code{:index-filename}
10326 @tab Filename for output of index. Defaults to @file{sitemap.org} (which
10327 becomes @file{sitemap.html}).
10329 @item @code{:index-title}
10330 @tab Title of index page. Defaults to name of file.
10332 @item @code{:index-function}
10333 @tab Plug-in function to use for generation of index.
10334 Defaults to @code{org-publish-org-index}, which generates a plain list
10335 of links to all files in the project.
10338 @node Uploading files, Sample configuration, Configuration, Publishing
10339 @section Uploading files
10343 For those people already utilizing third party sync tools such as
10344 @command{rsync} or @command{unison}, it might be preferable not to use the built in
10345 @i{remote} publishing facilities of Org mode which rely heavily on
10346 Tramp. Tramp, while very useful and powerful, tends not to be
10347 so efficient for multiple file transfer and has been known to cause problems
10350 Specialized synchronization utilities offer several advantages. In addition
10351 to timestamp comparison, they also do content and permissions/attribute
10352 checks. For this reason you might prefer to publish your web to a local
10353 directory (possibly even @i{in place} with your Org files) and then use
10354 @file{unison} or @file{rsync} to do the synchronization with the remote host.
10356 Since Unison (for example) can be configured as to which files to transfer to
10357 a certain remote destination, it can greatly simplify the project publishing
10358 definition. Simply keep all files in the correct location, process your Org
10359 files with @code{org-publish} and let the synchronization tool do the rest.
10360 You do not need, in this scenario, to include attachments such as @file{jpg},
10361 @file{css} or @file{gif} files in the project definition since the 3rd party
10364 Publishing to a local directory is also much faster than to a remote one, so
10365 that you can afford more easily to republish entire projects. If you set
10366 @code{org-publish-use-timestamps-flag} to @code{nil}, you gain the main
10367 benefit of re-including any changed external files such as source example
10368 files you might include with @code{#+INCLUDE}. The timestamp mechanism in
10369 Org is not smart enough to detect if included files have been modified.
10371 @node Sample configuration, Triggering publication, Uploading files, Publishing
10372 @section Sample configuration
10374 Below we provide two example configurations. The first one is a simple
10375 project publishing only a set of Org files. The second example is
10376 more complex, with a multi-component project.
10379 * Simple example:: One-component publishing
10380 * Complex example:: A multi-component publishing example
10383 @node Simple example, Complex example, Sample configuration, Sample configuration
10384 @subsection Example: simple publishing configuration
10386 This example publishes a set of Org files to the @file{public_html}
10387 directory on the local machine.
10390 (setq org-publish-project-alist
10392 :base-directory "~/org/"
10393 :publishing-directory "~/public_html"
10394 :section-numbers nil
10395 :table-of-contents nil
10396 :style "<link rel=\"stylesheet\"
10397 href=\"../other/mystyle.css\"
10398 type=\"text/css\"/>")))
10401 @node Complex example, , Simple example, Sample configuration
10402 @subsection Example: complex publishing configuration
10404 This more complicated example publishes an entire website, including
10405 Org files converted to HTML, image files, Emacs Lisp source code, and
10406 style sheets. The publishing directory is remote and private files are
10409 To ensure that links are preserved, care should be taken to replicate
10410 your directory structure on the web server, and to use relative file
10411 paths. For example, if your Org files are kept in @file{~/org} and your
10412 publishable images in @file{~/images}, you'd link to an image with
10415 file:../images/myimage.png
10418 On the web server, the relative path to the image should be the
10419 same. You can accomplish this by setting up an "images" folder in the
10420 right place on the web server, and publishing images to it.
10423 (setq org-publish-project-alist
10425 :base-directory "~/org/"
10426 :base-extension "org"
10427 :publishing-directory "/ssh:user@@host:~/html/notebook/"
10428 :publishing-function org-publish-org-to-html
10429 :exclude "PrivatePage.org" ;; regexp
10431 :section-numbers nil
10432 :table-of-contents nil
10433 :style "<link rel=\"stylesheet\"
10434 href=\"../other/mystyle.css\" type=\"text/css\"/>"
10436 :auto-postamble nil)
10439 :base-directory "~/images/"
10440 :base-extension "jpg\\|gif\\|png"
10441 :publishing-directory "/ssh:user@@host:~/html/images/"
10442 :publishing-function org-publish-attachment)
10445 :base-directory "~/other/"
10446 :base-extension "css\\|el"
10447 :publishing-directory "/ssh:user@@host:~/html/other/"
10448 :publishing-function org-publish-attachment)
10449 ("website" :components ("orgfiles" "images" "other"))))
10452 @node Triggering publication, , Sample configuration, Publishing
10453 @section Triggering publication
10455 Once properly configured, Org can publish with the following commands:
10460 Prompt for a specific project and publish all files that belong to it.
10463 Publish the project containing the current file.
10466 Publish only the current file.
10469 Publish every project.
10472 @vindex org-publish-use-timestamps-flag
10473 Org uses timestamps to track when a file has changed. The above functions
10474 normally only publish changed files. You can override this and force
10475 publishing of all files by giving a prefix argument to any of the commands
10476 above, or by customizing the variable @code{org-publish-use-timestamps-flag}.
10477 This may be necessary in particular if files include other files via
10478 @code{#+SETUPFILE:} or @code{#+INCLUDE:}.
10480 @node Miscellaneous, Hacking, Publishing, Top
10481 @chapter Miscellaneous
10484 * Completion:: M-TAB knows what you need
10485 * Speed keys:: Electic commands at the beginning of a headline
10486 * Customization:: Adapting Org to your taste
10487 * In-buffer settings:: Overview of the #+KEYWORDS
10488 * The very busy C-c C-c key:: When in doubt, press C-c C-c
10489 * Clean view:: Getting rid of leading stars in the outline
10490 * TTY keys:: Using Org on a tty
10491 * Interaction:: Other Emacs packages
10495 @node Completion, Speed keys, Miscellaneous, Miscellaneous
10496 @section Completion
10497 @cindex completion, of @TeX{} symbols
10498 @cindex completion, of TODO keywords
10499 @cindex completion, of dictionary words
10500 @cindex completion, of option keywords
10501 @cindex completion, of tags
10502 @cindex completion, of property keys
10503 @cindex completion, of link abbreviations
10504 @cindex @TeX{} symbol completion
10505 @cindex TODO keywords completion
10506 @cindex dictionary word completion
10507 @cindex option keyword completion
10508 @cindex tag completion
10509 @cindex link abbreviations, completion of
10511 Emacs would not be Emacs without completion, and Org-mode uses it whenever it
10512 makes sense. If you prefer an @i{iswitchb}- or @i{ido}-like interface for
10513 some of the completion prompts, you can specify your preference by setting at
10514 most one of the variables @code{org-completion-use-iswitchb}
10515 @code{org-completion-use-ido}.
10517 Org supports in-buffer completion. This type of completion does
10518 not make use of the minibuffer. You simply type a few letters into
10519 the buffer and use the key to complete text right there.
10522 @kindex M-@key{TAB}
10524 Complete word at point
10527 At the beginning of a headline, complete TODO keywords.
10529 After @samp{\}, complete @TeX{} symbols supported by the exporter.
10531 After @samp{*}, complete headlines in the current buffer so that they
10532 can be used in search links like @samp{[[*find this headline]]}.
10534 After @samp{:} in a headline, complete tags. The list of tags is taken
10535 from the variable @code{org-tag-alist} (possibly set through the
10536 @samp{#+TAGS} in-buffer option, @pxref{Setting tags}), or it is created
10537 dynamically from all tags used in the current buffer.
10539 After @samp{:} and not in a headline, complete property keys. The list
10540 of keys is constructed dynamically from all keys used in the current
10543 After @samp{[}, complete link abbreviations (@pxref{Link abbreviations}).
10545 After @samp{#+}, complete the special keywords like @samp{TYP_TODO} or
10546 @samp{OPTIONS} which set file-specific options for Org mode. When the
10547 option keyword is already complete, pressing @kbd{M-@key{TAB}} again
10548 will insert example settings for this keyword.
10550 In the line after @samp{#+STARTUP: }, complete startup keywords,
10551 i.e. valid keys for this line.
10553 Elsewhere, complete dictionary words using Ispell.
10557 @node Speed keys, Customization, Completion, Miscellaneous
10558 @section Speed keys
10560 @vindex org-use-speed-commands
10561 @vindex org-speed-commands-user
10563 Single keys can be made to execute commands when the cursor is at the
10564 beginning of a headline, i.e. before the first star. Configure the variable
10565 @code{org-use-speed-commands} to activate this feature. There is a
10566 pre-defined list of commands, and you can add more such commands using the
10567 variable @code{org-speed-commands-user}. Speed keys do not only speed up
10568 navigation and other commands, but they also provide an alternative way to
10569 execute commands bound to keys that are not or not easily available on a tty,
10570 or on a small mobile device with a limited keyboard.
10572 To see which commands are available, activate the feature and press @kbd{?}
10573 with the cursor at the beginning of a headline.
10575 @node Customization, In-buffer settings, Speed keys, Miscellaneous
10576 @section Customization
10577 @cindex customization
10578 @cindex options, for customization
10579 @cindex variables, for customization
10581 There are more than 180 variables that can be used to customize
10582 Org. For the sake of compactness of the manual, I am not
10583 describing the variables here. A structured overview of customization
10584 variables is available with @kbd{M-x org-customize}. Or select
10585 @code{Browse Org Group} from the @code{Org->Customization} menu. Many
10586 settings can also be activated on a per-file basis, by putting special
10587 lines into the buffer (@pxref{In-buffer settings}).
10589 @node In-buffer settings, The very busy C-c C-c key, Customization, Miscellaneous
10590 @section Summary of in-buffer settings
10591 @cindex in-buffer settings
10592 @cindex special keywords
10594 Org mode uses special lines in the buffer to define settings on a
10595 per-file basis. These lines start with a @samp{#+} followed by a
10596 keyword, a colon, and then individual words defining a setting. Several
10597 setting words can be in the same line, but you can also have multiple
10598 lines for the keyword. While these settings are described throughout
10599 the manual, here is a summary. After changing any of those lines in the
10600 buffer, press @kbd{C-c C-c} with the cursor still in the line to
10601 activate the changes immediately. Otherwise they become effective only
10602 when the file is visited again in a new Emacs session.
10604 @vindex org-archive-location
10606 @item #+ARCHIVE: %s_done::
10607 This line sets the archive location for the agenda file. It applies for
10608 all subsequent lines until the next @samp{#+ARCHIVE} line, or the end
10609 of the file. The first such line also applies to any entries before it.
10610 The corresponding variable is @code{org-archive-location}.
10612 This line sets the category for the agenda file. The category applies
10613 for all subsequent lines until the next @samp{#+CATEGORY} line, or the
10614 end of the file. The first such line also applies to any entries before it.
10615 @item #+COLUMNS: %25ITEM .....
10616 @cindex property, COLUMNS
10617 Set the default format for columns view. This format applies when
10618 columns view is invoked in locations where no @code{COLUMNS} property
10620 @item #+CONSTANTS: name1=value1 ...
10621 @vindex org-table-formula-constants
10622 @vindex org-table-formula
10623 Set file-local values for constants to be used in table formulas. This
10624 line set the local variable @code{org-table-formula-constants-local}.
10625 The global version of this variable is
10626 @code{org-table-formula-constants}.
10627 @item #+FILETAGS: :tag1:tag2:tag3:
10628 Set tags that can be inherited by any entry in the file, including the
10630 @item #+DRAWERS: NAME1 .....
10631 @vindex org-drawers
10632 Set the file-local set of drawers. The corresponding global variable is
10633 @code{org-drawers}.
10634 @item #+LINK: linkword replace
10635 @vindex org-link-abbrev-alist
10636 These lines (several are allowed) specify link abbreviations.
10637 @xref{Link abbreviations}. The corresponding variable is
10638 @code{org-link-abbrev-alist}.
10639 @item #+PRIORITIES: highest lowest default
10640 @vindex org-highest-priority
10641 @vindex org-lowest-priority
10642 @vindex org-default-priority
10643 This line sets the limits and the default for the priorities. All three
10644 must be either letters A-Z or numbers 0-9. The highest priority must
10645 have a lower ASCII number that the lowest priority.
10646 @item #+PROPERTY: Property_Name Value
10647 This line sets a default inheritance value for entries in the current
10648 buffer, most useful for specifying the allowed values of a property.
10649 @cindex #+SETUPFILE
10650 @item #+SETUPFILE: file
10651 This line defines a file that holds more in-buffer setup. Normally this is
10652 entirely ignored. Only when the buffer is parsed for option-setting lines
10653 (i.e. when starting Org mode for a file, when pressing @kbd{C-c C-c} in a
10654 settings line, or when exporting), then the contents of this file are parsed
10655 as if they had been included in the buffer. In particular, the file can be
10656 any other Org mode file with internal setup. You can visit the file the
10657 cursor is in the line with @kbd{C-c '}.
10660 This line sets options to be used at startup of Org mode, when an
10661 Org file is being visited.
10663 The first set of options deals with the initial visibility of the outline
10664 tree. The corresponding variable for global default settings is
10665 @code{org-startup-folded}, with a default value @code{t}, which means
10667 @vindex org-startup-folded
10668 @cindex @code{overview}, STARTUP keyword
10669 @cindex @code{content}, STARTUP keyword
10670 @cindex @code{showall}, STARTUP keyword
10671 @cindex @code{showeverything}, STARTUP keyword
10673 overview @r{top-level headlines only}
10674 content @r{all headlines}
10675 showall @r{no folding of any entries}
10676 showeverything @r{show even drawer contents}
10679 @vindex org-startup-indented
10680 @cindex @code{indent}, STARTUP keyword
10681 @cindex @code{noindent}, STARTUP keyword
10682 Dynamic virtual indentation is controlled by the variable
10683 @code{org-startup-indented}@footnote{Emacs 23 and Org-mode 6.29 are required}
10685 indent @r{start with @code{org-indent-mode} turned on}
10686 noindent @r{start with @code{org-indent-mode} turned off}
10689 @vindex org-startup-align-all-tables
10690 Then there are options for aligning tables upon visiting a file. This
10691 is useful in files containing narrowed table columns. The corresponding
10692 variable is @code{org-startup-align-all-tables}, with a default value
10694 @cindex @code{align}, STARTUP keyword
10695 @cindex @code{noalign}, STARTUP keyword
10697 align @r{align all tables}
10698 noalign @r{don't align tables on startup}
10700 @vindex org-log-done
10701 @vindex org-log-note-clock-out
10702 @vindex org-log-repeat
10703 Logging the closing and reopening of TODO items and clock intervals can be
10704 configured using these options (see variables @code{org-log-done},
10705 @code{org-log-note-clock-out} and @code{org-log-repeat})
10706 @cindex @code{logdone}, STARTUP keyword
10707 @cindex @code{lognotedone}, STARTUP keyword
10708 @cindex @code{nologdone}, STARTUP keyword
10709 @cindex @code{lognoteclock-out}, STARTUP keyword
10710 @cindex @code{nolognoteclock-out}, STARTUP keyword
10711 @cindex @code{logrepeat}, STARTUP keyword
10712 @cindex @code{lognoterepeat}, STARTUP keyword
10713 @cindex @code{nologrepeat}, STARTUP keyword
10714 @cindex @code{logreschedule}, STARTUP keyword
10715 @cindex @code{lognotereschedule}, STARTUP keyword
10716 @cindex @code{nologreschedule}, STARTUP keyword
10717 @cindex @code{logredeadline}, STARTUP keyword
10718 @cindex @code{lognoteredeadline}, STARTUP keyword
10719 @cindex @code{nologredeadline}, STARTUP keyword
10721 logdone @r{record a timestamp when an item is marked DONE}
10722 lognotedone @r{record timestamp and a note when DONE}
10723 nologdone @r{don't record when items are marked DONE}
10724 logrepeat @r{record a time when reinstating a repeating item}
10725 lognoterepeat @r{record a note when reinstating a repeating item}
10726 nologrepeat @r{do not record when reinstating repeating item}
10727 lognoteclock-out @r{record a note when clocking out}
10728 nolognoteclock-out @r{don't record a note when clocking out}
10729 logreschedule @r{record a timestamp when scheduling time changes}
10730 lognotereschedule @r{record a note when scheduling time changes}
10731 nologreschedule @r{do not record when a scheduling date changes}
10732 logredeadline @r{record a timestamp when deadline changes}
10733 lognoteredeadline @r{record a note when deadline changes}
10734 nologredeadline @r{do not record when a deadline date changes}
10736 @vindex org-hide-leading-stars
10737 @vindex org-odd-levels-only
10738 Here are the options for hiding leading stars in outline headings, and for
10739 indenting outlines. The corresponding variables are
10740 @code{org-hide-leading-stars} and @code{org-odd-levels-only}, both with a
10741 default setting @code{nil} (meaning @code{showstars} and @code{oddeven}).
10742 @cindex @code{hidestars}, STARTUP keyword
10743 @cindex @code{showstars}, STARTUP keyword
10744 @cindex @code{odd}, STARTUP keyword
10745 @cindex @code{even}, STARTUP keyword
10747 hidestars @r{make all but one of the stars starting a headline invisible.}
10748 showstars @r{show all stars starting a headline}
10749 indent @r{virtual indentation according to outline level}
10750 noindent @r{no virtual indentation according to outline level}
10751 odd @r{allow only odd outline levels (1,3,...)}
10752 oddeven @r{allow all outline levels}
10754 @vindex org-put-time-stamp-overlays
10755 @vindex org-time-stamp-overlay-formats
10756 To turn on custom format overlays over timestamps (variables
10757 @code{org-put-time-stamp-overlays} and
10758 @code{org-time-stamp-overlay-formats}), use
10759 @cindex @code{customtime}, STARTUP keyword
10761 customtime @r{overlay custom time format}
10763 @vindex constants-unit-system
10764 The following options influence the table spreadsheet (variable
10765 @code{constants-unit-system}).
10766 @cindex @code{constcgs}, STARTUP keyword
10767 @cindex @code{constSI}, STARTUP keyword
10769 constcgs @r{@file{constants.el} should use the c-g-s unit system}
10770 constSI @r{@file{constants.el} should use the SI unit system}
10772 @vindex org-footnote-define-inline
10773 @vindex org-footnote-auto-label
10774 @vindex org-footnote-auto-adjust
10775 To influence footnote settings, use the following keywords. The
10776 corresponding variables are @code{org-footnote-define-inline},
10777 @code{org-footnote-auto-label}, and @code{org-footnote-auto-adjust}.
10778 @cindex @code{fninline}, STARTUP keyword
10779 @cindex @code{nofninline}, STARTUP keyword
10780 @cindex @code{fnlocal}, STARTUP keyword
10781 @cindex @code{fnprompt}, STARTUP keyword
10782 @cindex @code{fnauto}, STARTUP keyword
10783 @cindex @code{fnconfirm}, STARTUP keyword
10784 @cindex @code{fnplain}, STARTUP keyword
10785 @cindex @code{fnadjust}, STARTUP keyword
10786 @cindex @code{nofnadjust}, STARTUP keyword
10788 fninline @r{define footnotes inline}
10789 fnnoinline @r{define footnotes in separate section}
10790 fnlocal @r{define footnotes near first reference, but not inline}
10791 fnprompt @r{prompt for footnote labels}
10792 fnauto @r{create [fn:1]-like labels automatically (default)}
10793 fnconfirm @r{offer automatic label for editing or confirmation}
10794 fnplain @r{create [1]-like labels automatically}
10795 fnadjust @r{automatically renumber and sort footnotes}
10796 nofnadjust @r{do not renumber and sort automatically}
10798 @cindex org-hide-block-startup
10799 To hide blocks on startup, use these keywords. The corresponding variable is
10800 @code{org-hide-block-startup}.
10801 @cindex @code{hideblocks}, STARTUP keyword
10802 @cindex @code{nohideblocks}, STARTUP keyword
10804 hideblocks @r{Hide all begin/end blocks on startup}
10805 nohideblocks @r{Do not hide blocks on startup}
10807 @item #+TAGS: TAG1(c1) TAG2(c2)
10808 @vindex org-tag-alist
10809 These lines (several such lines are allowed) specify the valid tags in
10810 this file, and (potentially) the corresponding @emph{fast tag selection}
10811 keys. The corresponding variable is @code{org-tag-alist}.
10813 This line contains the formulas for the table directly above the line.
10814 @item #+TITLE:, #+AUTHOR:, #+EMAIL:, #+LANGUAGE:, #+TEXT:, #+DATE:,
10815 @itemx #+OPTIONS:, #+BIND:
10816 @itemx #+DESCRIPTION:, #+KEYWORDS:
10817 @itemx #+LATEX_HEADER:, #+STYLE:, #+LINK_UP:, #+LINK_HOME:,
10818 @itemx #+EXPORT_SELECT_TAGS:, #+EXPORT_EXCLUDE_TAGS:
10819 These lines provide settings for exporting files. For more details see
10820 @ref{Export options}.
10821 @item #+TODO: #+SEQ_TODO: #+TYP_TODO:
10822 @vindex org-todo-keywords
10823 These lines set the TODO keywords and their interpretation in the
10824 current file. The corresponding variable is @code{org-todo-keywords}.
10827 @node The very busy C-c C-c key, Clean view, In-buffer settings, Miscellaneous
10828 @section The very busy C-c C-c key
10830 @cindex C-c C-c, overview
10832 The key @kbd{C-c C-c} has many purposes in Org, which are all
10833 mentioned scattered throughout this manual. One specific function of
10834 this key is to add @emph{tags} to a headline (@pxref{Tags}). In many
10835 other circumstances it means something like @emph{``Hey Org, look
10836 here and update according to what you see here''}. Here is a summary of
10837 what this means in different contexts.
10841 If there are highlights in the buffer from the creation of a sparse
10842 tree, or from clock display, remove these highlights.
10844 If the cursor is in one of the special @code{#+KEYWORD} lines, this
10845 triggers scanning the buffer for these lines and updating the
10848 If the cursor is inside a table, realign the table. This command
10849 works even if the automatic table editor has been turned off.
10851 If the cursor is on a @code{#+TBLFM} line, re-apply the formulas to
10854 If the cursor is inside a table created by the @file{table.el} package,
10855 activate that table.
10857 If the current buffer is a Remember buffer, close the note and file it.
10858 With a prefix argument, file it, without further interaction, to the
10861 If the cursor is on a @code{<<<target>>>}, update radio targets and
10862 corresponding links in this buffer.
10864 If the cursor is in a property line or at the start or end of a property
10865 drawer, offer property commands.
10867 If the cursor is at a footnote reference, go to the corresponding
10868 definition, and vice versa.
10870 If the cursor is on a statistics cookie, update it.
10872 If the cursor is in a plain list item with a checkbox, toggle the status
10875 If the cursor is on a numbered item in a plain list, renumber the
10878 If the cursor is on the @code{#+BEGIN} line of a dynamic block, the
10882 @node Clean view, TTY keys, The very busy C-c C-c key, Miscellaneous
10883 @section A cleaner outline view
10884 @cindex hiding leading stars
10885 @cindex dynamic indentation
10886 @cindex odd-levels-only outlines
10887 @cindex clean outline view
10889 Some people find it noisy and distracting that the Org headlines start with a
10890 potentially large number of stars, and that text below the headlines is not
10891 indented. While this is no problem when writing a @emph{book-like} document
10892 where the outline headings are really section headings, in a more
10893 @emph{list-oriented} outline, indented structure is a lot cleaner:
10897 * Top level headline | * Top level headline
10898 ** Second level | * Second level
10899 *** 3rd level | * 3rd level
10900 some text | some text
10901 *** 3rd level | * 3rd level
10902 more text | more text
10903 * Another top level headline | * Another top level headline
10908 If you are using at least Emacs 23.1.50.3 and version 6.29 of Org, this kind
10909 of view can be achieved dynamically at display time using
10910 @code{org-indent-mode}. In this minor mode, all lines are prefixed for
10911 display with the necessary amount of space@footnote{@code{org-indent-mode}
10912 also sets the @code{wrap-prefix} property, such that @code{visual-line-mode}
10913 (or purely setting @code{word-wrap}) wraps long lines (including headlines)
10914 correctly indented. }. Also headlines are prefixed with additional stars,
10915 so that the amount of indentation shifts by two@footnote{See the variable
10916 @code{org-indent-indentation-per-level}.} spaces per level. All headline
10917 stars but the last one are made invisible using the @code{org-hide}
10918 face@footnote{Turning on @code{org-indent-mode} sets
10919 @code{org-hide-leading-stars} to @code{t} and @code{org-adapt-indentation} to
10920 @code{nil}.} - see below under @samp{2.} for more information on how this
10921 works. You can turn on @code{org-indent-mode} for all files by customizing
10922 the variable @code{org-startup-indented}, or you can turn it on for
10923 individual files using
10929 If you want a similar effect in earlier version of Emacs and/or Org, or if
10930 you want the indentation to be hard space characters so that the plain text
10931 file looks as similar as possible to the Emacs display, Org supports you in
10936 @emph{Indentation of text below headlines}@*
10937 You may indent text below each headline to make the left boundary line up
10938 with the headline, like
10942 more text, now indented
10945 @vindex org-adapt-indentation
10946 Org supports this with paragraph filling, line wrapping, and structure
10947 editing@footnote{See also the variable @code{org-adapt-indentation}.},
10948 preserving or adapting the indentation as appropriate.
10951 @vindex org-hide-leading-stars
10952 @emph{Hiding leading stars}@* You can modify the display in such a way that
10953 all leading stars become invisible. To do this in a global way, configure
10954 the variable @code{org-hide-leading-stars} or change this on a per-file basis
10958 #+STARTUP: hidestars
10959 #+STARTUP: showstars
10962 With hidden stars, the tree becomes:
10966 * Top level headline
10974 @vindex org-hide @r{(face)}
10975 The leading stars are not truly replaced by whitespace, they are only
10976 fontified with the face @code{org-hide} that uses the background color as
10977 font color. If you are not using either white or black background, you may
10978 have to customize this face to get the wanted effect. Another possibility is
10979 to set this font such that the extra stars are @i{almost} invisible, for
10980 example using the color @code{grey90} on a white background.
10983 @vindex org-odd-levels-only
10984 Things become cleaner still if you skip all the even levels and use only odd
10985 levels 1, 3, 5..., effectively adding two stars to go from one outline level
10986 to the next@footnote{When you need to specify a level for a property search
10987 or refile targets, @samp{LEVEL=2} will correspond to 3 stars, etc@.}. In this
10988 way we get the outline view shown at the beginning of this section. In order
10989 to make the structure editing and export commands handle this convention
10990 correctly, configure the variable @code{org-odd-levels-only}, or set this on
10991 a per-file basis with one of the following lines:
10998 You can convert an Org file from single-star-per-level to the
10999 double-star-per-level convention with @kbd{M-x org-convert-to-odd-levels
11000 RET} in that file. The reverse operation is @kbd{M-x
11001 org-convert-to-oddeven-levels}.
11004 @node TTY keys, Interaction, Clean view, Miscellaneous
11005 @section Using Org on a tty
11006 @cindex tty key bindings
11008 Because Org contains a large number of commands, by default many of
11009 Org's core commands are bound to keys that are generally not
11010 accessible on a tty, such as the cursor keys (@key{left}, @key{right},
11011 @key{up}, @key{down}), @key{TAB} and @key{RET}, in particular when used
11012 together with modifiers like @key{Meta} and/or @key{Shift}. To access
11013 these commands on a tty when special keys are unavailable, the following
11014 alternative bindings can be used. The tty bindings below will likely be
11015 more cumbersome; you may find for some of the bindings below that a
11016 customized workaround suits you better. For example, changing a timestamp
11017 is really only fun with @kbd{S-@key{cursor}} keys, whereas on a
11018 tty you would rather use @kbd{C-c .} to re-insert the timestamp.
11020 @multitable @columnfractions 0.15 0.2 0.1 0.2
11021 @item @b{Default} @tab @b{Alternative 1} @tab @b{Speed key} @tab @b{Alternative 2}
11022 @item @kbd{S-@key{TAB}} @tab @kbd{C-u @key{TAB}} @tab @kbd{C} @tab
11023 @item @kbd{M-@key{left}} @tab @kbd{C-c C-x l} @tab @kbd{l} @tab @kbd{@key{Esc} @key{left}}
11024 @item @kbd{M-S-@key{left}} @tab @kbd{C-c C-x L} @tab @kbd{L} @tab
11025 @item @kbd{M-@key{right}} @tab @kbd{C-c C-x r} @tab @kbd{r} @tab @kbd{@key{Esc} @key{right}}
11026 @item @kbd{M-S-@key{right}} @tab @kbd{C-c C-x R} @tab @kbd{R} @tab
11027 @item @kbd{M-@key{up}} @tab @kbd{C-c C-x u} @tab @kbd{ } @tab @kbd{@key{Esc} @key{up}}
11028 @item @kbd{M-S-@key{up}} @tab @kbd{C-c C-x U} @tab @kbd{U} @tab
11029 @item @kbd{M-@key{down}} @tab @kbd{C-c C-x d} @tab @kbd{ } @tab @kbd{@key{Esc} @key{down}}
11030 @item @kbd{M-S-@key{down}} @tab @kbd{C-c C-x D} @tab @kbd{D} @tab
11031 @item @kbd{S-@key{RET}} @tab @kbd{C-c C-x c} @tab @kbd{ } @tab
11032 @item @kbd{M-@key{RET}} @tab @kbd{C-c C-x m} @tab @kbd{ } @tab @kbd{@key{Esc} @key{RET}}
11033 @item @kbd{M-S-@key{RET}} @tab @kbd{C-c C-x M} @tab @kbd{ } @tab
11034 @item @kbd{S-@key{left}} @tab @kbd{C-c @key{left}} @tab @kbd{ } @tab
11035 @item @kbd{S-@key{right}} @tab @kbd{C-c @key{right}} @tab @kbd{ } @tab
11036 @item @kbd{S-@key{up}} @tab @kbd{C-c @key{up}} @tab @kbd{ } @tab
11037 @item @kbd{S-@key{down}} @tab @kbd{C-c @key{down}} @tab @kbd{ } @tab
11038 @item @kbd{C-S-@key{left}} @tab @kbd{C-c C-x @key{left}} @tab @kbd{ } @tab
11039 @item @kbd{C-S-@key{right}} @tab @kbd{C-c C-x @key{right}} @tab @kbd{ } @tab
11043 @node Interaction, , TTY keys, Miscellaneous
11044 @section Interaction with other packages
11045 @cindex packages, interaction with other
11046 Org lives in the world of GNU Emacs and interacts in various ways
11047 with other code out there.
11050 * Cooperation:: Packages Org cooperates with
11051 * Conflicts:: Packages that lead to conflicts
11054 @node Cooperation, Conflicts, Interaction, Interaction
11055 @subsection Packages that Org cooperates with
11058 @cindex @file{calc.el}
11059 @cindex Gillespie, Dave
11060 @item @file{calc.el} by Dave Gillespie
11061 Org uses the Calc package for implementing spreadsheet
11062 functionality in its tables (@pxref{The spreadsheet}). Org
11063 checks for the availability of Calc by looking for the function
11064 @code{calc-eval} which will have been autoloaded during setup if Calc has
11065 been installed properly. As of Emacs 22, Calc is part of the Emacs
11066 distribution. Another possibility for interaction between the two
11067 packages is using Calc for embedded calculations. @xref{Embedded Mode,
11068 , Embedded Mode, Calc, GNU Emacs Calc Manual}.
11069 @item @file{constants.el} by Carsten Dominik
11070 @cindex @file{constants.el}
11071 @cindex Dominik, Carsten
11072 @vindex org-table-formula-constants
11073 In a table formula (@pxref{The spreadsheet}), it is possible to use
11074 names for natural constants or units. Instead of defining your own
11075 constants in the variable @code{org-table-formula-constants}, install
11076 the @file{constants} package which defines a large number of constants
11077 and units, and lets you use unit prefixes like @samp{M} for
11078 @samp{Mega}, etc@. You will need version 2.0 of this package, available
11079 at @url{http://www.astro.uva.nl/~dominik/Tools}. Org checks for
11080 the function @code{constants-get}, which has to be autoloaded in your
11081 setup. See the installation instructions in the file
11082 @file{constants.el}.
11083 @item @file{cdlatex.el} by Carsten Dominik
11084 @cindex @file{cdlatex.el}
11085 @cindex Dominik, Carsten
11086 Org mode can make use of the CDLa@TeX{} package to efficiently enter
11087 La@TeX{} fragments into Org files. See @ref{CDLaTeX mode}.
11088 @item @file{imenu.el} by Ake Stenhoff and Lars Lindberg
11089 @cindex @file{imenu.el}
11090 Imenu allows menu access to an index of items in a file. Org mode
11091 supports Imenu---all you need to do to get the index is the following:
11093 (add-hook 'org-mode-hook
11094 (lambda () (imenu-add-to-menubar "Imenu")))
11096 @vindex org-imenu-depth
11097 By default the index is two levels deep---you can modify the depth using
11098 the option @code{org-imenu-depth}.
11099 @item @file{remember.el} by John Wiegley
11100 @cindex @file{remember.el}
11101 @cindex Wiegley, John
11102 Org cooperates with remember, see @ref{Remember}.
11103 As of Emacs 23, @file{Remember.el} is part of the Emacs distribution.
11104 @item @file{speedbar.el} by Eric M. Ludlam
11105 @cindex @file{speedbar.el}
11106 @cindex Ludlam, Eric M.
11107 Speedbar is a package that creates a special frame displaying files and
11108 index items in files. Org mode supports Speedbar and allows you to
11109 drill into Org files directly from the Speedbar. It also allows you to
11110 restrict the scope of agenda commands to a file or a subtree by using
11111 the command @kbd{<} in the Speedbar frame.
11112 @cindex @file{table.el}
11113 @item @file{table.el} by Takaaki Ota
11115 @cindex table editor, @file{table.el}
11116 @cindex @file{table.el}
11117 @cindex Ota, Takaaki
11119 Complex ASCII tables with automatic line wrapping, column- and
11120 row-spanning, and alignment can be created using the Emacs table
11121 package by Takaaki Ota (@uref{http://sourceforge.net/projects/table},
11122 and also part of Emacs 22).
11123 When @key{TAB} or @kbd{C-c C-c} is pressed in such a table, Org mode
11124 will call @command{table-recognize-table} and move the cursor into the
11125 table. Inside a table, the keymap of Org mode is inactive. In order
11126 to execute Org mode-related commands, leave the table.
11131 Recognize @file{table.el} table. Works when the cursor is in a
11136 Insert a @file{table.el} table. If there is already a table at point, this
11137 command converts it between the @file{table.el} format and the Org-mode
11138 format. See the documentation string of the command
11139 @code{org-convert-table} for the restrictions under which this is
11142 @file{table.el} is part of Emacs 22.
11143 @item @file{footnote.el} by Steven L. Baur
11144 @cindex @file{footnote.el}
11145 @cindex Baur, Steven L.
11146 Org mode recognizes numerical footnotes as provided by this package.
11147 However, Org mode also has its own footnote support (@pxref{Footnotes}),
11148 which makes using @file{footnote.el} unnecessary.
11151 @node Conflicts, , Cooperation, Interaction
11152 @subsection Packages that lead to conflicts with Org mode
11156 @cindex @code{shift-selection-mode}
11157 @vindex org-support-shift-select
11158 In Emacs 23, @code{shift-selection-mode} is on by default, meaning that
11159 cursor motions combined with the shift key should start or enlarge regions.
11160 This conflicts with the use of @kbd{S-@key{cursor}} commands in Org to change
11161 timestamps, TODO keywords, priorities, and item bullet types if the cursor is
11162 at such a location. By default, @kbd{S-@key{cursor}} commands outside
11163 special contexts don't do anything, but you can customize the variable
11164 @code{org-support-shift-select}. Org mode then tries to accommodate shift
11165 selection by (i) using it outside of the special contexts where special
11166 commands apply, and by (ii) extending an existing active region even if the
11167 cursor moves across a special context.
11169 @item @file{CUA.el} by Kim. F. Storm
11170 @cindex @file{CUA.el}
11171 @cindex Storm, Kim. F.
11172 @vindex org-replace-disputed-keys
11173 Key bindings in Org conflict with the @kbd{S-<cursor>} keys used by CUA mode
11174 (as well as @code{pc-select-mode} and @code{s-region-mode}) to select and extend the
11175 region. In fact, Emacs 23 has this built-in in the form of
11176 @code{shift-selection-mode}, see previous paragraph. If you are using Emacs
11177 23, you probably don't want to use another package for this purpose. However,
11178 if you prefer to leave these keys to a different package while working in
11179 Org mode, configure the variable @code{org-replace-disputed-keys}. When set,
11180 Org will move the following key bindings in Org files, and in the agenda
11181 buffer (but not during date selection).
11184 S-UP -> M-p S-DOWN -> M-n
11185 S-LEFT -> M-- S-RIGHT -> M-+
11186 C-S-LEFT -> M-S-- C-S-RIGHT -> M-S-+
11189 @vindex org-disputed-keys
11190 Yes, these are unfortunately more difficult to remember. If you want
11191 to have other replacement keys, look at the variable
11192 @code{org-disputed-keys}.
11194 @item @file{yasnippet.el}
11195 @cindex @file{yasnippet.el}
11196 The way Org-mode binds the TAB key (binding to @code{[tab]} instead of
11197 @code{"\t"}) overrules yasnippets' access to this key. The following code
11198 fixed this problem:
11201 (add-hook 'org-mode-hook
11203 (org-set-local 'yas/trigger-key [tab])
11204 (define-key yas/keymap [tab] 'yas/next-field-group)))
11207 @item @file{windmove.el} by Hovav Shacham
11208 @cindex @file{windmove.el}
11209 This package also uses the @kbd{S-<cursor>} keys, so everything written
11210 in the paragraph above about CUA mode also applies here.
11212 @item @file{viper.el} by Michael Kifer
11213 @cindex @file{viper.el}
11215 Viper uses @kbd{C-c /} and therefore makes this key not access the
11216 corresponding Org-mode command @code{org-sparse-tree}. You need to find
11217 another key for this command, or override the key in
11218 @code{viper-vi-global-user-map} with
11221 (define-key viper-vi-global-user-map "C-c /" 'org-sparse-tree)
11227 @node Hacking, MobileOrg, Miscellaneous, Top
11231 This appendix covers some aspects where users can extend the functionality of
11235 * Hooks:: Who to reach into Org's internals
11236 * Add-on packages:: Available extensions
11237 * Adding hyperlink types:: New custom link types
11238 * Context-sensitive commands:: How to add functionality to such commands
11239 * Tables in arbitrary syntax:: Orgtbl for La@TeX{} and other programs
11240 * Dynamic blocks:: Automatically filled blocks
11241 * Special agenda views:: Customized views
11242 * Extracting agenda information:: Postprocessing of agenda information
11243 * Using the property API:: Writing programs that use entry properties
11244 * Using the mapping API:: Mapping over all or selected entries
11247 @node Hooks, Add-on packages, Hacking, Hacking
11251 Org has a large number of hook variables that can be used to add
11252 functionality. This appendix about hacking is going to illustrate the
11253 use of some of them. A complete list of all hooks with documentation is
11254 maintained by the Worg project and can be found at
11255 @uref{http://orgmode.org/worg/org-configs/org-hooks.php}.
11257 @node Add-on packages, Adding hyperlink types, Hooks, Hacking
11258 @section Add-on packages
11259 @cindex add-on packages
11261 A large number of add-on packages have been written by various authors.
11262 These packages are not part of Emacs, but they are distributed as contributed
11263 packages with the separate release available at the Org mode home page at
11264 @uref{http://orgmode.org}. The list of contributed packages, along with
11265 documentation about each package, is maintained by the Worg project at
11266 @uref{http://orgmode.org/worg/org-contrib/}.
11270 @node Adding hyperlink types, Context-sensitive commands, Add-on packages, Hacking
11271 @section Adding hyperlink types
11272 @cindex hyperlinks, adding new types
11274 Org has a large number of hyperlink types built-in
11275 (@pxref{Hyperlinks}). If you would like to add new link types, Org
11276 provides an interface for doing so. Let's look at an example file,
11277 @file{org-man.el}, that will add support for creating links like
11278 @samp{[[man:printf][The printf manpage]]} to show Unix manual pages inside
11282 ;;; org-man.el - Support for links to manpages in Org
11286 (org-add-link-type "man" 'org-man-open)
11287 (add-hook 'org-store-link-functions 'org-man-store-link)
11289 (defcustom org-man-command 'man
11290 "The Emacs command to be used to display a man page."
11292 :type '(choice (const man) (const woman)))
11294 (defun org-man-open (path)
11295 "Visit the manpage on PATH.
11296 PATH should be a topic that can be thrown at the man command."
11297 (funcall org-man-command path))
11299 (defun org-man-store-link ()
11300 "Store a link to a manpage."
11301 (when (memq major-mode '(Man-mode woman-mode))
11302 ;; This is a man page, we do make this link
11303 (let* ((page (org-man-get-page-name))
11304 (link (concat "man:" page))
11305 (description (format "Manpage for %s" page)))
11306 (org-store-link-props
11309 :description description))))
11311 (defun org-man-get-page-name ()
11312 "Extract the page name from the buffer name."
11313 ;; This works for both `Man-mode' and `woman-mode'.
11314 (if (string-match " \\(\\S-+\\)\\*" (buffer-name))
11315 (match-string 1 (buffer-name))
11316 (error "Cannot create link to this man page")))
11320 ;;; org-man.el ends here
11324 You would activate this new link type in @file{.emacs} with
11331 Let's go through the file and see what it does.
11334 It does @code{(require 'org)} to make sure that @file{org.el} has been
11337 The next line calls @code{org-add-link-type} to define a new link type
11338 with prefix @samp{man}. The call also contains the name of a function
11339 that will be called to follow such a link.
11341 @vindex org-store-link-functions
11342 The next line adds a function to @code{org-store-link-functions}, in
11343 order to allow the command @kbd{C-c l} to record a useful link in a
11344 buffer displaying a man page.
11347 The rest of the file defines the necessary variables and functions.
11348 First there is a customization variable that determines which Emacs
11349 command should be used to display man pages. There are two options,
11350 @code{man} and @code{woman}. Then the function to follow a link is
11351 defined. It gets the link path as an argument---in this case the link
11352 path is just a topic for the manual command. The function calls the
11353 value of @code{org-man-command} to display the man page.
11355 Finally the function @code{org-man-store-link} is defined. When you try
11356 to store a link with @kbd{C-c l}, this function will be called to
11357 try to make a link. The function must first decide if it is supposed to
11358 create the link for this buffer type; we do this by checking the value
11359 of the variable @code{major-mode}. If not, the function must exit and
11360 return the value @code{nil}. If yes, the link is created by getting the
11361 manual topic from the buffer name and prefixing it with the string
11362 @samp{man:}. Then it must call the command @code{org-store-link-props}
11363 and set the @code{:type} and @code{:link} properties. Optionally you
11364 can also set the @code{:description} property to provide a default for
11365 the link description when the link is later inserted into an Org
11366 buffer with @kbd{C-c C-l}.
11368 When is makes sense for your new link type, you may also define a function
11369 @code{org-PREFIX-complete-link} that implements special (e.g. completion)
11370 support for inserting such a link with @kbd{C-c C-l}. Such a function should
11371 not accept any arguments, and return the full link with prefix.
11373 @node Context-sensitive commands, Tables in arbitrary syntax, Adding hyperlink types, Hacking
11374 @section Context-sensitive commands
11375 @cindex context-sensitive commands, hooks
11376 @cindex add-ons, context-sensitive commands
11377 @vindex org-ctrl-c-ctrl-c-hook
11379 Org has several commands that act differently depending on context. The most
11380 important example it the @kbd{C-c C-c} (@pxref{The very busy C-c C-c key}).
11381 Also the @kbd{M-cursor} and @kbd{M-S-cursor} keys have this property.
11383 Add-ons can tap into this functionality by providing a function that detects
11384 special context for that add-on and executes functionality appropriate for
11385 the context. Here is an example from Dan Davison's @file{org-R.el} which
11386 allows you to evaluate commands based on the @file{R} programming language. For
11387 this package, special contexts are lines that start with @code{#+R:} or
11391 (defun org-R-apply-maybe ()
11392 "Detect if this is context for org-R and execute R commands."
11393 (if (save-excursion
11394 (beginning-of-line 1)
11395 (looking-at "#\\+RR?:"))
11396 (progn (call-interactively 'org-R-apply)
11397 t) ;; to signal that we took action
11398 nil)) ;; to signal that we did not
11400 (add-hook 'org-ctrl-c-ctrl-c-hook 'org-R-apply-maybe)
11403 The function first checks if the cursor is in such a line. If that is the
11404 case, @code{org-R-apply} is called and the function returns @code{t} to
11405 signal that action was taken, and @kbd{C-c C-c} will stop looking for other
11406 contexts. If the function finds it should do nothing locally, it returns @code{nil} so that other, similar functions can have a try.
11409 @node Tables in arbitrary syntax, Dynamic blocks, Context-sensitive commands, Hacking
11410 @section Tables and lists in arbitrary syntax
11411 @cindex tables, in other modes
11412 @cindex lists, in other modes
11413 @cindex Orgtbl mode
11415 Since Orgtbl mode can be used as a minor mode in arbitrary buffers, a
11416 frequent feature request has been to make it work with native tables in
11417 specific languages, for example La@TeX{}. However, this is extremely
11418 hard to do in a general way, would lead to a customization nightmare,
11419 and would take away much of the simplicity of the Orgtbl-mode table
11423 This appendix describes a different approach. We keep the Orgtbl mode
11424 table in its native format (the @i{source table}), and use a custom
11425 function to @i{translate} the table to the correct syntax, and to
11426 @i{install} it in the right location (the @i{target table}). This puts
11427 the burden of writing conversion functions on the user, but it allows
11428 for a very flexible system.
11430 Bastien added the ability to do the same with lists. You can use Org's
11431 facilities to edit and structure lists by turning @code{orgstruct-mode}
11432 on, then locally exporting such lists in another format (HTML, La@TeX{}
11437 * Radio tables:: Sending and receiving radio tables
11438 * A LaTeX example:: Step by step, almost a tutorial
11439 * Translator functions:: Copy and modify
11440 * Radio lists:: Doing the same for lists
11443 @node Radio tables, A LaTeX example, Tables in arbitrary syntax, Tables in arbitrary syntax
11444 @subsection Radio tables
11445 @cindex radio tables
11447 To define the location of the target table, you first need to create two
11448 lines that are comments in the current mode, but contain magic words for
11449 Orgtbl mode to find. Orgtbl mode will insert the translated table
11450 between these lines, replacing whatever was there before. For example:
11453 /* BEGIN RECEIVE ORGTBL table_name */
11454 /* END RECEIVE ORGTBL table_name */
11458 Just above the source table, we put a special line that tells
11459 Orgtbl mode how to translate this table and where to install it. For
11463 #+ORGTBL: SEND table_name translation_function arguments....
11467 @code{table_name} is the reference name for the table that is also used
11468 in the receiver lines. @code{translation_function} is the Lisp function
11469 that does the translation. Furthermore, the line can contain a list of
11470 arguments (alternating key and value) at the end. The arguments will be
11471 passed as a property list to the translation function for
11472 interpretation. A few standard parameters are already recognized and
11473 acted upon before the translation function is called:
11477 Skip the first N lines of the table. Hlines do count as separate lines for
11480 @item :skipcols (n1 n2 ...)
11481 List of columns that should be skipped. If the table has a column with
11482 calculation marks, that column is automatically discarded as well.
11483 Please note that the translator function sees the table @emph{after} the
11484 removal of these columns, the function never knows that there have been
11485 additional columns.
11489 The one problem remaining is how to keep the source table in the buffer
11490 without disturbing the normal workings of the file, for example during
11491 compilation of a C file or processing of a La@TeX{} file. There are a
11492 number of different solutions:
11496 The table could be placed in a block comment if that is supported by the
11497 language. For example, in C mode you could wrap the table between
11498 @samp{/*} and @samp{*/} lines.
11500 Sometimes it is possible to put the table after some kind of @i{END}
11501 statement, for example @samp{\bye} in @TeX{} and @samp{\end@{document@}}
11504 You can just comment the table line-by-line whenever you want to process
11505 the file, and uncomment it whenever you need to edit the table. This
11506 only sounds tedious---the command @kbd{M-x orgtbl-toggle-comment}
11507 makes this comment-toggling very easy, in particular if you bind it to a
11511 @node A LaTeX example, Translator functions, Radio tables, Tables in arbitrary syntax
11512 @subsection A La@TeX{} example of radio tables
11513 @cindex La@TeX{}, and Orgtbl mode
11515 The best way to wrap the source table in La@TeX{} is to use the
11516 @code{comment} environment provided by @file{comment.sty}. It has to be
11517 activated by placing @code{\usepackage@{comment@}} into the document
11518 header. Orgtbl mode can insert a radio table skeleton@footnote{By
11519 default this works only for La@TeX{}, HTML, and Texinfo. Configure the
11520 variable @code{orgtbl-radio-tables} to install templates for other
11521 modes.} with the command @kbd{M-x orgtbl-insert-radio-table}. You will
11522 be prompted for a table name, let's say we use @samp{salesfigures}. You
11523 will then get the following template:
11525 @cindex #+ORGTBL, SEND
11527 % BEGIN RECEIVE ORGTBL salesfigures
11528 % END RECEIVE ORGTBL salesfigures
11530 #+ORGTBL: SEND salesfigures orgtbl-to-latex
11536 @vindex La@TeX{}-verbatim-environments
11537 The @code{#+ORGTBL: SEND} line tells Orgtbl mode to use the function
11538 @code{orgtbl-to-latex} to convert the table into La@TeX{} and to put it
11539 into the receiver location with name @code{salesfigures}. You may now
11540 fill in the table, feel free to use the spreadsheet features@footnote{If
11541 the @samp{#+TBLFM} line contains an odd number of dollar characters,
11542 this may cause problems with font-lock in La@TeX{} mode. As shown in the
11543 example you can fix this by adding an extra line inside the
11544 @code{comment} environment that is used to balance the dollar
11545 expressions. If you are using AUC@TeX{} with the font-latex library, a
11546 much better solution is to add the @code{comment} environment to the
11547 variable @code{LaTeX-verbatim-environments}.}:
11550 % BEGIN RECEIVE ORGTBL salesfigures
11551 % END RECEIVE ORGTBL salesfigures
11553 #+ORGTBL: SEND salesfigures orgtbl-to-latex
11554 | Month | Days | Nr sold | per day |
11555 |-------+------+---------+---------|
11556 | Jan | 23 | 55 | 2.4 |
11557 | Feb | 21 | 16 | 0.8 |
11558 | March | 22 | 278 | 12.6 |
11559 #+TBLFM: $4=$3/$2;%.1f
11560 % $ (optional extra dollar to keep font-lock happy, see footnote)
11565 When you are done, press @kbd{C-c C-c} in the table to get the converted
11566 table inserted between the two marker lines.
11568 Now let's assume you want to make the table header by hand, because you
11569 want to control how columns are aligned, etc@. In this case we make sure
11570 that the table translator skips the first 2 lines of the source
11571 table, and tell the command to work as a @i{splice}, i.e. to not produce
11572 header and footer commands of the target table:
11575 \begin@{tabular@}@{lrrr@}
11576 Month & \multicolumn@{1@}@{c@}@{Days@} & Nr.\ sold & per day\\
11577 % BEGIN RECEIVE ORGTBL salesfigures
11578 % END RECEIVE ORGTBL salesfigures
11582 #+ORGTBL: SEND salesfigures orgtbl-to-latex :splice t :skip 2
11583 | Month | Days | Nr sold | per day |
11584 |-------+------+---------+---------|
11585 | Jan | 23 | 55 | 2.4 |
11586 | Feb | 21 | 16 | 0.8 |
11587 | March | 22 | 278 | 12.6 |
11588 #+TBLFM: $4=$3/$2;%.1f
11592 The La@TeX{} translator function @code{orgtbl-to-latex} is already part of
11593 Orgtbl mode. It uses a @code{tabular} environment to typeset the table
11594 and marks horizontal lines with @code{\hline}. Furthermore, it
11595 interprets the following parameters (see also @pxref{Translator functions}):
11598 @item :splice nil/t
11599 When set to t, return only table body lines, don't wrap them into a
11600 tabular environment. Default is nil.
11603 A format to be used to wrap each field, it should contain @code{%s} for the
11604 original field value. For example, to wrap each field value in dollars,
11605 you could use @code{:fmt "$%s$"}. This may also be a property list with
11606 column numbers and formats. for example @code{:fmt (2 "$%s$" 4 "%s\\%%")}.
11607 A function of one argument can be used in place of the strings; the
11608 function must return a formatted string.
11611 Use this format to print numbers with exponentials. The format should
11612 have @code{%s} twice for inserting mantissa and exponent, for example
11613 @code{"%s\\times10^@{%s@}"}. The default is @code{"%s\\,(%s)"}. This
11614 may also be a property list with column numbers and formats, for example
11615 @code{:efmt (2 "$%s\\times10^@{%s@}$" 4 "$%s\\cdot10^@{%s@}$")}. After
11616 @code{efmt} has been applied to a value, @code{fmt} will also be
11617 applied. Similar to @code{fmt}, functions of two arguments can be
11618 supplied instead of strings.
11621 @node Translator functions, Radio lists, A LaTeX example, Tables in arbitrary syntax
11622 @subsection Translator functions
11623 @cindex HTML, and Orgtbl mode
11624 @cindex translator function
11626 Orgtbl mode has several translator functions built-in: @code{orgtbl-to-csv}
11627 (comma-separated values), @code{orgtbl-to-tsv} (TAB-separated values)
11628 @code{orgtbl-to-latex}, @code{orgtbl-to-html}, and @code{orgtbl-to-texinfo}.
11629 Except for @code{orgtbl-to-html}@footnote{The HTML translator uses the same
11630 code that produces tables during HTML export.}, these all use a generic
11631 translator, @code{orgtbl-to-generic}. For example, @code{orgtbl-to-latex}
11632 itself is a very short function that computes the column definitions for the
11633 @code{tabular} environment, defines a few field and line separators and then
11634 hands processing over to the generic translator. Here is the entire code:
11638 (defun orgtbl-to-latex (table params)
11639 "Convert the Orgtbl mode TABLE to LaTeX."
11640 (let* ((alignment (mapconcat (lambda (x) (if x "r" "l"))
11641 org-table-last-alignment ""))
11644 :tstart (concat "\\begin@{tabular@}@{" alignment "@}")
11645 :tend "\\end@{tabular@}"
11646 :lstart "" :lend " \\\\" :sep " & "
11647 :efmt "%s\\,(%s)" :hline "\\hline")))
11648 (orgtbl-to-generic table (org-combine-plists params2 params))))
11652 As you can see, the properties passed into the function (variable
11653 @var{PARAMS}) are combined with the ones newly defined in the function
11654 (variable @var{PARAMS2}). The ones passed into the function (i.e. the
11655 ones set by the @samp{ORGTBL SEND} line) take precedence. So if you
11656 would like to use the La@TeX{} translator, but wanted the line endings to
11657 be @samp{\\[2mm]} instead of the default @samp{\\}, you could just
11658 overrule the default with
11661 #+ORGTBL: SEND test orgtbl-to-latex :lend " \\\\[2mm]"
11664 For a new language, you can either write your own converter function in
11665 analogy with the La@TeX{} translator, or you can use the generic function
11666 directly. For example, if you have a language where a table is started
11667 with @samp{!BTBL!}, ended with @samp{!ETBL!}, and where table lines are
11668 started with @samp{!BL!}, ended with @samp{!EL!}, and where the field
11669 separator is a TAB, you could call the generic translator like this (on
11673 #+ORGTBL: SEND test orgtbl-to-generic :tstart "!BTBL!" :tend "!ETBL!"
11674 :lstart "!BL! " :lend " !EL!" :sep "\t"
11678 Please check the documentation string of the function
11679 @code{orgtbl-to-generic} for a full list of parameters understood by
11680 that function, and remember that you can pass each of them into
11681 @code{orgtbl-to-latex}, @code{orgtbl-to-texinfo}, and any other function
11682 using the generic function.
11684 Of course you can also write a completely new function doing complicated
11685 things the generic translator cannot do. A translator function takes
11686 two arguments. The first argument is the table, a list of lines, each
11687 line either the symbol @code{hline} or a list of fields. The second
11688 argument is the property list containing all parameters specified in the
11689 @samp{#+ORGTBL: SEND} line. The function must return a single string
11690 containing the formatted table. If you write a generally useful
11691 translator, please post it on @email{emacs-orgmode@@gnu.org} so that
11692 others can benefit from your work.
11694 @node Radio lists, , Translator functions, Tables in arbitrary syntax
11695 @subsection Radio lists
11696 @cindex radio lists
11697 @cindex org-list-insert-radio-list
11699 Sending and receiving radio lists works exactly the same way than sending and
11700 receiving radio tables (@pxref{Radio tables}). As for radio tables, you can
11701 insert radio lists templates in HTML, La@TeX{} and Texinfo modes by calling
11702 @code{org-list-insert-radio-list}.
11704 Here are the differences with radio tables:
11708 Use @code{ORGLST} instead of @code{ORGTBL}.
11710 The available translation functions for radio lists don't take
11713 @kbd{C-c C-c} will work when pressed on the first item of the list.
11716 Here is a La@TeX{} example. Let's say that you have this in your
11721 % BEGIN RECEIVE ORGLST to-buy
11722 % END RECEIVE ORGLST to-buy
11724 #+ORGLIST: SEND to-buy orgtbl-to-latex
11733 Pressing `C-c C-c' on @code{a new house} and will insert the converted
11734 La@TeX{} list between the two marker lines.
11736 @node Dynamic blocks, Special agenda views, Tables in arbitrary syntax, Hacking
11737 @section Dynamic blocks
11738 @cindex dynamic blocks
11740 Org documents can contain @emph{dynamic blocks}. These are
11741 specially marked regions that are updated by some user-written function.
11742 A good example for such a block is the clock table inserted by the
11743 command @kbd{C-c C-x C-r} (@pxref{Clocking work time}).
11745 Dynamic block are enclosed by a BEGIN-END structure that assigns a name
11746 to the block and can also specify parameters for the function producing
11747 the content of the block.
11749 #+BEGIN:dynamic block
11751 #+BEGIN: myblock :parameter1 value1 :parameter2 value2 ...
11756 Dynamic blocks are updated with the following commands
11759 @kindex C-c C-x C-u
11761 Update dynamic block at point.
11762 @kindex C-u C-c C-x C-u
11763 @item C-u C-c C-x C-u
11764 Update all dynamic blocks in the current file.
11767 Updating a dynamic block means to remove all the text between BEGIN and
11768 END, parse the BEGIN line for parameters and then call the specific
11769 writer function for this block to insert the new content. If you want
11770 to use the original content in the writer function, you can use the
11771 extra parameter @code{:content}.
11773 For a block with name @code{myblock}, the writer function is
11774 @code{org-dblock-write:myblock} with as only parameter a property list
11775 with the parameters given in the begin line. Here is a trivial example
11776 of a block that keeps track of when the block update function was last
11780 #+BEGIN: block-update-time :format "on %m/%d/%Y at %H:%M"
11786 The corresponding block writer function could look like this:
11789 (defun org-dblock-write:block-update-time (params)
11790 (let ((fmt (or (plist-get params :format) "%d. %m. %Y")))
11791 (insert "Last block update at: "
11792 (format-time-string fmt (current-time)))))
11795 If you want to make sure that all dynamic blocks are always up-to-date,
11796 you could add the function @code{org-update-all-dblocks} to a hook, for
11797 example @code{before-save-hook}. @code{org-update-all-dblocks} is
11798 written in a way such that it does nothing in buffers that are not in
11801 @node Special agenda views, Extracting agenda information, Dynamic blocks, Hacking
11802 @section Special agenda views
11803 @cindex agenda views, user-defined
11805 Org provides a special hook that can be used to narrow down the
11806 selection made by any of the agenda views. You may specify a function
11807 that is used at each match to verify if the match should indeed be part
11808 of the agenda view, and if not, how much should be skipped.
11810 Let's say you want to produce a list of projects that contain a WAITING
11811 tag anywhere in the project tree. Let's further assume that you have
11812 marked all tree headings that define a project with the TODO keyword
11813 PROJECT. In this case you would run a TODO search for the keyword
11814 PROJECT, but skip the match unless there is a WAITING tag anywhere in
11815 the subtree belonging to the project line.
11817 To achieve this, you must write a function that searches the subtree for
11818 the tag. If the tag is found, the function must return @code{nil} to
11819 indicate that this match should not be skipped. If there is no such
11820 tag, return the location of the end of the subtree, to indicate that
11821 search should continue from there.
11824 (defun my-skip-unless-waiting ()
11825 "Skip trees that are not waiting"
11826 (let ((subtree-end (save-excursion (org-end-of-subtree t))))
11827 (if (re-search-forward ":waiting:" subtree-end t)
11828 nil ; tag found, do not skip
11829 subtree-end))) ; tag not found, continue after end of subtree
11832 Now you may use this function in an agenda custom command, for example
11836 (org-add-agenda-custom-command
11837 '("b" todo "PROJECT"
11838 ((org-agenda-skip-function 'my-skip-unless-waiting)
11839 (org-agenda-overriding-header "Projects waiting for something: "))))
11842 @vindex org-agenda-overriding-header
11843 Note that this also binds @code{org-agenda-overriding-header} to get a
11844 meaningful header in the agenda view.
11846 @vindex org-odd-levels-only
11847 @vindex org-agenda-skip-function
11848 A general way to create custom searches is to base them on a search for
11849 entries with a certain level limit. If you want to study all entries with
11850 your custom search function, simply do a search for
11851 @samp{LEVEL>0}@footnote{Note that, when using @code{org-odd-levels-only}, a
11852 level number corresponds to order in the hierarchy, not to the number of
11853 stars.}, and then use @code{org-agenda-skip-function} to select the entries
11854 you really want to have.
11856 You may also put a Lisp form into @code{org-agenda-skip-function}. In
11857 particular, you may use the functions @code{org-agenda-skip-entry-if}
11858 and @code{org-agenda-skip-subtree-if} in this form, for example:
11861 @item '(org-agenda-skip-entry-if 'scheduled)
11862 Skip current entry if it has been scheduled.
11863 @item '(org-agenda-skip-entry-if 'notscheduled)
11864 Skip current entry if it has not been scheduled.
11865 @item '(org-agenda-skip-entry-if 'deadline)
11866 Skip current entry if it has a deadline.
11867 @item '(org-agenda-skip-entry-if 'scheduled 'deadline)
11868 Skip current entry if it has a deadline, or if it is scheduled.
11869 @item '(org-agenda-skip-entry-if 'timestamp)
11870 Skip current entry if it has any timestamp, may also be deadline or scheduled.
11871 @item '(org-agenda-skip-entry 'regexp "regular expression")
11872 Skip current entry if the regular expression matches in the entry.
11873 @item '(org-agenda-skip-entry 'notregexp "regular expression")
11874 Skip current entry unless the regular expression matches.
11875 @item '(org-agenda-skip-subtree-if 'regexp "regular expression")
11876 Same as above, but check and skip the entire subtree.
11879 Therefore we could also have written the search for WAITING projects
11880 like this, even without defining a special function:
11883 (org-add-agenda-custom-command
11884 '("b" todo "PROJECT"
11885 ((org-agenda-skip-function '(org-agenda-skip-subtree-if
11886 'regexp ":waiting:"))
11887 (org-agenda-overriding-header "Projects waiting for something: "))))
11890 @node Extracting agenda information, Using the property API, Special agenda views, Hacking
11891 @section Extracting agenda information
11892 @cindex agenda, pipe
11893 @cindex Scripts, for agenda processing
11895 @vindex org-agenda-custom-commands
11896 Org provides commands to access agenda information for the command
11897 line in Emacs batch mode. This extracted information can be sent
11898 directly to a printer, or it can be read by a program that does further
11899 processing of the data. The first of these commands is the function
11900 @code{org-batch-agenda}, that produces an agenda view and sends it as
11901 ASCII text to STDOUT. The command takes a single string as parameter.
11902 If the string has length 1, it is used as a key to one of the commands
11903 you have configured in @code{org-agenda-custom-commands}, basically any
11904 key you can use after @kbd{C-c a}. For example, to directly print the
11905 current TODO list, you could use
11908 emacs -batch -l ~/.emacs -eval '(org-batch-agenda "t")' | lpr
11911 If the parameter is a string with 2 or more characters, it is used as a
11912 tags/TODO match string. For example, to print your local shopping list
11913 (all items with the tag @samp{shop}, but excluding the tag
11914 @samp{NewYork}), you could use
11917 emacs -batch -l ~/.emacs \
11918 -eval '(org-batch-agenda "+shop-NewYork")' | lpr
11922 You may also modify parameters on the fly like this:
11925 emacs -batch -l ~/.emacs \
11926 -eval '(org-batch-agenda "a" \
11927 org-agenda-ndays 30 \
11928 org-agenda-include-diary nil \
11929 org-agenda-files (quote ("~/org/project.org")))' \
11934 which will produce a 30-day agenda, fully restricted to the Org file
11935 @file{~/org/projects.org}, not even including the diary.
11937 If you want to process the agenda data in more sophisticated ways, you
11938 can use the command @code{org-batch-agenda-csv} to get a comma-separated
11939 list of values for each agenda item. Each line in the output will
11940 contain a number of fields separated by commas. The fields in a line
11944 category @r{The category of the item}
11945 head @r{The headline, without TODO keyword, TAGS and PRIORITY}
11946 type @r{The type of the agenda entry, can be}
11947 todo @r{selected in TODO match}
11948 tagsmatch @r{selected in tags match}
11949 diary @r{imported from diary}
11950 deadline @r{a deadline}
11951 scheduled @r{scheduled}
11952 timestamp @r{appointment, selected by timestamp}
11953 closed @r{entry was closed on date}
11954 upcoming-deadline @r{warning about nearing deadline}
11955 past-scheduled @r{forwarded scheduled item}
11956 block @r{entry has date block including date}
11957 todo @r{The TODO keyword, if any}
11958 tags @r{All tags including inherited ones, separated by colons}
11959 date @r{The relevant date, like 2007-2-14}
11960 time @r{The time, like 15:00-16:50}
11961 extra @r{String with extra planning info}
11962 priority-l @r{The priority letter if any was given}
11963 priority-n @r{The computed numerical priority}
11967 Time and date will only be given if a timestamp (or deadline/scheduled)
11968 led to the selection of the item.
11970 A CSV list like this is very easy to use in a post-processing script.
11971 For example, here is a Perl program that gets the TODO list from
11972 Emacs/Org and prints all the items, preceded by a checkbox:
11977 # define the Emacs command to run
11978 $cmd = "emacs -batch -l ~/.emacs -eval '(org-batch-agenda-csv \"t\")'";
11980 # run it and capture the output
11981 $agenda = qx@{$cmd 2>/dev/null@};
11983 # loop over all lines
11984 foreach $line (split(/\n/,$agenda)) @{
11985 # get the individual values
11986 ($category,$head,$type,$todo,$tags,$date,$time,$extra,
11987 $priority_l,$priority_n) = split(/,/,$line);
11988 # process and print
11989 print "[ ] $head\n";
11993 @node Using the property API, Using the mapping API, Extracting agenda information, Hacking
11994 @section Using the property API
11995 @cindex API, for properties
11996 @cindex properties, API
11998 Here is a description of the functions that can be used to work with
12001 @defun org-entry-properties &optional pom which
12002 Get all properties of the entry at point-or-marker POM.@*
12003 This includes the TODO keyword, the tags, time strings for deadline,
12004 scheduled, and clocking, and any additional properties defined in the
12005 entry. The return value is an alist, keys may occur multiple times
12006 if the property key was used several times.@*
12007 POM may also be nil, in which case the current entry is used.
12008 If WHICH is nil or `all', get all properties. If WHICH is
12009 `special' or `standard', only get that subclass.
12011 @vindex org-use-property-inheritance
12012 @defun org-entry-get pom property &optional inherit
12013 Get value of PROPERTY for entry at point-or-marker POM. By default,
12014 this only looks at properties defined locally in the entry. If INHERIT
12015 is non-nil and the entry does not have the property, then also check
12016 higher levels of the hierarchy. If INHERIT is the symbol
12017 @code{selective}, use inheritance if and only if the setting of
12018 @code{org-use-property-inheritance} selects PROPERTY for inheritance.
12021 @defun org-entry-delete pom property
12022 Delete the property PROPERTY from entry at point-or-marker POM.
12025 @defun org-entry-put pom property value
12026 Set PROPERTY to VALUE for entry at point-or-marker POM.
12029 @defun org-buffer-property-keys &optional include-specials
12030 Get all property keys in the current buffer.
12033 @defun org-insert-property-drawer
12034 Insert a property drawer at point.
12037 @defun org-entry-put-multivalued-property pom property &rest values
12038 Set PROPERTY at point-or-marker POM to VALUES. VALUES should be a list of
12039 strings. They will be concatenated, with spaces as separators.
12042 @defun org-entry-get-multivalued-property pom property
12043 Treat the value of the property PROPERTY as a whitespace-separated list of
12044 values and return the values as a list of strings.
12047 @defun org-entry-add-to-multivalued-property pom property value
12048 Treat the value of the property PROPERTY as a whitespace-separated list of
12049 values and make sure that VALUE is in this list.
12052 @defun org-entry-remove-from-multivalued-property pom property value
12053 Treat the value of the property PROPERTY as a whitespace-separated list of
12054 values and make sure that VALUE is @emph{not} in this list.
12057 @defun org-entry-member-in-multivalued-property pom property value
12058 Treat the value of the property PROPERTY as a whitespace-separated list of
12059 values and check if VALUE is in this list.
12062 @defopt org-property-allowed-value-functions
12063 Hook for functions supplying allowed values for specific.
12064 The functions must take a single argument, the name of the property, and
12065 return a flat list of allowed values. If @samp{:ETC} is one of
12066 the values, use the values as completion help, but allow also other values
12067 to be entered. The functions must return @code{nil} if they are not
12068 responsible for this property.
12071 @node Using the mapping API, , Using the property API, Hacking
12072 @section Using the mapping API
12073 @cindex API, for mapping
12074 @cindex mapping entries, API
12076 Org has sophisticated mapping capabilities to find all entries satisfying
12077 certain criteria. Internally, this functionality is used to produce agenda
12078 views, but there is also an API that can be used to execute arbitrary
12079 functions for each or selected entries. The main entry point for this API
12082 @defun org-map-entries func &optional match scope &rest skip
12083 Call FUNC at each headline selected by MATCH in SCOPE.
12085 FUNC is a function or a Lisp form. The function will be called without
12086 arguments, with the cursor positioned at the beginning of the headline.
12087 The return values of all calls to the function will be collected and
12088 returned as a list.
12090 The call to FUNC will be wrapped into a save-excursion form, so FUNC
12091 does not need to preserve point. After evaluation, the cursor will be
12092 moved to the end of the line (presumably of the headline of the
12093 processed entry) and search continues from there. Under some
12094 circumstances, this may not produce the wanted results. For example,
12095 if you have removed (e.g. archived) the current (sub)tree it could
12096 mean that the next entry will be skipped entirely. In such cases, you
12097 can specify the position from where search should continue by making
12098 FUNC set the variable `org-map-continue-from' to the desired buffer
12101 MATCH is a tags/property/todo match as it is used in the agenda match view.
12102 Only headlines that are matched by this query will be considered during
12103 the iteration. When MATCH is nil or t, all headlines will be
12104 visited by the iteration.
12106 SCOPE determines the scope of this command. It can be any of:
12109 nil @r{the current buffer, respecting the restriction if any}
12110 tree @r{the subtree started with the entry at point}
12111 file @r{the current buffer, without restriction}
12113 @r{the current buffer, and any archives associated with it}
12114 agenda @r{all agenda files}
12115 agenda-with-archives
12116 @r{all agenda files with any archive files associated with them}
12118 @r{if this is a list, all files in the list will be scanned}
12121 The remaining args are treated as settings for the skipping facilities of
12122 the scanner. The following items can be given here:
12124 @vindex org-agenda-skip-function
12126 archive @r{skip trees with the archive tag}
12127 comment @r{skip trees with the COMMENT keyword}
12128 function or Lisp form
12129 @r{will be used as value for @code{org-agenda-skip-function},}
12130 @r{so whenever the function returns t, FUNC}
12131 @r{will not be called for that entry and search will}
12132 @r{continue from the point where the function leaves it}
12136 The function given to that mapping routine can really do anything you like.
12137 It can use the property API (@pxref{Using the property API}) to gather more
12138 information about the entry, or in order to change metadata in the entry.
12139 Here are a couple of functions that might be handy:
12141 @defun org-todo &optional arg
12142 Change the TODO state of the entry, see the docstring of the functions for
12143 the many possible values for the argument ARG.
12146 @defun org-priority &optional action
12147 Change the priority of the entry, see the docstring of this function for the
12148 possible values for ACTION.
12151 @defun org-toggle-tag tag &optional onoff
12152 Toggle the tag TAG in the current entry. Setting ONOFF to either @code{on}
12153 or @code{off} will not toggle tag, but ensure that it is either on or off.
12157 Promote the current entry.
12161 Demote the current entry.
12164 Here is a simple example that will turn all entries in the current file with
12165 a tag @code{TOMORROW} into TODO entries with the keyword @code{UPCOMING}.
12166 Entries in comment trees and in archive trees will be ignored.
12170 '(org-todo "UPCOMING")
12171 "+TOMORROW" 'file 'archive 'comment)
12174 The following example counts the number of entries with TODO keyword
12175 @code{WAITING}, in all agenda files.
12178 (length (org-map-entries t "/+WAITING" 'agenda))
12181 @node MobileOrg, History and Acknowledgments, Hacking, Top
12182 @appendix MobileOrg
12186 @i{MobileOrg} is an application for the @i{iPhone/iPod Touch} series of
12187 devices, developed by Richard Moreland. @i{MobileOrg} offers offline viewing
12188 and capture support for an Org-mode system rooted on a ``real'' computer. It
12189 does also allow you to record changes to existing entries. For information
12190 about @i{MobileOrg}, see @uref{http://mobileorg.ncogni.to/}).
12192 This appendix describes the support Org has for creating agenda views in a
12193 format that can be displayed by @i{MobileOrg}, and for integrating notes
12194 captured and changes made by @i{MobileOrg} into the main system.
12196 For changing tags and TODO states in MobileOrg, you should have set up the
12197 customization variables @code{org-todo-keywords} and @code{org-tags-alist} to
12198 cover all important tags and todo keywords, even if individual files use only
12199 part of these. MobileOrg will also offer you states and tags set up with
12200 in-buffer settings, but it will understand the logistics of todo state
12201 @i{sets} (@pxref{Per-file keywords}) and @i{mutually exclusive} tags
12202 (@pxref{Setting tags}) only for those set in these variables.
12205 * Setting up the staging area:: Where to interact with the mobile device
12206 * Pushing to MobileOrg:: Uploading Org files and agendas
12207 * Pulling from MobileOrg:: Integrating captured and flagged items
12210 @node Setting up the staging area, Pushing to MobileOrg, MobileOrg, MobileOrg
12211 @section Setting up the staging area
12213 Org-mode has commands to prepare a directory with files for @i{MobileOrg},
12214 and to read captured notes from there. If Emacs can directly write to the
12215 WebDAV directory accessed by @i{MobileOrg}, just point to this directory
12216 using the variable @code{org-mobile-directory}. Using the @file{tramp}
12217 method, @code{org-mobile-directory} may point to a remote directory
12218 accessible through, for example,
12222 (setq org-mobile-directory "/scpc:user@@remote.host:org/webdav/")
12225 If Emacs cannot access the WebDAV directory directly using a @file{tramp}
12226 method, or you prefer to maintain a local copy, you can use a local directory
12227 for staging. Other means must then be used to keep this directory in sync
12228 with the WebDAV directory. In the following example, files are staged in
12229 @file{~/stage}, and Org-mode hooks take care of moving files to and from the
12230 WebDAV directory using @file{scp}.
12233 (setq org-mobile-directory "~/stage/")
12234 (add-hook 'org-mobile-post-push-hook
12235 (lambda () (shell-command "scp -r ~/stage/* user@@wdhost:mobile/")))
12236 (add-hook 'org-mobile-pre-pull-hook
12237 (lambda () (shell-command "scp user@@wdhost:mobile/mobileorg.org ~/stage/ ")))
12238 (add-hook 'org-mobile-post-pull-hook
12239 (lambda () (shell-command "scp ~/stage/mobileorg.org user@@wdhost:mobile/")))
12242 @node Pushing to MobileOrg, Pulling from MobileOrg, Setting up the staging area, MobileOrg
12243 @section Pushing to MobileOrg
12245 This operation copies all files currently listed in @code{org-mobile-files}
12246 to the directory @code{org-mobile-directory}. By default this list contains
12247 all agenda files (as listed in @code{org-agenda-files}), but additional files
12248 can be included by customizing @code{org-mobiles-files}. File names will be
12249 staged with path relative to @code{org-directory}, so all files should be
12250 inside this directory. The push operation also creates (in the same
12251 directory) a special Org file @file{agendas.org}. This file is an Org-mode
12252 style outline, containing every custom agenda view defined by the user.
12253 While creating the agendas, Org-mode will force@footnote{See the variable
12254 @code{org-mobile-force-id-on-agenda-items}.} an ID property on all entries
12255 referenced by the agendas, so that these entries can be uniquely identified
12256 if @i{MobileOrg} flags them for further action. Finally, Org writes the file
12257 @file{index.org}, containing links to all other files. If @i{MobileOrg} is
12258 configured to request this file from the WebDAV server, all agendas and Org
12259 files will be downloaded to the device. To speed up the download, MobileOrg
12260 will only read files whose checksums@footnote{stored automatically in the
12261 file @file{checksums.dat}} have changed.
12263 @node Pulling from MobileOrg, , Pushing to MobileOrg, MobileOrg
12264 @section Pulling from MobileOrg
12266 When @i{MobileOrg} synchronizes with the WebDAV server, it not only pulls the
12267 Org files for viewing. It also appends captured entries and pointers to
12268 flagged and changed entries to the file @file{mobileorg.org} on the server.
12269 Org has a @emph{pull} operation that integrates this information into an
12270 inbox file and operates on the pointers to flagged entries. Here is how it
12275 Org moves all entries found in
12276 @file{mobileorg.org}@footnote{@file{mobileorg.org} will be empty after this
12277 operation.} and appends them to the file pointed to by the variable
12278 @code{org-mobile-inbox-for-pull}. Each captured entry and each editing event
12279 will be a top-level entry in the inbox file.
12281 After moving the entries, Org will attempt to implement the changes made in
12282 @i{MobileOrg}. Some changes are applied directly and without user
12283 interaction. Examples are all changes to tags, TODO state, headline and body
12284 text that can be cleanly applied. Entries that have been flagged for further
12285 action will receive a tag @code{:FLAGGED:}, so that they can be easily found
12286 again. When there is a problem finding an entry or applying the change, the
12287 pointer entry will remain in the inbox and will be marked with an error
12288 message. You need to later resolve these issues by hand.
12290 Org will then generate an agenda view with all flagged entries. The user
12291 should then go through these entries and do whatever actions are necessary.
12292 If a note has been stored while flagging an entry in @i{MobileOrg}, that note
12293 will be displayed in the echo area when the cursor is on the corresponding
12298 Pressing @kbd{?} in that special agenda will display the full flagging note in
12299 another window and also push it onto the kill ring. So you could use @kbd{?
12300 z C-y C-c C-c} to store that flagging note as a normal note in the entry.
12301 Pressing @kbd{?} twice in succession will offer to remove the
12302 @code{:FLAGGED:} tag along with the recorded flagging note (which is stored
12303 in a property). In this way you indicate, that the intended processing for
12304 this flagged entry is finished.
12309 If you are not able to process all flagged entries directly, you can always
12310 return to this agenda view using @kbd{C-c a ?}. Note, however, that there is
12311 a subtle difference. The view created automatically by @kbd{M-x
12312 org-mobile-pull RET} is guaranteed to search all files that have been
12313 addressed by the last pull. This might include a file that is not currently
12314 in your list of agenda files. If you later use @kbd{C-c a ?} to regenerate
12315 the view, only the current agenda files will be searched.
12317 @node History and Acknowledgments, Main Index, MobileOrg, Top
12318 @appendix History and Acknowledgments
12319 @cindex acknowledgements
12323 Org was born in 2003, out of frustration over the user interface
12324 of the Emacs Outline mode. I was trying to organize my notes and
12325 projects, and using Emacs seemed to be the natural way to go. However,
12326 having to remember eleven different commands with two or three keys per
12327 command, only to hide and show parts of the outline tree, that seemed
12328 entirely unacceptable to me. Also, when using outlines to take notes, I
12329 constantly wanted to restructure the tree, organizing it parallel to my
12330 thoughts and plans. @emph{Visibility cycling} and @emph{structure
12331 editing} were originally implemented in the package
12332 @file{outline-magic.el}, but quickly moved to the more general
12333 @file{org.el}. As this environment became comfortable for project
12334 planning, the next step was adding @emph{TODO entries}, basic
12335 @emph{timestamps}, and @emph{table support}. These areas highlighted the two main
12336 goals that Org still has today: to be a new, outline-based,
12337 plain text mode with innovative and intuitive editing features, and to
12338 incorporate project planning functionality directly into a notes file.
12340 A special thanks goes to @i{Bastien Guerry} who has not only written a large
12341 number of extensions to Org (most of them integrated into the core by now),
12342 but who has also helped in the development and maintenance of Org so much that he
12343 should be considered the main co-contributor to this package.
12345 Since the first release, literally thousands of emails to me or to
12346 @email{emacs-orgmode@@gnu.org} have provided a constant stream of bug
12347 reports, feedback, new ideas, and sometimes patches and add-on code.
12348 Many thanks to everyone who has helped to improve this package. I am
12349 trying to keep here a list of the people who had significant influence
12350 in shaping one or more aspects of Org. The list may not be
12351 complete, if I have forgotten someone, please accept my apologies and
12357 @i{Russel Adams} came up with the idea for drawers.
12359 @i{Thomas Baumann} wrote @file{org-bbdb.el} and @file{org-mhe.el}.
12361 @i{Christophe Bataillon} created the great unicorn logo that we use on the
12364 @i{Alex Bochannek} provided a patch for rounding timestamps.
12366 @i{Jan Böcker} wrote @file{org-docview.el}.
12368 @i{Brad Bozarth} showed how to pull RSS feed data into Org-mode files.
12370 @i{Tom Breton} wrote @file{org-choose.el}.
12372 @i{Charles Cave}'s suggestion sparked the implementation of templates
12375 @i{Pavel Chalmoviansky} influenced the agenda treatment of items with
12378 @i{Gregory Chernov} patched support for Lisp forms into table
12379 calculations and improved XEmacs compatibility, in particular by porting
12380 @file{nouline.el} to XEmacs.
12382 @i{Sacha Chua} suggested copying some linking code from Planner.
12384 @i{Baoqiu Cui} contributed the DocBook exporter.
12386 @i{Dan Davison} wrote (together with @i{Eric Schulte}) Org Babel.
12388 @i{Eddward DeVilla} proposed and tested checkbox statistics. He also
12389 came up with the idea of properties, and that there should be an API for
12392 @i{Nick Dokos} tracked down several nasty bugs.
12394 @i{Kees Dullemond} used to edit projects lists directly in HTML and so
12395 inspired some of the early development, including HTML export. He also
12396 asked for a way to narrow wide table columns.
12398 @i{Christian Egli} converted the documentation into Texinfo format,
12399 patched CSS formatting into the HTML exporter, and inspired the agenda.
12401 @i{David Emery} provided a patch for custom CSS support in exported
12404 @i{Nic Ferrier} contributed mailcap and XOXO support.
12406 @i{Miguel A. Figueroa-Villanueva} implemented hierarchical checkboxes.
12408 @i{John Foerch} figured out how to make incremental search show context
12409 around a match in a hidden outline tree.
12411 @i{Raimar Finken} wrote @file{org-git-line.el}.
12413 @i{Mikael Fornius} works as a mailing list moderator.
12415 @i{Austin Frank} works as a mailing list moderator.
12417 @i{Niels Giesen} had the idea to automatically archive DONE trees.
12419 @i{Bastien Guerry} wrote the La@TeX{} exporter and @file{org-bibtex.el}, and
12420 has been prolific with patches, ideas, and bug reports.
12422 @i{Kai Grossjohann} pointed out key-binding conflicts with other packages.
12424 @i{Bernt Hansen} has driven much of the support for auto-repeating tasks,
12425 task state change logging, and the clocktable. His clear explanations have
12426 been critical when we started to adopt the Git version control system.
12428 @i{Manuel Hermenegildo} has contributed various ideas, small fixes and
12431 @i{Phil Jackson} wrote @file{org-irc.el}.
12433 @i{Scott Jaderholm} proposed footnotes, control over whitespace between
12434 folded entries, and column view for properties.
12436 @i{Tokuya Kameshima} wrote @file{org-wl.el} and @file{org-mew.el}.
12438 @i{Shidai Liu} ("Leo") asked for embedded La@TeX{} and tested it. He also
12439 provided frequent feedback and some patches.
12441 @i{Matt Lundin} has proposed last-row references for table formulas and named
12442 invisible anchors. He has also worked a lot on the FAQ.
12444 @i{Jason F. McBrayer} suggested agenda export to CSV format.
12446 @i{Max Mikhanosha} came up with the idea of refiling.
12448 @i{Dmitri Minaev} sent a patch to set priority limits on a per-file
12451 @i{Stefan Monnier} provided a patch to keep the Emacs-Lisp compiler
12454 @i{Richard Moreland} wrote @i{MobileOrg} for the iPhone.
12456 @i{Rick Moynihan} proposed allowing multiple TODO sequences in a file
12457 and being able to quickly restrict the agenda to a subtree.
12459 @i{Todd Neal} provided patches for links to Info files and Elisp forms.
12461 @i{Greg Newman} refreshed the unicorn logo into its current form.
12463 @i{Tim O'Callaghan} suggested in-file links, search options for general
12464 file links, and TAGS.
12466 @i{Takeshi Okano} translated the manual and David O'Toole's tutorial
12469 @i{Oliver Oppitz} suggested multi-state TODO items.
12471 @i{Scott Otterson} sparked the introduction of descriptive text for
12472 links, among other things.
12474 @i{Pete Phillips} helped during the development of the TAGS feature, and
12475 provided frequent feedback.
12477 @i{Martin Pohlack} provided the code snippet to bundle character insertion
12478 into bundles of 20 for undo.
12480 @i{T.V. Raman} reported bugs and suggested improvements.
12482 @i{Matthias Rempe} (Oelde) provided ideas, Windows support, and quality
12485 @i{Paul Rivier} provided the basic implementation of named footnotes. He
12486 also acted as mailing list moderator for some time.
12488 @i{Kevin Rogers} contributed code to access VM files on remote hosts.
12490 @i{Sebastian Rose} wrote @file{org-info.js}, a Java script for displaying
12491 webpages derived from Org using an Info-like or a folding interface with
12492 single-key navigation.
12494 @i{Frank Ruell} solved the mystery of the @code{keymapp nil} bug, a
12495 conflict with @file{allout.el}.
12497 @i{Jason Riedy} generalized the send-receive mechanism for Orgtbl tables with
12500 @i{Philip Rooke} created the Org reference card, provided lots
12501 of feedback, developed and applied standards to the Org documentation.
12503 @i{Christian Schlauer} proposed angular brackets around links, among
12506 @i{Eric Schulte} wrote @file{org-plot.el} and (together with @i{Dan Davison})
12507 Org Babel, and contributed various patches, small features and modules.
12509 @i{Paul Sexton} wrote @file{org-ctags.el}.
12511 Linking to VM/BBDB/Gnus was first inspired by @i{Tom Shannon}'s
12512 @file{organizer-mode.el}.
12514 @i{Ilya Shlyakhter} proposed the Archive Sibling, line numbering in literal
12515 examples, and remote highlighting for referenced code lines.
12517 @i{Stathis Sideris} wrote the @file{ditaa.jar} ASCII to PNG converter that is
12518 now packaged into Org's @file{contrib} directory.
12520 @i{Daniel Sinder} came up with the idea of internal archiving by locking
12523 @i{Dale Smith} proposed link abbreviations.
12525 @i{James TD Smith} has contributed a large number of patches for useful
12526 tweaks and features.
12528 @i{Adam Spiers} asked for global linking commands, inspired the link
12529 extension system, added support for mairix, and proposed the mapping API.
12531 @i{Andy Stewart} contributed code to @file{org-w3m.el}, to copy HTML content
12532 with links transformation to Org syntax.
12534 @i{David O'Toole} wrote @file{org-publish.el} and drafted the manual
12535 chapter about publishing.
12537 @i{J@"urgen Vollmer} contributed code generating the table of contents
12540 @i{Samuel Wales} has provided important feedback and bug reports.
12542 @i{Chris Wallace} provided a patch implementing the @samp{QUOTE}
12545 @i{David Wainberg} suggested archiving, and improvements to the linking
12548 @i{John Wiegley} wrote @file{emacs-wiki.el}, @file{planner.el}, and
12549 @file{muse.el}, which have some overlap with Org. Initially the development
12550 of Org was fully independent because I was not aware of the existence of
12551 these packages. But with time I have occasionally looked at John's code and
12552 learned a lot from it. John has also contributed a number of great ideas and
12553 patches directly to Org, including the attachment system
12554 (@file{org-attach.el}), integration with Apple Mail
12555 (@file{org-mac-message.el}), hierarchical dependencies of TODO items, habit
12556 tracking (@file{org-habits.el}).
12558 @i{Carsten Wimmer} suggested some changes and helped fix a bug in
12561 @i{Roland Winkler} requested additional key bindings to make Org
12564 @i{Piotr Zielinski} wrote @file{org-mouse.el}, proposed agenda blocks
12565 and contributed various ideas and code snippets.
12569 @node Main Index, Key Index, History and Acknowledgments, Top
12570 @unnumbered Concept Index
12574 @node Key Index, Variable Index, Main Index, Top
12575 @unnumbered Key Index
12579 @node Variable Index, , Key Index, Top
12580 @unnumbered Variable Index
12582 This is not a complete index of variables and faces, only the ones that are
12583 mentioned in the manual. For a more complete list, use @kbd{M-x
12584 org-customize @key{RET}} and then click yourself through the tree.
12591 arch-tag: 7893d1Fe-cc57-4d13-b5e5-f494a1CBC7ac
12594 @c Local variables:
12595 @c ispell-local-dictionary: "en_US-w_accents"
12596 @c ispell-local-pdict: "./.aspell.org.pws"
12601 @c LocalWords: webdavhost pre